]> git.ipfire.org Git - thirdparty/binutils-gdb.git/blame - ld/ld.texi
bfd: use "stack trace" instead of "unwind" for SFrame
[thirdparty/binutils-gdb.git] / ld / ld.texi
CommitLineData
252b5132
RH
1\input texinfo
2@setfilename ld.info
d87bef3a 3@c Copyright (C) 1991-2023 Free Software Foundation, Inc.
252b5132 4@syncodeindex ky cp
dff70155 5@c man begin INCLUDE
252b5132
RH
6@include configdoc.texi
7@c (configdoc.texi is generated by the Makefile)
c428fa83 8@include bfdver.texi
dff70155 9@c man end
252b5132
RH
10
11@c @smallbook
12
ff5dcc92
SC
13@macro gcctabopt{body}
14@code{\body\}
15@end macro
16
0285c67d
NC
17@c man begin NAME
18@ifset man
19@c Configure for the generation of man pages
20@set UsesEnvVars
21@set GENERIC
0285c67d 22@set ARM
ac145307 23@set C6X
b8891f8d 24@set CSKY
49fa1e15 25@set H8300
0285c67d 26@set HPPA
0285c67d 27@set M68HC11
7fb9f789 28@set M68K
833794fc 29@set MIPS
3c3bdf30 30@set MMIX
2469cfa2 31@set MSP430
35c08157 32@set NDS32
78058a5e 33@set NIOSII
fa1477dc 34@set PDP11
2a60a7a8
AM
35@set POWERPC
36@set POWERPC64
49fa1e15 37@set Renesas
b4cbbe8f 38@set S/390
49fa1e15
AM
39@set SPU
40@set TICOFF
2ca22b03 41@set WIN32
e0001a05 42@set XTENSA
0285c67d
NC
43@end ifset
44@c man end
45
9160ea82
AM
46@ifnottex
47@dircategory Software development
48@direntry
252b5132 49* Ld: (ld). The GNU linker.
9160ea82
AM
50@end direntry
51@end ifnottex
252b5132 52
0e9517a9 53@copying
e49e529d
JM
54This file documents the @sc{gnu} linker LD
55@ifset VERSION_PACKAGE
56@value{VERSION_PACKAGE}
57@end ifset
58version @value{VERSION}.
252b5132 59
d87bef3a 60Copyright @copyright{} 1991-2023 Free Software Foundation, Inc.
252b5132 61
cf055d54 62Permission is granted to copy, distribute and/or modify this document
793c5807 63under the terms of the GNU Free Documentation License, Version 1.3
cf055d54
NC
64or any later version published by the Free Software Foundation;
65with no Invariant Sections, with no Front-Cover Texts, and with no
66Back-Cover Texts. A copy of the license is included in the
36f63dca 67section entitled ``GNU Free Documentation License''.
0e9517a9 68@end copying
252b5132
RH
69@iftex
70@finalout
71@setchapternewpage odd
71ba23f6 72@settitle The GNU linker
252b5132 73@titlepage
71ba23f6 74@title The GNU linker
252b5132 75@sp 1
e49e529d
JM
76@subtitle @code{ld}
77@ifset VERSION_PACKAGE
78@subtitle @value{VERSION_PACKAGE}
79@end ifset
252b5132
RH
80@subtitle Version @value{VERSION}
81@author Steve Chamberlain
82@author Ian Lance Taylor
252b5132
RH
83@page
84
85@tex
86{\parskip=0pt
704c465c
NC
87\hfill Red Hat Inc\par
88\hfill nickc\@credhat.com, doc\@redhat.com\par
71ba23f6 89\hfill {\it The GNU linker}\par
252b5132
RH
90\hfill Edited by Jeffrey Osier (jeffrey\@cygnus.com)\par
91}
92\global\parindent=0pt % Steve likes it this way.
93@end tex
94
95@vskip 0pt plus 1filll
0285c67d 96@c man begin COPYRIGHT
d87bef3a 97Copyright @copyright{} 1991-2023 Free Software Foundation, Inc.
252b5132 98
0285c67d 99Permission is granted to copy, distribute and/or modify this document
793c5807 100under the terms of the GNU Free Documentation License, Version 1.3
0285c67d
NC
101or any later version published by the Free Software Foundation;
102with no Invariant Sections, with no Front-Cover Texts, and with no
103Back-Cover Texts. A copy of the license is included in the
36f63dca 104section entitled ``GNU Free Documentation License''.
0285c67d 105@c man end
252b5132 106
252b5132
RH
107@end titlepage
108@end iftex
4ecceb71 109@contents
252b5132
RH
110@c FIXME: Talk about importance of *order* of args, cmds to linker!
111
84ec0e6d 112@ifnottex
252b5132 113@node Top
71ba23f6 114@top LD
e49e529d
JM
115This file documents the @sc{gnu} linker ld
116@ifset VERSION_PACKAGE
117@value{VERSION_PACKAGE}
118@end ifset
119version @value{VERSION}.
252b5132 120
cf055d54 121This document is distributed under the terms of the GNU Free
793c5807
NC
122Documentation License version 1.3. A copy of the license is included
123in the section entitled ``GNU Free Documentation License''.
cf055d54 124
252b5132
RH
125@menu
126* Overview:: Overview
127* Invocation:: Invocation
128* Scripts:: Linker Scripts
bf6d8037 129* Plugins:: Linker Plugins
252b5132
RH
130@ifset GENERIC
131* Machine Dependent:: Machine Dependent Features
132@end ifset
133@ifclear GENERIC
134@ifset H8300
135* H8/300:: ld and the H8/300
136@end ifset
c2dcd04e
NC
137@ifset Renesas
138* Renesas:: ld and other Renesas micros
252b5132 139@end ifset
36f63dca
NC
140@ifset ARM
141* ARM:: ld and the ARM family
142@end ifset
93fd0973
SC
143@ifset M68HC11
144* M68HC11/68HC12:: ld and the Motorola 68HC11 and 68HC12 families
145@end ifset
7ca01ed9
NC
146@ifset HPPA
147* HPPA ELF32:: ld and HPPA 32-bit ELF
148@end ifset
7fb9f789
NC
149@ifset M68K
150* M68K:: ld and Motorola 68K family
151@end ifset
833794fc
MR
152@ifset MIPS
153* MIPS:: ld and MIPS family
154@end ifset
2a60a7a8
AM
155@ifset POWERPC
156* PowerPC ELF32:: ld and PowerPC 32-bit ELF Support
157@end ifset
158@ifset POWERPC64
159* PowerPC64 ELF64:: ld and PowerPC64 64-bit ELF Support
160@end ifset
b4cbbe8f
AK
161@ifset S/390
162* S/390 ELF:: ld and S/390 ELF Support
163@end ifset
49fa1e15
AM
164@ifset SPU
165* SPU ELF:: ld and SPU ELF Support
166@end ifset
74459f0e
TW
167@ifset TICOFF
168* TI COFF:: ld and the TI COFF
169@end ifset
2ca22b03
NC
170@ifset WIN32
171* Win32:: ld and WIN32 (cygwin/mingw)
172@end ifset
e0001a05
NC
173@ifset XTENSA
174* Xtensa:: ld and Xtensa Processors
175@end ifset
252b5132
RH
176@end ifclear
177@ifclear SingleFormat
178* BFD:: BFD
179@end ifclear
180@c Following blank line required for remaining bug in makeinfo conds/menus
181
182* Reporting Bugs:: Reporting Bugs
183* MRI:: MRI Compatible Script Files
704c465c 184* GNU Free Documentation License:: GNU Free Documentation License
370b66a1 185* LD Index:: LD Index
252b5132 186@end menu
84ec0e6d 187@end ifnottex
252b5132
RH
188
189@node Overview
190@chapter Overview
191
192@cindex @sc{gnu} linker
193@cindex what is this?
0285c67d 194
0879a67a 195@ifset man
0285c67d 196@c man begin SYNOPSIS
ff5dcc92 197ld [@b{options}] @var{objfile} @dots{}
0285c67d
NC
198@c man end
199
200@c man begin SEEALSO
201ar(1), nm(1), objcopy(1), objdump(1), readelf(1) and
202the Info entries for @file{binutils} and
203@file{ld}.
204@c man end
205@end ifset
206
207@c man begin DESCRIPTION
208
ff5dcc92 209@command{ld} combines a number of object and archive files, relocates
252b5132 210their data and ties up symbol references. Usually the last step in
ff5dcc92 211compiling a program is to run @command{ld}.
252b5132 212
ff5dcc92 213@command{ld} accepts Linker Command Language files written in
252b5132
RH
214a superset of AT&T's Link Editor Command Language syntax,
215to provide explicit and total control over the linking process.
216
0285c67d
NC
217@ifset man
218@c For the man only
ece2d90e 219This man page does not describe the command language; see the
71ba23f6
NC
220@command{ld} entry in @code{info} for full details on the command
221language and on other aspects of the GNU linker.
0285c67d
NC
222@end ifset
223
252b5132 224@ifclear SingleFormat
ff5dcc92
SC
225This version of @command{ld} uses the general purpose BFD libraries
226to operate on object files. This allows @command{ld} to read, combine, and
252b5132
RH
227write object files in many different formats---for example, COFF or
228@code{a.out}. Different formats may be linked together to produce any
229available kind of object file. @xref{BFD}, for more information.
230@end ifclear
231
232Aside from its flexibility, the @sc{gnu} linker is more helpful than other
233linkers in providing diagnostic information. Many linkers abandon
234execution immediately upon encountering an error; whenever possible,
ff5dcc92 235@command{ld} continues executing, allowing you to identify other errors
252b5132
RH
236(or, in some cases, to get an output file in spite of the error).
237
0285c67d
NC
238@c man end
239
252b5132
RH
240@node Invocation
241@chapter Invocation
242
0285c67d
NC
243@c man begin DESCRIPTION
244
ff5dcc92 245The @sc{gnu} linker @command{ld} is meant to cover a broad range of situations,
252b5132
RH
246and to be as compatible as possible with other linkers. As a result,
247you have many choices to control its behavior.
248
0285c67d
NC
249@c man end
250
252b5132
RH
251@ifset UsesEnvVars
252@menu
a05a5b64 253* Options:: Command-line Options
252b5132
RH
254* Environment:: Environment Variables
255@end menu
256
257@node Options
a05a5b64 258@section Command-line Options
252b5132
RH
259@end ifset
260
261@cindex command line
262@cindex options
0285c67d
NC
263
264@c man begin OPTIONS
265
252b5132
RH
266The linker supports a plethora of command-line options, but in actual
267practice few of them are used in any particular context.
268@cindex standard Unix system
ff5dcc92 269For instance, a frequent use of @command{ld} is to link standard Unix
252b5132
RH
270object files on a standard, supported Unix system. On such a system, to
271link a file @code{hello.o}:
272
273@smallexample
274ld -o @var{output} /lib/crt0.o hello.o -lc
275@end smallexample
276
ff5dcc92 277This tells @command{ld} to produce a file called @var{output} as the
252b5132
RH
278result of linking the file @code{/lib/crt0.o} with @code{hello.o} and
279the library @code{libc.a}, which will come from the standard search
280directories. (See the discussion of the @samp{-l} option below.)
281
ff5dcc92 282Some of the command-line options to @command{ld} may be specified at any
511ab9e9
ILT
283point in the command line. However, options which refer to files, such
284as @samp{-l} or @samp{-T}, cause the file to be read at the point at
285which the option appears in the command line, relative to the object
286files and other file options. Repeating non-file options with a
287different argument will either have no further effect, or override prior
252b5132
RH
288occurrences (those further to the left on the command line) of that
289option. Options which may be meaningfully specified more than once are
290noted in the descriptions below.
291
292@cindex object files
511ab9e9
ILT
293Non-option arguments are object files or archives which are to be linked
294together. They may follow, precede, or be mixed in with command-line
295options, except that an object file argument may not be placed between
296an option and its argument.
252b5132
RH
297
298Usually the linker is invoked with at least one object file, but you can
299specify other forms of binary input files using @samp{-l}, @samp{-R},
300and the script command language. If @emph{no} binary input files at all
301are specified, the linker does not produce any output, and issues the
302message @samp{No input files}.
303
36f63dca 304If the linker cannot recognize the format of an object file, it will
252b5132
RH
305assume that it is a linker script. A script specified in this way
306augments the main linker script used for the link (either the default
307linker script or the one specified by using @samp{-T}). This feature
308permits the linker to link against a file which appears to be an object
309or an archive, but actually merely defines some symbol values, or uses
53d25da6
AM
310@code{INPUT} or @code{GROUP} to load other objects. Specifying a
311script in this way merely augments the main linker script, with the
312extra commands placed after the main script; use the @samp{-T} option
313to replace the default linker script entirely, but note the effect of
314the @code{INSERT} command. @xref{Scripts}.
252b5132
RH
315
316For options whose names are a single letter,
317option arguments must either follow the option letter without intervening
318whitespace, or be given as separate arguments immediately following the
319option that requires them.
320
321For options whose names are multiple letters, either one dash or two can
e4897a32 322precede the option name; for example, @samp{-trace-symbol} and
36f63dca 323@samp{--trace-symbol} are equivalent. Note---there is one exception to
e4897a32 324this rule. Multiple letter options that start with a lower case 'o' can
ba1be17e 325only be preceded by two dashes. This is to reduce confusion with the
e4897a32
NC
326@samp{-o} option. So for example @samp{-omagic} sets the output file
327name to @samp{magic} whereas @samp{--omagic} sets the NMAGIC flag on the
328output.
329
330Arguments to multiple-letter options must either be separated from the
331option name by an equals sign, or be given as separate arguments
332immediately following the option that requires them. For example,
333@samp{--trace-symbol foo} and @samp{--trace-symbol=foo} are equivalent.
334Unique abbreviations of the names of multiple-letter options are
335accepted.
252b5132 336
36f63dca 337Note---if the linker is being invoked indirectly, via a compiler driver
a05a5b64 338(e.g. @samp{gcc}) then all the linker command-line options should be
fa19fce0
NC
339prefixed by @samp{-Wl,} (or whatever is appropriate for the particular
340compiler driver) like this:
4e53152f
NC
341
342@smallexample
2509a395 343 gcc -Wl,--start-group foo.o bar.o -Wl,--end-group
4e53152f
NC
344@end smallexample
345
346This is important, because otherwise the compiler driver program may
2509a395
SL
347silently drop the linker options, resulting in a bad link. Confusion
348may also arise when passing options that require values through a
349driver, as the use of a space between option and argument acts as
350a separator, and causes the driver to pass only the option to the linker
351and the argument to the compiler. In this case, it is simplest to use
352the joined forms of both single- and multiple-letter options, such as:
353
354@smallexample
355 gcc foo.o bar.o -Wl,-eENTRY -Wl,-Map=a.map
356@end smallexample
4e53152f 357
a05a5b64 358Here is a table of the generic command-line switches accepted by the GNU
4e53152f
NC
359linker:
360
ff5dcc92 361@table @gcctabopt
38fc1cb1 362@include at-file.texi
dff70155 363
2509a395
SL
364@kindex -a @var{keyword}
365@item -a @var{keyword}
252b5132
RH
366This option is supported for HP/UX compatibility. The @var{keyword}
367argument must be one of the strings @samp{archive}, @samp{shared}, or
368@samp{default}. @samp{-aarchive} is functionally equivalent to
369@samp{-Bstatic}, and the other two keywords are functionally equivalent
370to @samp{-Bdynamic}. This option may be used any number of times.
371
7ee314fa
AM
372@kindex --audit @var{AUDITLIB}
373@item --audit @var{AUDITLIB}
374Adds @var{AUDITLIB} to the @code{DT_AUDIT} entry of the dynamic section.
375@var{AUDITLIB} is not checked for existence, nor will it use the DT_SONAME
376specified in the library. If specified multiple times @code{DT_AUDIT}
377will contain a colon separated list of audit interfaces to use. If the linker
378finds an object with an audit entry while searching for shared libraries,
9d5777a3 379it will add a corresponding @code{DT_DEPAUDIT} entry in the output file.
7ee314fa 380This option is only meaningful on ELF platforms supporting the rtld-audit
9d5777a3 381interface.
7ee314fa 382
252b5132
RH
383@ifclear SingleFormat
384@cindex binary input format
385@kindex -b @var{format}
386@kindex --format=@var{format}
387@cindex input format
388@cindex input format
389@item -b @var{input-format}
390@itemx --format=@var{input-format}
ff5dcc92
SC
391@command{ld} may be configured to support more than one kind of object
392file. If your @command{ld} is configured this way, you can use the
252b5132 393@samp{-b} option to specify the binary format for input object files
ff5dcc92 394that follow this option on the command line. Even when @command{ld} is
252b5132 395configured to support alternative object formats, you don't usually need
ff5dcc92 396to specify this, as @command{ld} should be configured to expect as a
252b5132
RH
397default input format the most usual format on each machine.
398@var{input-format} is a text string, the name of a particular format
399supported by the BFD libraries. (You can list the available binary
400formats with @samp{objdump -i}.)
401@xref{BFD}.
402
403You may want to use this option if you are linking files with an unusual
404binary format. You can also use @samp{-b} to switch formats explicitly (when
405linking object files of different formats), by including
406@samp{-b @var{input-format}} before each group of object files in a
a1ab1d2a 407particular format.
252b5132
RH
408
409The default format is taken from the environment variable
410@code{GNUTARGET}.
411@ifset UsesEnvVars
412@xref{Environment}.
413@end ifset
414You can also define the input format from a script, using the command
0285c67d
NC
415@code{TARGET};
416@ifclear man
417see @ref{Format Commands}.
418@end ifclear
252b5132
RH
419@end ifclear
420
421@kindex -c @var{MRI-cmdfile}
422@kindex --mri-script=@var{MRI-cmdfile}
423@cindex compatibility, MRI
424@item -c @var{MRI-commandfile}
425@itemx --mri-script=@var{MRI-commandfile}
ff5dcc92 426For compatibility with linkers produced by MRI, @command{ld} accepts script
252b5132 427files written in an alternate, restricted command language, described in
0285c67d
NC
428@ifclear man
429@ref{MRI,,MRI Compatible Script Files}.
430@end ifclear
431@ifset man
432the MRI Compatible Script Files section of GNU ld documentation.
433@end ifset
434Introduce MRI script files with
252b5132 435the option @samp{-c}; use the @samp{-T} option to run linker
ff5dcc92
SC
436scripts written in the general-purpose @command{ld} scripting language.
437If @var{MRI-cmdfile} does not exist, @command{ld} looks for it in the directories
252b5132
RH
438specified by any @samp{-L} options.
439
440@cindex common allocation
441@kindex -d
442@kindex -dc
443@kindex -dp
a1ab1d2a 444@item -d
252b5132
RH
445@itemx -dc
446@itemx -dp
447These three options are equivalent; multiple forms are supported for
448compatibility with other linkers. They assign space to common symbols
449even if a relocatable output file is specified (with @samp{-r}). The
450script command @code{FORCE_COMMON_ALLOCATION} has the same effect.
451@xref{Miscellaneous Commands}.
452
7ee314fa
AM
453@kindex --depaudit @var{AUDITLIB}
454@kindex -P @var{AUDITLIB}
455@item --depaudit @var{AUDITLIB}
456@itemx -P @var{AUDITLIB}
457Adds @var{AUDITLIB} to the @code{DT_DEPAUDIT} entry of the dynamic section.
458@var{AUDITLIB} is not checked for existence, nor will it use the DT_SONAME
459specified in the library. If specified multiple times @code{DT_DEPAUDIT}
460will contain a colon separated list of audit interfaces to use. This
461option is only meaningful on ELF platforms supporting the rtld-audit interface.
9d5777a3 462The -P option is provided for Solaris compatibility.
7ee314fa 463
abf874aa
CL
464@kindex --enable-non-contiguous-regions
465@item --enable-non-contiguous-regions
466This option avoids generating an error if an input section does not
467fit a matching output section. The linker tries to allocate the input
468section to subseque nt matching output sections, and generates an
469error only if no output section is large enough. This is useful when
470several non-contiguous memory regions are available and the input
471section does not require a particular one. The order in which input
472sections are evaluated does not change, for instance:
473
474@smallexample
475 MEMORY @{
476 MEM1 (rwx) : ORIGIN : 0x1000, LENGTH = 0x14
477 MEM2 (rwx) : ORIGIN : 0x1000, LENGTH = 0x40
478 MEM3 (rwx) : ORIGIN : 0x2000, LENGTH = 0x40
479 @}
480 SECTIONS @{
481 mem1 : @{ *(.data.*); @} > MEM1
482 mem2 : @{ *(.data.*); @} > MEM2
483 mem3 : @{ *(.data.*); @} > MEM2
484 @}
485
486 with input sections:
487 .data.1: size 8
488 .data.2: size 0x10
489 .data.3: size 4
490
491 results in .data.1 affected to mem1, and .data.2 and .data.3
492 affected to mem2, even though .data.3 would fit in mem3.
493@end smallexample
494
495This option is incompatible with INSERT statements because it changes
496the way input sections are mapped to output sections.
497
498@kindex --enable-non-contiguous-regions-warnings
499@item --enable-non-contiguous-regions-warnings
500This option enables warnings when
501@code{--enable-non-contiguous-regions} allows possibly unexpected
502matches in sections mapping, potentially leading to silently
503discarding a section instead of failing because it does not fit any
504output region.
505
252b5132
RH
506@cindex entry point, from command line
507@kindex -e @var{entry}
508@kindex --entry=@var{entry}
a1ab1d2a 509@item -e @var{entry}
252b5132
RH
510@itemx --entry=@var{entry}
511Use @var{entry} as the explicit symbol for beginning execution of your
512program, rather than the default entry point. If there is no symbol
513named @var{entry}, the linker will try to parse @var{entry} as a number,
514and use that as the entry address (the number will be interpreted in
515base 10; you may use a leading @samp{0x} for base 16, or a leading
516@samp{0} for base 8). @xref{Entry Point}, for a discussion of defaults
517and other ways of specifying the entry point.
518
b58f81ae
DJ
519@kindex --exclude-libs
520@item --exclude-libs @var{lib},@var{lib},...
521Specifies a list of archive libraries from which symbols should not be automatically
e1c37eb5 522exported. The library names may be delimited by commas or colons. Specifying
b58f81ae
DJ
523@code{--exclude-libs ALL} excludes symbols in all archive libraries from
524automatic export. This option is available only for the i386 PE targeted
525port of the linker and for ELF targeted ports. For i386 PE, symbols
526explicitly listed in a .def file are still exported, regardless of this
527option. For ELF targeted ports, symbols affected by this option will
528be treated as hidden.
529
e1c37eb5
DK
530@kindex --exclude-modules-for-implib
531@item --exclude-modules-for-implib @var{module},@var{module},...
532Specifies a list of object files or archive members, from which symbols
533should not be automatically exported, but which should be copied wholesale
534into the import library being generated during the link. The module names
535may be delimited by commas or colons, and must match exactly the filenames
536used by @command{ld} to open the files; for archive members, this is simply
537the member name, but for object files the name listed must include and
538match precisely any path used to specify the input file on the linker's
539command-line. This option is available only for the i386 PE targeted port
540of the linker. Symbols explicitly listed in a .def file are still exported,
541regardless of this option.
542
252b5132
RH
543@cindex dynamic symbol table
544@kindex -E
545@kindex --export-dynamic
267e2722 546@kindex --no-export-dynamic
252b5132
RH
547@item -E
548@itemx --export-dynamic
267e2722
CD
549@itemx --no-export-dynamic
550When creating a dynamically linked executable, using the @option{-E}
551option or the @option{--export-dynamic} option causes the linker to add
552all symbols to the dynamic symbol table. The dynamic symbol table is the
553set of symbols which are visible from dynamic objects at run time.
554
555If you do not use either of these options (or use the
556@option{--no-export-dynamic} option to restore the default behavior), the
557dynamic symbol table will normally contain only those symbols which are
558referenced by some dynamic object mentioned in the link.
252b5132
RH
559
560If you use @code{dlopen} to load a dynamic object which needs to refer
561back to the symbols defined by the program, rather than some other
562dynamic object, then you will probably need to use this option when
563linking the program itself.
564
55255dae 565You can also use the dynamic list to control what symbols should
cb840a31 566be added to the dynamic symbol table if the output format supports it.
55255dae 567See the description of @samp{--dynamic-list}.
cb840a31 568
8b747e1a
DK
569Note that this option is specific to ELF targeted ports. PE targets
570support a similar function to export all symbols from a DLL or EXE; see
571the description of @samp{--export-all-symbols} below.
572
37a141bf
FS
573@kindex --export-dynamic-symbol=@var{glob}
574@cindex export dynamic symbol
575@item --export-dynamic-symbol=@var{glob}
576When creating a dynamically linked executable, symbols matching
577@var{glob} will be added to the dynamic symbol table. When creating a
578shared library, references to symbols matching @var{glob} will not be
579bound to the definitions within the shared library. This option is a
580no-op when creating a shared library and @samp{-Bsymbolic} or
581@samp{--dynamic-list} are not specified. This option is only meaningful
582on ELF platforms which support shared libraries.
583
584@kindex --export-dynamic-symbol-list=@var{file}
585@cindex export dynamic symbol list
586@item --export-dynamic-symbol-list=@var{file}
587Specify a @samp{--export-dynamic-symbol} for each pattern in the file.
588The format of the file is the same as the version node without
589scope and node name. See @ref{VERSION} for more information.
590
36f63dca 591@ifclear SingleFormat
252b5132
RH
592@cindex big-endian objects
593@cindex endianness
594@kindex -EB
595@item -EB
596Link big-endian objects. This affects the default output format.
597
598@cindex little-endian objects
599@kindex -EL
600@item -EL
601Link little-endian objects. This affects the default output format.
36f63dca 602@end ifclear
252b5132 603
2509a395
SL
604@kindex -f @var{name}
605@kindex --auxiliary=@var{name}
606@item -f @var{name}
607@itemx --auxiliary=@var{name}
252b5132
RH
608When creating an ELF shared object, set the internal DT_AUXILIARY field
609to the specified name. This tells the dynamic linker that the symbol
610table of the shared object should be used as an auxiliary filter on the
611symbol table of the shared object @var{name}.
612
613If you later link a program against this filter object, then, when you
614run the program, the dynamic linker will see the DT_AUXILIARY field. If
615the dynamic linker resolves any symbols from the filter object, it will
616first check whether there is a definition in the shared object
617@var{name}. If there is one, it will be used instead of the definition
618in the filter object. The shared object @var{name} need not exist.
619Thus the shared object @var{name} may be used to provide an alternative
620implementation of certain functions, perhaps for debugging or for
a094d01f 621machine-specific performance.
252b5132
RH
622
623This option may be specified more than once. The DT_AUXILIARY entries
624will be created in the order in which they appear on the command line.
625
2509a395
SL
626@kindex -F @var{name}
627@kindex --filter=@var{name}
252b5132 628@item -F @var{name}
2509a395 629@itemx --filter=@var{name}
252b5132
RH
630When creating an ELF shared object, set the internal DT_FILTER field to
631the specified name. This tells the dynamic linker that the symbol table
632of the shared object which is being created should be used as a filter
633on the symbol table of the shared object @var{name}.
634
635If you later link a program against this filter object, then, when you
636run the program, the dynamic linker will see the DT_FILTER field. The
637dynamic linker will resolve symbols according to the symbol table of the
638filter object as usual, but it will actually link to the definitions
639found in the shared object @var{name}. Thus the filter object can be
640used to select a subset of the symbols provided by the object
641@var{name}.
642
ff5dcc92 643Some older linkers used the @option{-F} option throughout a compilation
252b5132 644toolchain for specifying object-file format for both input and output
36f63dca
NC
645object files.
646@ifclear SingleFormat
647The @sc{gnu} linker uses other mechanisms for this purpose: the
ece2d90e 648@option{-b}, @option{--format}, @option{--oformat} options, the
252b5132 649@code{TARGET} command in linker scripts, and the @code{GNUTARGET}
36f63dca
NC
650environment variable.
651@end ifclear
652The @sc{gnu} linker will ignore the @option{-F} option when not
653creating an ELF shared object.
252b5132 654
3dbf70a2 655@cindex finalization function
2509a395
SL
656@kindex -fini=@var{name}
657@item -fini=@var{name}
3dbf70a2
MM
658When creating an ELF executable or shared object, call NAME when the
659executable or shared object is unloaded, by setting DT_FINI to the
660address of the function. By default, the linker uses @code{_fini} as
661the function to call.
662
252b5132
RH
663@kindex -g
664@item -g
665Ignored. Provided for compatibility with other tools.
666
2509a395
SL
667@kindex -G @var{value}
668@kindex --gpsize=@var{value}
252b5132 669@cindex object size
2509a395 670@item -G @var{value}
252b5132
RH
671@itemx --gpsize=@var{value}
672Set the maximum size of objects to be optimized using the GP register to
673@var{size}. This is only meaningful for object file formats such as
e8044f35 674MIPS ELF that support putting large and small objects into different
252b5132
RH
675sections. This is ignored for other object file formats.
676
677@cindex runtime library name
2509a395 678@kindex -h @var{name}
252b5132 679@kindex -soname=@var{name}
2509a395 680@item -h @var{name}
252b5132
RH
681@itemx -soname=@var{name}
682When creating an ELF shared object, set the internal DT_SONAME field to
683the specified name. When an executable is linked with a shared object
684which has a DT_SONAME field, then when the executable is run the dynamic
685linker will attempt to load the shared object specified by the DT_SONAME
010e444b 686field rather than using the file name given to the linker.
252b5132
RH
687
688@kindex -i
689@cindex incremental link
690@item -i
691Perform an incremental link (same as option @samp{-r}).
692
3dbf70a2 693@cindex initialization function
2509a395
SL
694@kindex -init=@var{name}
695@item -init=@var{name}
3dbf70a2
MM
696When creating an ELF executable or shared object, call NAME when the
697executable or shared object is loaded, by setting DT_INIT to the address
698of the function. By default, the linker uses @code{_init} as the
699function to call.
700
252b5132 701@cindex archive files, from cmd line
2509a395 702@kindex -l @var{namespec}
bcb674cf 703@kindex --library=@var{namespec}
2509a395 704@item -l @var{namespec}
bcb674cf
RS
705@itemx --library=@var{namespec}
706Add the archive or object file specified by @var{namespec} to the
707list of files to link. This option may be used any number of times.
708If @var{namespec} is of the form @file{:@var{filename}}, @command{ld}
07d8eb55 709will search the library path for a file called @var{filename}, otherwise it
bcb674cf 710will search the library path for a file called @file{lib@var{namespec}.a}.
252b5132 711
ff5dcc92 712On systems which support shared libraries, @command{ld} may also search for
bcb674cf
RS
713files other than @file{lib@var{namespec}.a}. Specifically, on ELF
714and SunOS systems, @command{ld} will search a directory for a library
715called @file{lib@var{namespec}.so} before searching for one called
716@file{lib@var{namespec}.a}. (By convention, a @code{.so} extension
717indicates a shared library.) Note that this behavior does not apply
718to @file{:@var{filename}}, which always specifies a file called
719@var{filename}.
252b5132
RH
720
721The linker will search an archive only once, at the location where it is
722specified on the command line. If the archive defines a symbol which
723was undefined in some object which appeared before the archive on the
724command line, the linker will include the appropriate file(s) from the
725archive. However, an undefined symbol in an object appearing later on
726the command line will not cause the linker to search the archive again.
727
ff5dcc92 728See the @option{-(} option for a way to force the linker to search
252b5132
RH
729archives multiple times.
730
731You may list the same archive multiple times on the command line.
732
733@ifset GENERIC
734This type of archive searching is standard for Unix linkers. However,
ff5dcc92 735if you are using @command{ld} on AIX, note that it is different from the
252b5132
RH
736behaviour of the AIX linker.
737@end ifset
738
739@cindex search directory, from cmd line
2509a395 740@kindex -L @var{dir}
252b5132 741@kindex --library-path=@var{dir}
2509a395 742@item -L @var{searchdir}
252b5132 743@itemx --library-path=@var{searchdir}
ff5dcc92
SC
744Add path @var{searchdir} to the list of paths that @command{ld} will search
745for archive libraries and @command{ld} control scripts. You may use this
252b5132
RH
746option any number of times. The directories are searched in the order
747in which they are specified on the command line. Directories specified
748on the command line are searched before the default directories. All
ff5dcc92 749@option{-L} options apply to all @option{-l} options, regardless of the
7d24f02c
KH
750order in which the options appear. @option{-L} options do not affect
751how @command{ld} searches for a linker script unless @option{-T}
752option is specified.
252b5132 753
3aa2d05a
NC
754If @var{searchdir} begins with @code{=} or @code{$SYSROOT}, then this
755prefix will be replaced by the @dfn{sysroot prefix}, controlled by the
756@samp{--sysroot} option, or specified when the linker is configured.
9c8ebd6a 757
252b5132
RH
758@ifset UsesEnvVars
759The default set of paths searched (without being specified with
ff5dcc92 760@samp{-L}) depends on which emulation mode @command{ld} is using, and in
252b5132
RH
761some cases also on how it was configured. @xref{Environment}.
762@end ifset
763
764The paths can also be specified in a link script with the
765@code{SEARCH_DIR} command. Directories specified this way are searched
766at the point in which the linker script appears in the command line.
767
768@cindex emulation
769@kindex -m @var{emulation}
2509a395 770@item -m @var{emulation}
252b5132
RH
771Emulate the @var{emulation} linker. You can list the available
772emulations with the @samp{--verbose} or @samp{-V} options.
773
774If the @samp{-m} option is not used, the emulation is taken from the
775@code{LDEMULATION} environment variable, if that is defined.
776
777Otherwise, the default emulation depends upon how the linker was
778configured.
779
780@cindex link map
781@kindex -M
782@kindex --print-map
783@item -M
784@itemx --print-map
785Print a link map to the standard output. A link map provides
786information about the link, including the following:
787
788@itemize @bullet
789@item
3b83e13a 790Where object files are mapped into memory.
252b5132
RH
791@item
792How common symbols are allocated.
793@item
794All archive members included in the link, with a mention of the symbol
795which caused the archive member to be brought in.
3b83e13a
NC
796@item
797The values assigned to symbols.
798
799Note - symbols whose values are computed by an expression which
800involves a reference to a previous value of the same symbol may not
801have correct result displayed in the link map. This is because the
802linker discards intermediate results and only retains the final value
803of an expression. Under such circumstances the linker will display
804the final value enclosed by square brackets. Thus for example a
805linker script containing:
806
807@smallexample
808 foo = 1
809 foo = foo * 4
810 foo = foo + 8
811@end smallexample
812
813will produce the following output in the link map if the @option{-M}
814option is used:
815
816@smallexample
817 0x00000001 foo = 0x1
818 [0x0000000c] foo = (foo * 0x4)
819 [0x0000000c] foo = (foo + 0x8)
820@end smallexample
821
822See @ref{Expressions} for more information about expressions in linker
823scripts.
d2ef37eb 824
06ddcada
AM
825@item
826How GNU properties are merged.
d2ef37eb 827
06ddcada
AM
828When the linker merges input .note.gnu.property sections into one output
829.note.gnu.property section, some properties are removed or updated.
830These actions are reported in the link map. For example:
d2ef37eb
L
831
832@smallexample
833Removed property 0xc0000002 to merge foo.o (0x1) and bar.o (not found)
834@end smallexample
835
06ddcada 836This indicates that property 0xc0000002 is removed from output when
d2ef37eb
L
837merging properties in @file{foo.o}, whose property 0xc0000002 value
838is 0x1, and @file{bar.o}, which doesn't have property 0xc0000002.
839
840@smallexample
06ddcada 841Updated property 0xc0010001 (0x1) to merge foo.o (0x1) and bar.o (0x1)
d2ef37eb
L
842@end smallexample
843
06ddcada 844This indicates that property 0xc0010001 value is updated to 0x1 in output
d2ef37eb
L
845when merging properties in @file{foo.o}, whose 0xc0010001 property value
846is 0x1, and @file{bar.o}, whose 0xc0010001 property value is 0x1.
252b5132
RH
847@end itemize
848
035801ce
FS
849@cindex link map discarded
850@kindex --print-map-discarded
851@kindex --no-print-map-discarded
852@item --print-map-discarded
853@itemx --no-print-map-discarded
854Print (or do not print) the list of discarded and garbage collected sections
855in the link map. Enabled by default.
856
252b5132
RH
857@kindex -n
858@cindex read-only text
859@cindex NMAGIC
860@kindex --nmagic
861@item -n
862@itemx --nmagic
90f5d9d9
JZ
863Turn off page alignment of sections, and disable linking against shared
864libraries. If the output format supports Unix style magic numbers,
865mark the output as @code{NMAGIC}.
252b5132
RH
866
867@kindex -N
868@kindex --omagic
869@cindex read/write from cmd line
870@cindex OMAGIC
a1ab1d2a 871@item -N
252b5132
RH
872@itemx --omagic
873Set the text and data sections to be readable and writable. Also, do
63fd3b82
NC
874not page-align the data segment, and disable linking against shared
875libraries. If the output format supports Unix style magic numbers,
4d8907ac
DS
876mark the output as @code{OMAGIC}. Note: Although a writable text section
877is allowed for PE-COFF targets, it does not conform to the format
878specification published by Microsoft.
63fd3b82
NC
879
880@kindex --no-omagic
881@cindex OMAGIC
882@item --no-omagic
883This option negates most of the effects of the @option{-N} option. It
884sets the text section to be read-only, and forces the data segment to
885be page-aligned. Note - this option does not enable linking against
886shared libraries. Use @option{-Bdynamic} for this.
252b5132
RH
887
888@kindex -o @var{output}
889@kindex --output=@var{output}
890@cindex naming the output file
891@item -o @var{output}
892@itemx --output=@var{output}
ff5dcc92 893Use @var{output} as the name for the program produced by @command{ld}; if this
252b5132
RH
894option is not specified, the name @file{a.out} is used by default. The
895script command @code{OUTPUT} can also specify the output file name.
896
f37b21b4
RM
897@kindex --dependency-file=@var{depfile}
898@cindex dependency file
899@item --dependency-file=@var{depfile}
900Write a @dfn{dependency file} to @var{depfile}. This file contains a rule
901suitable for @code{make} describing the output file and all the input files
902that were read to produce it. The output is similar to the compiler's
903output with @samp{-M -MP} (@pxref{Preprocessor Options,, Options
904Controlling the Preprocessor, gcc.info, Using the GNU Compiler
905Collection}). Note that there is no option like the compiler's @samp{-MM},
906to exclude ``system files'' (which is not a well-specified concept in the
907linker, unlike ``system headers'' in the compiler). So the output from
908@samp{--dependency-file} is always specific to the exact state of the
909installation where it was produced, and should not be copied into
910distributed makefiles without careful editing.
911
252b5132
RH
912@kindex -O @var{level}
913@cindex generating optimized output
914@item -O @var{level}
ff5dcc92 915If @var{level} is a numeric values greater than zero @command{ld} optimizes
252b5132 916the output. This might take significantly longer and therefore probably
98c503ac
NC
917should only be enabled for the final binary. At the moment this
918option only affects ELF shared library generation. Future releases of
919the linker may make more use of this option. Also currently there is
920no difference in the linker's behaviour for different non-zero values
921of this option. Again this may change with future releases.
252b5132 922
387dd777
DP
923@kindex -plugin @var{name}
924@item -plugin @var{name}
925Involve a plugin in the linking process. The @var{name} parameter is
926the absolute filename of the plugin. Usually this parameter is
927automatically added by the complier, when using link time
928optimization, but users can also add their own plugins if they so
929wish.
930
931Note that the location of the compiler originated plugins is different
932from the place where the @command{ar}, @command{nm} and
933@command{ranlib} programs search for their plugins. In order for
934those commands to make use of a compiler based plugin it must first be
41f37a6f 935copied into the @file{$@{libdir@}/bfd-plugins} directory. All gcc
387dd777 936based linker plugins are backward compatible, so it is sufficient to
6c19b93b 937just copy in the newest one.
387dd777 938
26278bb8
UD
939@kindex --push-state
940@cindex push state governing input file handling
941@item --push-state
f9a6a8f0 942The @option{--push-state} allows one to preserve the current state of the
26278bb8
UD
943flags which govern the input file handling so that they can all be
944restored with one corresponding @option{--pop-state} option.
945
946The option which are covered are: @option{-Bdynamic}, @option{-Bstatic},
947@option{-dn}, @option{-dy}, @option{-call_shared}, @option{-non_shared},
948@option{-static}, @option{-N}, @option{-n}, @option{--whole-archive},
949@option{--no-whole-archive}, @option{-r}, @option{-Ur},
950@option{--copy-dt-needed-entries}, @option{--no-copy-dt-needed-entries},
951@option{--as-needed}, @option{--no-as-needed}, and @option{-a}.
952
953One target for this option are specifications for @file{pkg-config}. When
954used with the @option{--libs} option all possibly needed libraries are
955listed and then possibly linked with all the time. It is better to return
956something as follows:
957
958@smallexample
959-Wl,--push-state,--as-needed -libone -libtwo -Wl,--pop-state
960@end smallexample
961
962@kindex --pop-state
963@cindex pop state governing input file handling
67cecaba 964@item --pop-state
26278bb8
UD
965Undoes the effect of --push-state, restores the previous values of the
966flags governing input file handling.
967
a712da20
NC
968@kindex -q
969@kindex --emit-relocs
970@cindex retain relocations in final executable
971@item -q
972@itemx --emit-relocs
ba1be17e 973Leave relocation sections and contents in fully linked executables.
a712da20
NC
974Post link analysis and optimization tools may need this information in
975order to perform correct modifications of executables. This results
976in larger executables.
977
dbab7a7b
NC
978This option is currently only supported on ELF platforms.
979
4f471f39
RS
980@kindex --force-dynamic
981@cindex forcing the creation of dynamic sections
982@item --force-dynamic
983Force the output file to have dynamic sections. This option is specific
984to VxWorks targets.
985
252b5132
RH
986@cindex partial link
987@cindex relocatable output
988@kindex -r
1049f94e 989@kindex --relocatable
252b5132 990@item -r
1049f94e 991@itemx --relocatable
252b5132 992Generate relocatable output---i.e., generate an output file that can in
ff5dcc92 993turn serve as input to @command{ld}. This is often called @dfn{partial
252b5132
RH
994linking}. As a side effect, in environments that support standard Unix
995magic numbers, this option also sets the output file's magic number to
996@code{OMAGIC}.
ff5dcc92 997@c ; see @option{-N}.
252b5132
RH
998If this option is not specified, an absolute file is produced. When
999linking C++ programs, this option @emph{will not} resolve references to
1000constructors; to do that, use @samp{-Ur}.
1001
62bf86b4
HPN
1002When an input file does not have the same format as the output file,
1003partial linking is only supported if that input file does not contain any
1004relocations. Different output formats can have further restrictions; for
1005example some @code{a.out}-based formats do not support partial linking
1006with input files in other formats at all.
1007
252b5132
RH
1008This option does the same thing as @samp{-i}.
1009
1010@kindex -R @var{file}
1011@kindex --just-symbols=@var{file}
1012@cindex symbol-only input
1013@item -R @var{filename}
1014@itemx --just-symbols=@var{filename}
1015Read symbol names and their addresses from @var{filename}, but do not
1016relocate it or include it in the output. This allows your output file
1017to refer symbolically to absolute locations of memory defined in other
1018programs. You may use this option more than once.
1019
ff5dcc92 1020For compatibility with other ELF linkers, if the @option{-R} option is
252b5132 1021followed by a directory name, rather than a file name, it is treated as
ff5dcc92 1022the @option{-rpath} option.
252b5132
RH
1023
1024@kindex -s
1025@kindex --strip-all
1026@cindex strip all symbols
a1ab1d2a 1027@item -s
252b5132
RH
1028@itemx --strip-all
1029Omit all symbol information from the output file.
1030
1031@kindex -S
1032@kindex --strip-debug
1033@cindex strip debugger symbols
a1ab1d2a 1034@item -S
252b5132
RH
1035@itemx --strip-debug
1036Omit debugger symbol information (but not all symbols) from the output file.
1037
a70f34c0
NC
1038@kindex --strip-discarded
1039@kindex --no-strip-discarded
1040@item --strip-discarded
1041@itemx --no-strip-discarded
1042Omit (or do not omit) global symbols defined in discarded sections.
1043Enabled by default.
1044
252b5132
RH
1045@kindex -t
1046@kindex --trace
1047@cindex input files, displaying
a1ab1d2a 1048@item -t
252b5132 1049@itemx --trace
4f4690cd
AM
1050Print the names of the input files as @command{ld} processes them. If
1051@samp{-t} is given twice then members within archives are also printed.
1052@samp{-t} output is useful to generate a list of all the object files
1053and scripts involved in linking, for example, when packaging files for
1054a linker bug report.
252b5132
RH
1055
1056@kindex -T @var{script}
1057@kindex --script=@var{script}
1058@cindex script files
1059@item -T @var{scriptfile}
1060@itemx --script=@var{scriptfile}
1061Use @var{scriptfile} as the linker script. This script replaces
ff5dcc92 1062@command{ld}'s default linker script (rather than adding to it), so
252b5132 1063@var{commandfile} must specify everything necessary to describe the
114283d8
NC
1064output file. @xref{Scripts}. If @var{scriptfile} does not exist in
1065the current directory, @code{ld} looks for it in the directories
1066specified by any preceding @samp{-L} options. Multiple @samp{-T}
1067options accumulate.
252b5132 1068
14be8564
L
1069@kindex -dT @var{script}
1070@kindex --default-script=@var{script}
1071@cindex script files
1072@item -dT @var{scriptfile}
1073@itemx --default-script=@var{scriptfile}
1074Use @var{scriptfile} as the default linker script. @xref{Scripts}.
1075
1076This option is similar to the @option{--script} option except that
1077processing of the script is delayed until after the rest of the
1078command line has been processed. This allows options placed after the
1079@option{--default-script} option on the command line to affect the
1080behaviour of the linker script, which can be important when the linker
1081command line cannot be directly controlled by the user. (eg because
1082the command line is being constructed by another tool, such as
1083@samp{gcc}).
1084
252b5132
RH
1085@kindex -u @var{symbol}
1086@kindex --undefined=@var{symbol}
1087@cindex undefined symbol
1088@item -u @var{symbol}
1089@itemx --undefined=@var{symbol}
1090Force @var{symbol} to be entered in the output file as an undefined
1091symbol. Doing this may, for example, trigger linking of additional
1092modules from standard libraries. @samp{-u} may be repeated with
1093different option arguments to enter additional undefined symbols. This
1094option is equivalent to the @code{EXTERN} linker script command.
1095
0a618243
AB
1096If this option is being used to force additional modules to be pulled
1097into the link, and if it is an error for the symbol to remain
1098undefined, then the option @option{--require-defined} should be used
1099instead.
1100
1101@kindex --require-defined=@var{symbol}
1102@cindex symbols, require defined
1103@cindex defined symbol
1104@item --require-defined=@var{symbol}
1105Require that @var{symbol} is defined in the output file. This option
1106is the same as option @option{--undefined} except that if @var{symbol}
1107is not defined in the output file then the linker will issue an error
1108and exit. The same effect can be achieved in a linker script by using
1109@code{EXTERN}, @code{ASSERT} and @code{DEFINED} together. This option
1110can be used multiple times to require additional symbols.
1111
252b5132
RH
1112@kindex -Ur
1113@cindex constructors
a1ab1d2a 1114@item -Ur
252b5132
RH
1115For anything other than C++ programs, this option is equivalent to
1116@samp{-r}: it generates relocatable output---i.e., an output file that can in
ff5dcc92 1117turn serve as input to @command{ld}. When linking C++ programs, @samp{-Ur}
252b5132
RH
1118@emph{does} resolve references to constructors, unlike @samp{-r}.
1119It does not work to use @samp{-Ur} on files that were themselves linked
1120with @samp{-Ur}; once the constructor table has been built, it cannot
1121be added to. Use @samp{-Ur} only for the last partial link, and
1122@samp{-r} for the others.
1123
c005eb9e
AB
1124@kindex --orphan-handling=@var{MODE}
1125@cindex orphan sections
1126@cindex sections, orphan
1127@item --orphan-handling=@var{MODE}
1128Control how orphan sections are handled. An orphan section is one not
1129specifically mentioned in a linker script. @xref{Orphan Sections}.
1130
1131@var{MODE} can have any of the following values:
1132
1133@table @code
1134@item place
1135Orphan sections are placed into a suitable output section following
1136the strategy described in @ref{Orphan Sections}. The option
d2732b69 1137@samp{--unique} also affects how sections are placed.
c005eb9e
AB
1138
1139@item discard
1140All orphan sections are discarded, by placing them in the
1141@samp{/DISCARD/} section (@pxref{Output Section Discarding}).
1142
1143@item warn
1144The linker will place the orphan section as for @code{place} and also
1145issue a warning.
1146
1147@item error
1148The linker will exit with an error if any orphan section is found.
1149@end table
1150
1151The default if @samp{--orphan-handling} is not given is @code{place}.
1152
577a0623
AM
1153@kindex --unique[=@var{SECTION}]
1154@item --unique[=@var{SECTION}]
1155Creates a separate output section for every input section matching
1156@var{SECTION}, or if the optional wildcard @var{SECTION} argument is
1157missing, for every orphan input section. An orphan section is one not
1158specifically mentioned in a linker script. You may use this option
1159multiple times on the command line; It prevents the normal merging of
1160input sections with the same name, overriding output section assignments
1161in a linker script.
a854a4a7 1162
252b5132
RH
1163@kindex -v
1164@kindex -V
1165@kindex --version
1166@cindex version
1167@item -v
1168@itemx --version
1169@itemx -V
ff5dcc92 1170Display the version number for @command{ld}. The @option{-V} option also
252b5132
RH
1171lists the supported emulations.
1172
1173@kindex -x
1174@kindex --discard-all
1175@cindex deleting local symbols
1176@item -x
1177@itemx --discard-all
1178Delete all local symbols.
1179
1180@kindex -X
1181@kindex --discard-locals
1182@cindex local symbols, deleting
a1ab1d2a 1183@item -X
252b5132 1184@itemx --discard-locals
3c68c38f
BW
1185Delete all temporary local symbols. (These symbols start with
1186system-specific local label prefixes, typically @samp{.L} for ELF systems
1187or @samp{L} for traditional a.out systems.)
252b5132
RH
1188
1189@kindex -y @var{symbol}
1190@kindex --trace-symbol=@var{symbol}
1191@cindex symbol tracing
1192@item -y @var{symbol}
1193@itemx --trace-symbol=@var{symbol}
1194Print the name of each linked file in which @var{symbol} appears. This
1195option may be given any number of times. On many systems it is necessary
1196to prepend an underscore.
1197
1198This option is useful when you have an undefined symbol in your link but
1199don't know where the reference is coming from.
1200
1201@kindex -Y @var{path}
1202@item -Y @var{path}
1203Add @var{path} to the default library search path. This option exists
1204for Solaris compatibility.
1205
1206@kindex -z @var{keyword}
1207@item -z @var{keyword}
cd6d6c15
NC
1208The recognized keywords are:
1209@table @samp
1210
e6e2dfbd
AM
1211@item call-nop=prefix-addr
1212@itemx call-nop=suffix-nop
1213@itemx call-nop=prefix-@var{byte}
1214@itemx call-nop=suffix-@var{byte}
1215Specify the 1-byte @code{NOP} padding when transforming indirect call
1216to a locally defined function, foo, via its GOT slot.
1217@option{call-nop=prefix-addr} generates @code{0x67 call foo}.
1218@option{call-nop=suffix-nop} generates @code{call foo 0x90}.
1219@option{call-nop=prefix-@var{byte}} generates @code{@var{byte} call foo}.
1220@option{call-nop=suffix-@var{byte}} generates @code{call foo @var{byte}}.
1221Supported for i386 and x86_64.
1222
233a0083
L
1223@item cet-report=none
1224@itemx cet-report=warning
1225@itemx cet-report=error
1226Specify how to report the missing GNU_PROPERTY_X86_FEATURE_1_IBT and
1227GNU_PROPERTY_X86_FEATURE_1_SHSTK properties in input .note.gnu.property
1228section. @option{cet-report=none}, which is the default, will make the
1229linker not report missing properties in input files.
1230@option{cet-report=warning} will make the linker issue a warning for
1231missing properties in input files. @option{cet-report=error} will make
1232the linker issue an error for missing properties in input files.
1233Note that @option{ibt} will turn off the missing
1234GNU_PROPERTY_X86_FEATURE_1_IBT property report and @option{shstk} will
1235turn off the missing GNU_PROPERTY_X86_FEATURE_1_SHSTK property report.
1236Supported for Linux/i386 and Linux/x86_64.
1237
cd6d6c15 1238@item combreloc
e6e2dfbd
AM
1239@itemx nocombreloc
1240Combine multiple dynamic relocation sections and sort to improve
1241dynamic symbol lookup caching. Do not do this if @samp{nocombreloc}.
cd6d6c15 1242
b8871f35 1243@item common
e6e2dfbd
AM
1244@itemx nocommon
1245Generate common symbols with STT_COMMON type during a relocatable
1246link. Use STT_OBJECT type if @samp{nocommon}.
1247
1248@item common-page-size=@var{value}
1249Set the page size most commonly used to @var{value}. Memory image
1250layout will be optimized to minimize memory pages if the system is
1251using pages of this size.
b8871f35 1252
cd6d6c15 1253@item defs
97a232d7
NC
1254Report unresolved symbol references from regular object files. This
1255is done even if the linker is creating a non-symbolic shared library.
1256This option is the inverse of @samp{-z undefs}.
cd6d6c15 1257
e6e2dfbd
AM
1258@item dynamic-undefined-weak
1259@itemx nodynamic-undefined-weak
1260Make undefined weak symbols dynamic when building a dynamic object,
1261if they are referenced from a regular object file and not forced local
1262by symbol visibility or versioning. Do not make them dynamic if
1263@samp{nodynamic-undefined-weak}. If neither option is given, a target
1264may default to either option being in force, or make some other
1265selection of undefined weak symbols dynamic. Not all targets support
1266these options.
1267
6aa29e7b
JJ
1268@item execstack
1269Marks the object as requiring executable stack.
1270
b039ef04
L
1271@item global
1272This option is only meaningful when building a shared object. It makes
1273the symbols defined by this shared object available for symbol resolution
1274of subsequently loaded libraries.
1275
93ab9c0d
NC
1276@item globalaudit
1277This option is only meaningful when building a dynamic executable.
1278This option marks the executable as requiring global auditing by
1279setting the @code{DF_1_GLOBAUDIT} bit in the @code{DT_FLAGS_1} dynamic
1280tag. Global auditing requires that any auditing library defined via
a05a5b64 1281the @option{--depaudit} or @option{-P} command-line options be run for
6c19b93b 1282all dynamic objects loaded by the application.
93ab9c0d 1283
e6e2dfbd
AM
1284@item ibtplt
1285Generate Intel Indirect Branch Tracking (IBT) enabled PLT entries.
1286Supported for Linux/i386 and Linux/x86_64.
1287
8df93cb5 1288@item ibt
e6e2dfbd
AM
1289Generate GNU_PROPERTY_X86_FEATURE_1_IBT in .note.gnu.property section
1290to indicate compatibility with IBT. This also implies @option{ibtplt}.
1291Supported for Linux/i386 and Linux/x86_64.
1292
6f365fda
L
1293@item indirect-extern-access
1294@itemx noindirect-extern-access
1295Generate GNU_PROPERTY_1_NEEDED_INDIRECT_EXTERN_ACCESS in
1296.note.gnu.property section to indicate that object file requires
1297canonical function pointers and cannot be used with copy relocation.
1298This option also implies @option{noextern-protected-data} and
1299@option{nocopyreloc}. Supported for i386 and x86-64.
1300
1301@option{noindirect-extern-access} removes
1302GNU_PROPERTY_1_NEEDED_INDIRECT_EXTERN_ACCESS from .note.gnu.property
1303section.
1304
cd6d6c15
NC
1305@item initfirst
1306This option is only meaningful when building a shared object.
1307It marks the object so that its runtime initialization will occur
1308before the runtime initialization of any other objects brought into
1309the process at the same time. Similarly the runtime finalization of
1310the object will occur after the runtime finalization of any other
1311objects.
1312
1313@item interpose
e6e2dfbd
AM
1314Specify that the dynamic loader should modify its symbol search order
1315so that symbols in this shared library interpose all other shared
1316libraries not so marked.
cd6d6c15 1317
c3805e4c
VDM
1318@item unique
1319@itemx nounique
1320When generating a shared library or other dynamically loadable ELF
1321object mark it as one that should (by default) only ever be loaded once,
1322and only in the main namespace (when using @code{dlmopen}). This is
1323primarily used to mark fundamental libraries such as libc, libpthread et
1324al which do not usually function correctly unless they are the sole instances
1325of themselves. This behaviour can be overridden by the @code{dlmopen} caller
1326and does not apply to certain loading mechanisms (such as audit libraries).
1327
279d901e
L
1328@item lam-u48
1329Generate GNU_PROPERTY_X86_FEATURE_1_LAM_U48 in .note.gnu.property section
1330to indicate compatibility with Intel LAM_U48. Supported for Linux/x86_64.
1331
1332@item lam-u57
1333Generate GNU_PROPERTY_X86_FEATURE_1_LAM_U57 in .note.gnu.property section
1334to indicate compatibility with Intel LAM_U57. Supported for Linux/x86_64.
1335
1336@item lam-u48-report=none
1337@itemx lam-u48-report=warning
1338@itemx lam-u48-report=error
1339Specify how to report the missing GNU_PROPERTY_X86_FEATURE_1_LAM_U48
1340property in input .note.gnu.property section.
1341@option{lam-u48-report=none}, which is the default, will make the
1342linker not report missing properties in input files.
1343@option{lam-u48-report=warning} will make the linker issue a warning for
1344missing properties in input files. @option{lam-u48-report=error} will
1345make the linker issue an error for missing properties in input files.
1346Supported for Linux/x86_64.
1347
1348@item lam-u57-report=none
1349@itemx lam-u57-report=warning
1350@itemx lam-u57-report=error
1351Specify how to report the missing GNU_PROPERTY_X86_FEATURE_1_LAM_U57
1352property in input .note.gnu.property section.
1353@option{lam-u57-report=none}, which is the default, will make the
1354linker not report missing properties in input files.
1355@option{lam-u57-report=warning} will make the linker issue a warning for
1356missing properties in input files. @option{lam-u57-report=error} will
1357make the linker issue an error for missing properties in input files.
1358Supported for Linux/x86_64.
1359
1360@item lam-report=none
1361@itemx lam-report=warning
1362@itemx lam-report=error
1363Specify how to report the missing GNU_PROPERTY_X86_FEATURE_1_LAM_U48 and
1364GNU_PROPERTY_X86_FEATURE_1_LAM_U57 properties in input .note.gnu.property
1365section. @option{lam-report=none}, which is the default, will make the
1366linker not report missing properties in input files.
1367@option{lam-report=warning} will make the linker issue a warning for
1368missing properties in input files. @option{lam-report=error} will make
1369the linker issue an error for missing properties in input files.
1370Supported for Linux/x86_64.
1371
5fa222e4
AM
1372@item lazy
1373When generating an executable or shared library, mark it to tell the
1374dynamic linker to defer function call resolution to the point when
1375the function is called (lazy binding), rather than at load time.
1376Lazy binding is the default.
1377
cd6d6c15 1378@item loadfltr
e6e2dfbd 1379Specify that the object's filters be processed immediately at runtime.
cd6d6c15 1380
e6e2dfbd
AM
1381@item max-page-size=@var{value}
1382Set the maximum memory page size supported to @var{value}.
cd6d6c15 1383
e6e2dfbd
AM
1384@item muldefs
1385Allow multiple definitions.
b8871f35 1386
cd6d6c15 1387@item nocopyreloc
daf220f0
AM
1388Disable linker generated .dynbss variables used in place of variables
1389defined in shared libraries. May result in dynamic text relocations.
cd6d6c15
NC
1390
1391@item nodefaultlib
e6e2dfbd
AM
1392Specify that the dynamic loader search for dependencies of this object
1393should ignore any default library search paths.
cd6d6c15
NC
1394
1395@item nodelete
e6e2dfbd 1396Specify that the object shouldn't be unloaded at runtime.
cd6d6c15
NC
1397
1398@item nodlopen
e6e2dfbd 1399Specify that the object is not available to @code{dlopen}.
cd6d6c15
NC
1400
1401@item nodump
e6e2dfbd 1402Specify that the object can not be dumped by @code{dldump}.
cd6d6c15 1403
6aa29e7b
JJ
1404@item noexecstack
1405Marks the object as not requiring executable stack.
1406
e6e2dfbd
AM
1407@item noextern-protected-data
1408Don't treat protected data symbols as external when building a shared
1409library. This option overrides the linker backend default. It can be
1410used to work around incorrect relocations against protected data symbols
1411generated by compiler. Updates on protected data symbols by another
1412module aren't visible to the resulting shared library. Supported for
1413i386 and x86-64.
8dfef1bd 1414
e6e2dfbd
AM
1415@item noreloc-overflow
1416Disable relocation overflow check. This can be used to disable
1417relocation overflow check if there will be no dynamic relocation
1418overflow at run-time. Supported for x86_64.
6aa29e7b 1419
cd6d6c15
NC
1420@item now
1421When generating an executable or shared library, mark it to tell the
1422dynamic linker to resolve all symbols when the program is started, or
e6e2dfbd
AM
1423when the shared library is loaded by dlopen, instead of deferring
1424function call resolution to the point when the function is first
1425called.
cd6d6c15
NC
1426
1427@item origin
e6e2dfbd 1428Specify that the object requires @samp{$ORIGIN} handling in paths.
cd6d6c15 1429
6a91be86
L
1430@item pack-relative-relocs
1431@itemx nopack-relative-relocs
1432Generate compact relative relocation in position-independent executable
1433and shared library. It adds @code{DT_RELR}, @code{DT_RELRSZ} and
1434@code{DT_RELRENT} entries to the dynamic section. It is ignored when
1435building position-dependent executable and relocatable output.
1436@option{nopack-relative-relocs} is the default, which disables compact
72aa8173
L
1437relative relocation. When linked against the GNU C Library, a
1438GLIBC_ABI_DT_RELR symbol version dependency on the shared C Library is
1439added to the output. Supported for i386 and x86-64.
6a91be86 1440
6aa29e7b 1441@item relro
e6e2dfbd 1442@itemx norelro
def5c83c
AM
1443Create an ELF @code{PT_GNU_RELRO} segment header in the object. This
1444specifies a memory segment that should be made read-only after
1445relocation, if supported. Specifying @samp{common-page-size} smaller
1446than the system page size will render this protection ineffective.
e6e2dfbd 1447Don't create an ELF @code{PT_GNU_RELRO} segment if @samp{norelro}.
6aa29e7b 1448
68b00778
L
1449@item report-relative-reloc
1450Report dynamic relative relocations generated by linker. Supported for
1451Linux/i386 and Linux/x86_64.
1452
47acac12
L
1453@item separate-code
1454@itemx noseparate-code
1455Create separate code @code{PT_LOAD} segment header in the object. This
1456specifies a memory segment that should contain only instructions and must
1457be in wholly disjoint pages from any other data. Don't create separate
1458code @code{PT_LOAD} segment if @samp{noseparate-code} is used.
1459
e6e2dfbd
AM
1460@item shstk
1461Generate GNU_PROPERTY_X86_FEATURE_1_SHSTK in .note.gnu.property section
1462to indicate compatibility with Intel Shadow Stack. Supported for
1463Linux/i386 and Linux/x86_64.
24718e3b 1464
04c3a755 1465@item stack-size=@var{value}
e6e2dfbd 1466Specify a stack size for an ELF @code{PT_GNU_STACK} segment.
04c3a755
NS
1467Specifying zero will override any default non-zero sized
1468@code{PT_GNU_STACK} segment creation.
1469
8ee10e86
AM
1470@item start-stop-gc
1471@itemx nostart-stop-gc
1472@cindex start-stop-gc
1473When @samp{--gc-sections} is in effect, a reference from a retained
1474section to @code{__start_SECNAME} or @code{__stop_SECNAME} causes all
1475input sections named @code{SECNAME} to also be retained, if
1476@code{SECNAME} is representable as a C identifier and either
1477@code{__start_SECNAME} or @code{__stop_SECNAME} is synthesized by the
1478linker. @samp{-z start-stop-gc} disables this effect, allowing
1479sections to be garbage collected as if the special synthesized symbols
1480were not defined. @samp{-z start-stop-gc} has no effect on a
1481definition of @code{__start_SECNAME} or @code{__stop_SECNAME} in an
1482object file or linker script. Such a definition will prevent the
1483linker providing a synthesized @code{__start_SECNAME} or
1484@code{__stop_SECNAME} respectively, and therefore the special
1485treatment by garbage collection for those references.
1486
cae64165
RM
1487@item start-stop-visibility=@var{value}
1488@cindex visibility
1489@cindex ELF symbol visibility
1490Specify the ELF symbol visibility for synthesized
1491@code{__start_SECNAME} and @code{__stop_SECNAME} symbols (@pxref{Input
1492Section Example}). @var{value} must be exactly @samp{default},
1493@samp{internal}, @samp{hidden}, or @samp{protected}. If no @samp{-z
1494start-stop-visibility} option is given, @samp{protected} is used for
1495compatibility with historical practice. However, it's highly
1496recommended to use @samp{-z start-stop-visibility=hidden} in new
1497programs and shared libraries so that these symbols are not exported
1498between shared objects, which is not usually what's intended.
1499
e6e2dfbd
AM
1500@item text
1501@itemx notext
1502@itemx textoff
a6dbf402
L
1503Report an error if DT_TEXTREL is set, i.e., if the position-independent
1504or shared object has dynamic relocations in read-only sections. Don't
1505report an error if @samp{notext} or @samp{textoff}.
48580982 1506
97a232d7
NC
1507@item undefs
1508Do not report unresolved symbol references from regular object files,
1509either when creating an executable, or when creating a shared library.
1510This option is the inverse of @samp{-z defs}.
1511
2d95647b
L
1512@item unique-symbol
1513@itemx nounique-symbol
1514Avoid duplicated local symbol names in the symbol string table. Append
1515".@code{number}" to duplicated local symbol names if @samp{unique-symbol}
1516is used. @option{nounique-symbol} is the default.
1517
b0ab0693 1518@item x86-64-baseline
32930e4e
L
1519@item x86-64-v2
1520@item x86-64-v3
1521@itemx x86-64-v4
1522Specify the x86-64 ISA level needed in .note.gnu.property section.
b0ab0693 1523@option{x86-64-baseline} generates @code{GNU_PROPERTY_X86_ISA_1_BASELINE}.
32930e4e
L
1524@option{x86-64-v2} generates @code{GNU_PROPERTY_X86_ISA_1_V2}.
1525@option{x86-64-v3} generates @code{GNU_PROPERTY_X86_ISA_1_V3}.
1526@option{x86-64-v4} generates @code{GNU_PROPERTY_X86_ISA_1_V4}.
1527Supported for Linux/i386 and Linux/x86_64.
1528
cd6d6c15
NC
1529@end table
1530
ece2d90e 1531Other keywords are ignored for Solaris compatibility.
252b5132
RH
1532
1533@kindex -(
1534@cindex groups of archives
1535@item -( @var{archives} -)
1536@itemx --start-group @var{archives} --end-group
1537The @var{archives} should be a list of archive files. They may be
1538either explicit file names, or @samp{-l} options.
1539
1540The specified archives are searched repeatedly until no new undefined
1541references are created. Normally, an archive is searched only once in
1542the order that it is specified on the command line. If a symbol in that
1543archive is needed to resolve an undefined symbol referred to by an
1544object in an archive that appears later on the command line, the linker
1545would not be able to resolve that reference. By grouping the archives,
5d3db3e2 1546they will all be searched repeatedly until all possible references are
252b5132
RH
1547resolved.
1548
1549Using this option has a significant performance cost. It is best to use
1550it only when there are unavoidable circular references between two or
1551more archives.
1552
69da35b5
NC
1553@kindex --accept-unknown-input-arch
1554@kindex --no-accept-unknown-input-arch
1555@item --accept-unknown-input-arch
1556@itemx --no-accept-unknown-input-arch
1557Tells the linker to accept input files whose architecture cannot be
2ca22b03 1558recognised. The assumption is that the user knows what they are doing
69da35b5
NC
1559and deliberately wants to link in these unknown input files. This was
1560the default behaviour of the linker, before release 2.14. The default
1561behaviour from release 2.14 onwards is to reject such input files, and
1562so the @samp{--accept-unknown-input-arch} option has been added to
1563restore the old behaviour.
2ca22b03 1564
4a43e768
AM
1565@kindex --as-needed
1566@kindex --no-as-needed
1567@item --as-needed
1568@itemx --no-as-needed
1569This option affects ELF DT_NEEDED tags for dynamic libraries mentioned
ddbb8a31 1570on the command line after the @option{--as-needed} option. Normally
4a43e768
AM
1571the linker will add a DT_NEEDED tag for each dynamic library mentioned
1572on the command line, regardless of whether the library is actually
ddbb8a31 1573needed or not. @option{--as-needed} causes a DT_NEEDED tag to only be
ffa9430d
AM
1574emitted for a library that @emph{at that point in the link} satisfies a
1575non-weak undefined symbol reference from a regular object file or, if
1240be6b
AM
1576the library is not found in the DT_NEEDED lists of other needed libraries, a
1577non-weak undefined symbol reference from another needed dynamic library.
ffa9430d
AM
1578Object files or libraries appearing on the command line @emph{after}
1579the library in question do not affect whether the library is seen as
1580needed. This is similar to the rules for extraction of object files
1581from archives. @option{--no-as-needed} restores the default behaviour.
4a43e768 1582
6418520e
NC
1583Note: On Linux based systems the @option{--as-needed} option also has
1584an affect on the behaviour of the @option{--rpath} and
1585@option{--rpath-link} options. See the description of
1586@option{--rpath-link} for more details.
1587
e56f61be
L
1588@kindex --add-needed
1589@kindex --no-add-needed
1590@item --add-needed
1591@itemx --no-add-needed
ddbb8a31
NC
1592These two options have been deprecated because of the similarity of
1593their names to the @option{--as-needed} and @option{--no-as-needed}
1594options. They have been replaced by @option{--copy-dt-needed-entries}
1595and @option{--no-copy-dt-needed-entries}.
e56f61be 1596
252b5132
RH
1597@kindex -assert @var{keyword}
1598@item -assert @var{keyword}
1599This option is ignored for SunOS compatibility.
1600
1601@kindex -Bdynamic
1602@kindex -dy
1603@kindex -call_shared
1604@item -Bdynamic
1605@itemx -dy
1606@itemx -call_shared
1607Link against dynamic libraries. This is only meaningful on platforms
1608for which shared libraries are supported. This option is normally the
1609default on such platforms. The different variants of this option are
1610for compatibility with various systems. You may use this option
1611multiple times on the command line: it affects library searching for
da8bce14 1612@option{-l} options which follow it.
252b5132 1613
a1ab1d2a
UD
1614@kindex -Bgroup
1615@item -Bgroup
1616Set the @code{DF_1_GROUP} flag in the @code{DT_FLAGS_1} entry in the dynamic
1617section. This causes the runtime linker to handle lookups in this
1618object and its dependencies to be performed only inside the group.
560e09e9
NC
1619@option{--unresolved-symbols=report-all} is implied. This option is
1620only meaningful on ELF platforms which support shared libraries.
a1ab1d2a 1621
252b5132
RH
1622@kindex -Bstatic
1623@kindex -dn
1624@kindex -non_shared
1625@kindex -static
a1ab1d2a 1626@item -Bstatic
252b5132
RH
1627@itemx -dn
1628@itemx -non_shared
1629@itemx -static
1630Do not link against shared libraries. This is only meaningful on
1631platforms for which shared libraries are supported. The different
1632variants of this option are for compatibility with various systems. You
1633may use this option multiple times on the command line: it affects
560e09e9 1634library searching for @option{-l} options which follow it. This
e9156f74
NC
1635option also implies @option{--unresolved-symbols=report-all}. This
1636option can be used with @option{-shared}. Doing so means that a
1637shared library is being created but that all of the library's external
1638references must be resolved by pulling in entries from static
ece2d90e 1639libraries.
252b5132
RH
1640
1641@kindex -Bsymbolic
1642@item -Bsymbolic
1643When creating a shared library, bind references to global symbols to the
1644definition within the shared library, if any. Normally, it is possible
1645for a program linked against a shared library to override the definition
1914e264
AM
1646within the shared library. This option is only meaningful on ELF
1647platforms which support shared libraries.
252b5132 1648
40b36307
L
1649@kindex -Bsymbolic-functions
1650@item -Bsymbolic-functions
1651When creating a shared library, bind references to global function
c0065db7 1652symbols to the definition within the shared library, if any.
40b36307 1653This option is only meaningful on ELF platforms which support shared
1914e264 1654libraries.
40b36307 1655
cf893b0e
FS
1656@kindex -Bno-symbolic
1657@item -Bno-symbolic
1658This option can cancel previously specified @samp{-Bsymbolic} and
1659@samp{-Bsymbolic-functions}.
1660
55255dae
L
1661@kindex --dynamic-list=@var{dynamic-list-file}
1662@item --dynamic-list=@var{dynamic-list-file}
1663Specify the name of a dynamic list file to the linker. This is
1664typically used when creating shared libraries to specify a list of
1665global symbols whose references shouldn't be bound to the definition
1666within the shared library, or creating dynamically linked executables
1667to specify a list of symbols which should be added to the symbol table
1668in the executable. This option is only meaningful on ELF platforms
1669which support shared libraries.
1670
1671The format of the dynamic list is the same as the version node without
1672scope and node name. See @ref{VERSION} for more information.
1673
40b36307
L
1674@kindex --dynamic-list-data
1675@item --dynamic-list-data
1676Include all global data symbols to the dynamic list.
1677
1678@kindex --dynamic-list-cpp-new
1679@item --dynamic-list-cpp-new
1680Provide the builtin dynamic list for C++ operator new and delete. It
1681is mainly useful for building shared libstdc++.
1682
0b8a70d9
L
1683@kindex --dynamic-list-cpp-typeinfo
1684@item --dynamic-list-cpp-typeinfo
1685Provide the builtin dynamic list for C++ runtime type identification.
1686
252b5132
RH
1687@kindex --check-sections
1688@kindex --no-check-sections
1689@item --check-sections
308b1ffd 1690@itemx --no-check-sections
252b5132 1691Asks the linker @emph{not} to check section addresses after they have
7d816a17 1692been assigned to see if there are any overlaps. Normally the linker will
252b5132
RH
1693perform this check, and if it finds any overlaps it will produce
1694suitable error messages. The linker does know about, and does make
1695allowances for sections in overlays. The default behaviour can be
a05a5b64 1696restored by using the command-line switch @option{--check-sections}.
02b0b1aa
NS
1697Section overlap is not usually checked for relocatable links. You can
1698force checking in that case by using the @option{--check-sections}
1699option.
252b5132 1700
ddbb8a31
NC
1701@kindex --copy-dt-needed-entries
1702@kindex --no-copy-dt-needed-entries
1703@item --copy-dt-needed-entries
1704@itemx --no-copy-dt-needed-entries
9d5777a3 1705This option affects the treatment of dynamic libraries referred to
ddbb8a31 1706by DT_NEEDED tags @emph{inside} ELF dynamic libraries mentioned on the
08efffb8 1707command line. Normally the linker won't add a DT_NEEDED tag to the
ddbb8a31 1708output binary for each library mentioned in a DT_NEEDED tag in an
08efffb8 1709input dynamic library. With @option{--copy-dt-needed-entries}
ddbb8a31 1710specified on the command line however any dynamic libraries that
08efffb8
MM
1711follow it will have their DT_NEEDED entries added. The default
1712behaviour can be restored with @option{--no-copy-dt-needed-entries}.
ddbb8a31
NC
1713
1714This option also has an effect on the resolution of symbols in dynamic
08efffb8
MM
1715libraries. With @option{--copy-dt-needed-entries} dynamic libraries
1716mentioned on the command line will be recursively searched, following
1717their DT_NEEDED tags to other libraries, in order to resolve symbols
1718required by the output binary. With the default setting however
1719the searching of dynamic libraries that follow it will stop with the
1720dynamic library itself. No DT_NEEDED links will be traversed to resolve
ddbb8a31
NC
1721symbols.
1722
252b5132
RH
1723@cindex cross reference table
1724@kindex --cref
1725@item --cref
1726Output a cross reference table. If a linker map file is being
1727generated, the cross reference table is printed to the map file.
1728Otherwise, it is printed on the standard output.
1729
1730The format of the table is intentionally simple, so that it may be
1731easily processed by a script if necessary. The symbols are printed out,
1732sorted by name. For each symbol, a list of file names is given. If the
1733symbol is defined, the first file listed is the location of the
049c1c8e
NC
1734definition. If the symbol is defined as a common value then any files
1735where this happens appear next. Finally any files that reference the
1736symbol are listed.
252b5132 1737
5dba6f05
NA
1738@cindex ctf variables
1739@kindex --ctf-variables
1740@kindex --no-ctf-variables
1741@item --ctf-variables
1742@item --no-ctf-variables
1743The CTF debuginfo format supports a section which encodes the names and
1744types of variables found in the program which do not appear in any symbol
1745table. These variables clearly cannot be looked up by address by
1746conventional debuggers, so the space used for their types and names is
1747usually wasted: the types are usually small but the names are often not.
1748@option{--ctf-variables} causes the generation of such a section.
1749The default behaviour can be restored with @option{--no-ctf-variables}.
1750
1751@cindex ctf type sharing
1752@kindex --ctf-share-types
1753@item --ctf-share-types=@var{method}
1754Adjust the method used to share types between translation units in CTF.
1755
1756@table @samp
1757@item share-unconflicted
1758Put all types that do not have ambiguous definitions into the shared dictionary,
1759where debuggers can easily access them, even if they only occur in one
1760translation unit. This is the default.
1761
1762@item share-duplicated
1763Put only types that occur in multiple translation units into the shared
1764dictionary: types with only one definition go into per-translation-unit
1765dictionaries. Types with ambiguous definitions in multiple translation units
1766always go into per-translation-unit dictionaries. This tends to make the CTF
1767larger, but may reduce the amount of CTF in the shared dictionary. For very
1768large projects this may speed up opening the CTF and save memory in the CTF
1769consumer at runtime.
1770@end table
1771
4818e05f
AM
1772@cindex common allocation
1773@kindex --no-define-common
1774@item --no-define-common
1775This option inhibits the assignment of addresses to common symbols.
1776The script command @code{INHIBIT_COMMON_ALLOCATION} has the same effect.
1777@xref{Miscellaneous Commands}.
1778
1779The @samp{--no-define-common} option allows decoupling
1780the decision to assign addresses to Common symbols from the choice
1781of the output file type; otherwise a non-Relocatable output type
1782forces assigning addresses to Common symbols.
1783Using @samp{--no-define-common} allows Common symbols that are referenced
1784from a shared library to be assigned addresses only in the main program.
1785This eliminates the unused duplicate space in the shared library,
1786and also prevents any possible confusion over resolving to the wrong
1787duplicate when there are many dynamic modules with specialized search
1788paths for runtime symbol resolution.
1789
7bdf4127
AB
1790@cindex group allocation in linker script
1791@cindex section groups
1792@cindex COMDAT
1793@kindex --force-group-allocation
1794@item --force-group-allocation
1795This option causes the linker to place section group members like
1796normal input sections, and to delete the section groups. This is the
1797default behaviour for a final link but this option can be used to
1798change the behaviour of a relocatable link (@samp{-r}). The script
1799command @code{FORCE_GROUP_ALLOCATION} has the same
1800effect. @xref{Miscellaneous Commands}.
1801
252b5132 1802@cindex symbols, from command line
2509a395
SL
1803@kindex --defsym=@var{symbol}=@var{exp}
1804@item --defsym=@var{symbol}=@var{expression}
252b5132
RH
1805Create a global symbol in the output file, containing the absolute
1806address given by @var{expression}. You may use this option as many
1807times as necessary to define multiple symbols in the command line. A
1808limited form of arithmetic is supported for the @var{expression} in this
1809context: you may give a hexadecimal constant or the name of an existing
1810symbol, or use @code{+} and @code{-} to add or subtract hexadecimal
1811constants or symbols. If you need more elaborate expressions, consider
66bc8739
AM
1812using the linker command language from a script (@pxref{Assignments}).
1813@emph{Note:} there should be no white space between @var{symbol}, the
1814equals sign (``@key{=}''), and @var{expression}.
252b5132 1815
54874444
AB
1816The linker processes @samp{--defsym} arguments and @samp{-T} arguments
1817in order, placing @samp{--defsym} before @samp{-T} will define the
1818symbol before the linker script from @samp{-T} is processed, while
1819placing @samp{--defsym} after @samp{-T} will define the symbol after
1820the linker script has been processed. This difference has
1821consequences for expressions within the linker script that use the
1822@samp{--defsym} symbols, which order is correct will depend on what
1823you are trying to achieve.
1824
252b5132 1825@cindex demangling, from command line
28c309a2 1826@kindex --demangle[=@var{style}]
252b5132 1827@kindex --no-demangle
28c309a2 1828@item --demangle[=@var{style}]
252b5132
RH
1829@itemx --no-demangle
1830These options control whether to demangle symbol names in error messages
1831and other output. When the linker is told to demangle, it tries to
1832present symbol names in a readable fashion: it strips leading
1833underscores if they are used by the object file format, and converts C++
a1ab1d2a
UD
1834mangled symbol names into user readable names. Different compilers have
1835different mangling styles. The optional demangling style argument can be used
1836to choose an appropriate demangling style for your compiler. The linker will
28c309a2
NC
1837demangle by default unless the environment variable @samp{COLLECT_NO_DEMANGLE}
1838is set. These options may be used to override the default.
252b5132
RH
1839
1840@cindex dynamic linker, from command line
506eee22 1841@kindex -I@var{file}
2509a395
SL
1842@kindex --dynamic-linker=@var{file}
1843@item -I@var{file}
1844@itemx --dynamic-linker=@var{file}
252b5132
RH
1845Set the name of the dynamic linker. This is only meaningful when
1846generating dynamically linked ELF executables. The default dynamic
1847linker is normally correct; don't use this unless you know what you are
1848doing.
1849
9b8b325a
RF
1850@kindex --no-dynamic-linker
1851@item --no-dynamic-linker
1852When producing an executable file, omit the request for a dynamic
1853linker to be used at load-time. This is only meaningful for ELF
1854executables that contain dynamic relocations, and usually requires
1855entry point code that is capable of processing these relocations.
1856
a70f34c0
NC
1857@kindex --embedded-relocs
1858@item --embedded-relocs
1859This option is similar to the @option{--emit-relocs} option except
a094d01f 1860that the relocs are stored in a target-specific section. This option
a70f34c0
NC
1861is only supported by the @samp{BFIN}, @samp{CR16} and @emph{M68K}
1862targets.
1863
3f0a5f17
ME
1864@kindex --disable-multiple-abs-defs
1865@item --disable-multiple-abs-defs
1866Do not allow multiple definitions with symbols included
1867in filename invoked by -R or --just-symbols
1868
7ce691ae 1869@kindex --fatal-warnings
0fe58ccd 1870@kindex --no-fatal-warnings
7ce691ae 1871@item --fatal-warnings
0fe58ccd
NC
1872@itemx --no-fatal-warnings
1873Treat all warnings as errors. The default behaviour can be restored
1874with the option @option{--no-fatal-warnings}.
7ce691ae 1875
4b2e7a57
NC
1876@kindex -w
1877@kindex --no-warnings
1878@item -w
1879@itemx --no-warnings
1880Do not display any warning or error messages. This overrides
1881@option{--fatal-warnings} if it has been enabled. This option can be
1882used when it is known that the output binary will not work, but there
1883is still a need to create it.
1884
252b5132
RH
1885@kindex --force-exe-suffix
1886@item --force-exe-suffix
1887Make sure that an output file has a .exe suffix.
1888
1889If a successfully built fully linked output file does not have a
1890@code{.exe} or @code{.dll} suffix, this option forces the linker to copy
1891the output file to one of the same name with a @code{.exe} suffix. This
1892option is useful when using unmodified Unix makefiles on a Microsoft
1893Windows host, since some versions of Windows won't run an image unless
1894it ends in a @code{.exe} suffix.
1895
1896@kindex --gc-sections
1897@kindex --no-gc-sections
1898@cindex garbage collection
c17d87de
NC
1899@item --gc-sections
1900@itemx --no-gc-sections
252b5132 1901Enable garbage collection of unused input sections. It is ignored on
ac69cbc6 1902targets that do not support this option. The default behaviour (of not
b3549761 1903performing this garbage collection) can be restored by specifying
0f088b2a
KT
1904@samp{--no-gc-sections} on the command line. Note that garbage
1905collection for COFF and PE format targets is supported, but the
1906implementation is currently considered to be experimental.
252b5132 1907
d5465ba2
AM
1908@samp{--gc-sections} decides which input sections are used by
1909examining symbols and relocations. The section containing the entry
1910symbol and all sections containing symbols undefined on the
1911command-line will be kept, as will sections containing symbols
1912referenced by dynamic objects. Note that when building shared
1913libraries, the linker must assume that any visible symbol is
1914referenced. Once this initial set of sections has been determined,
1915the linker recursively marks as used any section referenced by their
b69e1ff3
CC
1916relocations. See @samp{--entry}, @samp{--undefined}, and
1917@samp{--gc-keep-exported}.
d5465ba2 1918
ac69cbc6 1919This option can be set when doing a partial link (enabled with option
9d5777a3 1920@samp{-r}). In this case the root of symbols kept must be explicitly
b69e1ff3
CC
1921specified either by one of the options @samp{--entry},
1922@samp{--undefined}, or @samp{--gc-keep-exported} or by a @code{ENTRY}
1923command in the linker script.
ac69cbc6 1924
99fabbc9
JL
1925As a GNU extension, ELF input sections marked with the
1926@code{SHF_GNU_RETAIN} flag will not be garbage collected.
1927
c17d87de
NC
1928@kindex --print-gc-sections
1929@kindex --no-print-gc-sections
1930@cindex garbage collection
1931@item --print-gc-sections
1932@itemx --no-print-gc-sections
1933List all sections removed by garbage collection. The listing is
1934printed on stderr. This option is only effective if garbage
1935collection has been enabled via the @samp{--gc-sections}) option. The
1936default behaviour (of not listing the sections that are removed) can
1937be restored by specifying @samp{--no-print-gc-sections} on the command
1938line.
1939
22185505 1940@kindex --gc-keep-exported
1941@cindex garbage collection
1942@item --gc-keep-exported
1943When @samp{--gc-sections} is enabled, this option prevents garbage
1944collection of unused input sections that contain global symbols having
1945default or protected visibility. This option is intended to be used for
1946executables where unreferenced sections would otherwise be garbage
1947collected regardless of the external visibility of contained symbols.
1948Note that this option has no effect when linking shared objects since
1949it is already the default behaviour. This option is only supported for
1950ELF format targets.
1951
30824704
RM
1952@kindex --print-output-format
1953@cindex output format
1954@item --print-output-format
1955Print the name of the default output format (perhaps influenced by
1956other command-line options). This is the string that would appear
1957in an @code{OUTPUT_FORMAT} linker script command (@pxref{File Commands}).
1958
3604cb1f
TG
1959@kindex --print-memory-usage
1960@cindex memory usage
1961@item --print-memory-usage
1962Print used size, total size and used size of memory regions created with
1963the @ref{MEMORY} command. This is useful on embedded targets to have a
1964quick view of amount of free memory. The format of the output has one
1965headline and one line per region. It is both human readable and easily
1966parsable by tools. Here is an example of an output:
1967
1968@smallexample
1969Memory region Used Size Region Size %age Used
1970 ROM: 256 KB 1 MB 25.00%
1971 RAM: 32 B 2 GB 0.00%
1972@end smallexample
1973
252b5132
RH
1974@cindex help
1975@cindex usage
1976@kindex --help
1977@item --help
1978Print a summary of the command-line options on the standard output and exit.
1979
ea20a7da
CC
1980@kindex --target-help
1981@item --target-help
a094d01f 1982Print a summary of all target-specific options on the standard output and exit.
ea20a7da 1983
2509a395
SL
1984@kindex -Map=@var{mapfile}
1985@item -Map=@var{mapfile}
252b5132 1986Print a link map to the file @var{mapfile}. See the description of the
2c72361c
NC
1987@option{-M} option, above. If @var{mapfile} is just the character
1988@code{-} then the map will be written to stdout.
1989
1990Specifying a directory as @var{mapfile} causes the linker map to be
1991written as a file inside the directory. Normally name of the file
1992inside the directory is computed as the basename of the @var{output}
1993file with @code{.map} appended. If however the special character
1994@code{%} is used then this will be replaced by the full path of the
1995output file. Additionally if there are any characters after the
1996@var{%} symbol then @code{.map} will no longer be appended.
1997
1998@smallexample
1999 -o foo.exe -Map=bar [Creates ./bar]
2000 -o ../dir/foo.exe -Map=bar [Creates ./bar]
2001 -o foo.exe -Map=../dir [Creates ../dir/foo.exe.map]
2002 -o ../dir2/foo.exe -Map=../dir [Creates ../dir/foo.exe.map]
2003 -o foo.exe -Map=% [Creates ./foo.exe.map]
2004 -o ../dir/foo.exe -Map=% [Creates ../dir/foo.exe.map]
2005 -o foo.exe -Map=%.bar [Creates ./foo.exe.bar]
2006 -o ../dir/foo.exe -Map=%.bar [Creates ../dir/foo.exe.bar]
2007 -o ../dir2/foo.exe -Map=../dir/% [Creates ../dir/../dir2/foo.exe.map]
2008 -o ../dir2/foo.exe -Map=../dir/%.bar [Creates ../dir/../dir2/foo.exe.bar]
2009@end smallexample
2010
2011It is an error to specify more than one @code{%} character.
2012
2013If the map file already exists then it will be overwritten by this
2014operation.
252b5132
RH
2015
2016@cindex memory usage
2017@kindex --no-keep-memory
2018@item --no-keep-memory
ff5dcc92
SC
2019@command{ld} normally optimizes for speed over memory usage by caching the
2020symbol tables of input files in memory. This option tells @command{ld} to
252b5132 2021instead optimize for memory usage, by rereading the symbol tables as
ff5dcc92 2022necessary. This may be required if @command{ld} runs out of memory space
252b5132
RH
2023while linking a large executable.
2024
2025@kindex --no-undefined
a1ab1d2a 2026@kindex -z defs
97a232d7 2027@kindex -z undefs
252b5132 2028@item --no-undefined
a1ab1d2a 2029@itemx -z defs
560e09e9
NC
2030Report unresolved symbol references from regular object files. This
2031is done even if the linker is creating a non-symbolic shared library.
2032The switch @option{--[no-]allow-shlib-undefined} controls the
2033behaviour for reporting unresolved references found in shared
ece2d90e 2034libraries being linked in.
252b5132 2035
97a232d7
NC
2036The effects of this option can be reverted by using @code{-z undefs}.
2037
aa713662
L
2038@kindex --allow-multiple-definition
2039@kindex -z muldefs
2040@item --allow-multiple-definition
2041@itemx -z muldefs
2042Normally when a symbol is defined multiple times, the linker will
2043report a fatal error. These options allow multiple definitions and the
2044first definition will be used.
2045
b79e8c78 2046@kindex --allow-shlib-undefined
ae9a127f 2047@kindex --no-allow-shlib-undefined
b79e8c78 2048@item --allow-shlib-undefined
ae9a127f 2049@itemx --no-allow-shlib-undefined
903249d7 2050Allows or disallows undefined symbols in shared libraries.
560e09e9
NC
2051This switch is similar to @option{--no-undefined} except that it
2052determines the behaviour when the undefined symbols are in a
2053shared library rather than a regular object file. It does not affect
2054how undefined symbols in regular object files are handled.
2055
903249d7
NC
2056The default behaviour is to report errors for any undefined symbols
2057referenced in shared libraries if the linker is being used to create
2058an executable, but to allow them if the linker is being used to create
2059a shared library.
2060
2061The reasons for allowing undefined symbol references in shared
2062libraries specified at link time are that:
2063
2064@itemize @bullet
2065@item
2066A shared library specified at link time may not be the same as the one
2067that is available at load time, so the symbol might actually be
2068resolvable at load time.
2069@item
2070There are some operating systems, eg BeOS and HPPA, where undefined
2071symbols in shared libraries are normal.
2072
2073The BeOS kernel for example patches shared libraries at load time to
2074select whichever function is most appropriate for the current
2075architecture. This is used, for example, to dynamically select an
2076appropriate memset function.
2077@end itemize
b79e8c78 2078
23ae20f5
NC
2079@kindex --error-handling-script=@var{scriptname}
2080@item --error-handling-script=@var{scriptname}
2081If this option is provided then the linker will invoke
2082@var{scriptname} whenever an error is encountered. Currently however
2083only two kinds of error are supported: missing symbols and missing
2084libraries. Two arguments will be passed to script: the keyword
5c14cc55 2085``undefined-symbol'' or `missing-lib'' and the @var{name} of the
93cf38c0
NC
2086undefined symbol or missing library. The intention is that the script
2087will provide suggestions to the user as to where the symbol or library
23ae20f5
NC
2088might be found. After the script has finished then the normal linker
2089error message will be displayed.
2090
2091The availability of this option is controlled by a configure time
2092switch, so it may not be present in specific implementations.
2093
31941635
L
2094@kindex --no-undefined-version
2095@item --no-undefined-version
2096Normally when a symbol has an undefined version, the linker will ignore
2097it. This option disallows symbols with undefined version and a fatal error
2098will be issued instead.
2099
3e3b46e5
PB
2100@kindex --default-symver
2101@item --default-symver
2102Create and use a default symbol version (the soname) for unversioned
fc0e6df6
PB
2103exported symbols.
2104
2105@kindex --default-imported-symver
2106@item --default-imported-symver
2107Create and use a default symbol version (the soname) for unversioned
2108imported symbols.
3e3b46e5 2109
252b5132
RH
2110@kindex --no-warn-mismatch
2111@item --no-warn-mismatch
ff5dcc92 2112Normally @command{ld} will give an error if you try to link together input
252b5132
RH
2113files that are mismatched for some reason, perhaps because they have
2114been compiled for different processors or for different endiannesses.
ff5dcc92 2115This option tells @command{ld} that it should silently permit such possible
252b5132
RH
2116errors. This option should only be used with care, in cases when you
2117have taken some special action that ensures that the linker errors are
2118inappropriate.
2119
fe7929ce
AM
2120@kindex --no-warn-search-mismatch
2121@item --no-warn-search-mismatch
2122Normally @command{ld} will give a warning if it finds an incompatible
2123library during a library search. This option silences the warning.
2124
252b5132
RH
2125@kindex --no-whole-archive
2126@item --no-whole-archive
ff5dcc92 2127Turn off the effect of the @option{--whole-archive} option for subsequent
252b5132
RH
2128archive files.
2129
2130@cindex output file after errors
2131@kindex --noinhibit-exec
2132@item --noinhibit-exec
2133Retain the executable output file whenever it is still usable.
2134Normally, the linker will not produce an output file if it encounters
2135errors during the link process; it exits without writing an output file
2136when it issues any error whatsoever.
2137
0a9c1c8e
CD
2138@kindex -nostdlib
2139@item -nostdlib
2140Only search library directories explicitly specified on the
2141command line. Library directories specified in linker scripts
2142(including linker scripts specified on the command line) are ignored.
2143
252b5132 2144@ifclear SingleFormat
2509a395
SL
2145@kindex --oformat=@var{output-format}
2146@item --oformat=@var{output-format}
ff5dcc92
SC
2147@command{ld} may be configured to support more than one kind of object
2148file. If your @command{ld} is configured this way, you can use the
252b5132 2149@samp{--oformat} option to specify the binary format for the output
ff5dcc92
SC
2150object file. Even when @command{ld} is configured to support alternative
2151object formats, you don't usually need to specify this, as @command{ld}
252b5132
RH
2152should be configured to produce as a default output format the most
2153usual format on each machine. @var{output-format} is a text string, the
2154name of a particular format supported by the BFD libraries. (You can
2155list the available binary formats with @samp{objdump -i}.) The script
2156command @code{OUTPUT_FORMAT} can also specify the output format, but
2157this option overrides it. @xref{BFD}.
2158@end ifclear
2159
76359541
TP
2160@kindex --out-implib
2161@item --out-implib @var{file}
2162Create an import library in @var{file} corresponding to the executable
2163the linker is generating (eg. a DLL or ELF program). This import
2164library (which should be called @code{*.dll.a} or @code{*.a} for DLLs)
2165may be used to link clients against the generated executable; this
2166behaviour makes it possible to skip a separate import library creation
2167step (eg. @code{dlltool} for DLLs). This option is only available for
2168the i386 PE and ELF targetted ports of the linker.
2169
36af4a4e
JJ
2170@kindex -pie
2171@kindex --pic-executable
2172@item -pie
2173@itemx --pic-executable
2174@cindex position independent executables
2175Create a position independent executable. This is currently only supported on
2176ELF platforms. Position independent executables are similar to shared
2177libraries in that they are relocated by the dynamic linker to the virtual
7e7d5768 2178address the OS chooses for them (which can vary between invocations). Like
36af4a4e
JJ
2179normal dynamically linked executables they can be executed and symbols
2180defined in the executable cannot be overridden by shared libraries.
2181
e8f6c2a5
FS
2182@kindex -no-pie
2183@item -no-pie
2184@cindex position dependent executables
2185Create a position dependent executable. This is the default.
2186
252b5132
RH
2187@kindex -qmagic
2188@item -qmagic
2189This option is ignored for Linux compatibility.
2190
2191@kindex -Qy
2192@item -Qy
2193This option is ignored for SVR4 compatibility.
2194
2195@kindex --relax
2196@cindex synthesizing linker
2197@cindex relaxing addressing modes
28d5f677 2198@cindex --no-relax
252b5132 2199@item --relax
28d5f677 2200@itemx --no-relax
a1ab1d2a 2201An option with machine dependent effects.
252b5132
RH
2202@ifset GENERIC
2203This option is only supported on a few targets.
2204@end ifset
2205@ifset H8300
ff5dcc92 2206@xref{H8/300,,@command{ld} and the H8/300}.
252b5132 2207@end ifset
e0001a05
NC
2208@ifset XTENSA
2209@xref{Xtensa,, @command{ld} and Xtensa Processors}.
2210@end ifset
93fd0973
SC
2211@ifset M68HC11
2212@xref{M68HC11/68HC12,,@command{ld} and the 68HC11 and 68HC12}.
2213@end ifset
78058a5e
SL
2214@ifset NIOSII
2215@xref{Nios II,,@command{ld} and the Altera Nios II}.
2216@end ifset
2a60a7a8
AM
2217@ifset POWERPC
2218@xref{PowerPC ELF32,,@command{ld} and PowerPC 32-bit ELF Support}.
2219@end ifset
252b5132 2220
ccd9fae5 2221On some platforms the @option{--relax} option performs target specific,
28d5f677
NC
2222global optimizations that become possible when the linker resolves
2223addressing in the program, such as relaxing address modes,
2224synthesizing new instructions, selecting shorter version of current
11e7fd74 2225instructions, and combining constant values.
252b5132
RH
2226
2227On some platforms these link time global optimizations may make symbolic
2228debugging of the resulting executable impossible.
2229@ifset GENERIC
28d5f677
NC
2230This is known to be the case for the Matsushita MN10200 and MN10300
2231family of processors.
252b5132
RH
2232@end ifset
2233
ccd9fae5
NC
2234On platforms where the feature is supported, the option
2235@option{--no-relax} will disable it.
28d5f677 2236
ccd9fae5
NC
2237On platforms where the feature is not supported, both @option{--relax}
2238and @option{--no-relax} are accepted, but ignored.
5c14cc55 2239
252b5132
RH
2240@cindex retaining specified symbols
2241@cindex stripping all but some symbols
2242@cindex symbols, retaining selectively
2509a395
SL
2243@kindex --retain-symbols-file=@var{filename}
2244@item --retain-symbols-file=@var{filename}
252b5132
RH
2245Retain @emph{only} the symbols listed in the file @var{filename},
2246discarding all others. @var{filename} is simply a flat file, with one
2247symbol name per line. This option is especially useful in environments
2248@ifset GENERIC
2249(such as VxWorks)
2250@end ifset
2251where a large global symbol table is accumulated gradually, to conserve
2252run-time memory.
2253
2254@samp{--retain-symbols-file} does @emph{not} discard undefined symbols,
2255or symbols needed for relocations.
2256
2257You may only specify @samp{--retain-symbols-file} once in the command
2258line. It overrides @samp{-s} and @samp{-S}.
2259
2260@ifset GENERIC
2509a395 2261@item -rpath=@var{dir}
252b5132 2262@cindex runtime library search path
2509a395 2263@kindex -rpath=@var{dir}
252b5132 2264Add a directory to the runtime library search path. This is used when
ff5dcc92 2265linking an ELF executable with shared objects. All @option{-rpath}
252b5132 2266arguments are concatenated and passed to the runtime linker, which uses
c1b00498
MR
2267them to locate shared objects at runtime.
2268
2269The @option{-rpath} option is also used when locating shared objects which
2270are needed by shared objects explicitly included in the link; see the
2271description of the @option{-rpath-link} option. Searching @option{-rpath}
2272in this way is only supported by native linkers and cross linkers which
2273have been configured with the @option{--with-sysroot} option.
2274
2275If @option{-rpath} is not used when linking an ELF executable, the
2276contents of the environment variable @code{LD_RUN_PATH} will be used if it
2277is defined.
252b5132 2278
ff5dcc92 2279The @option{-rpath} option may also be used on SunOS. By default, on
d8506323 2280SunOS, the linker will form a runtime search path out of all the
ff5dcc92
SC
2281@option{-L} options it is given. If a @option{-rpath} option is used, the
2282runtime search path will be formed exclusively using the @option{-rpath}
2283options, ignoring the @option{-L} options. This can be useful when using
2284gcc, which adds many @option{-L} options which may be on NFS mounted
b45619c0 2285file systems.
252b5132 2286
ff5dcc92 2287For compatibility with other ELF linkers, if the @option{-R} option is
252b5132 2288followed by a directory name, rather than a file name, it is treated as
ff5dcc92 2289the @option{-rpath} option.
252b5132
RH
2290@end ifset
2291
2292@ifset GENERIC
2293@cindex link-time runtime library search path
2509a395
SL
2294@kindex -rpath-link=@var{dir}
2295@item -rpath-link=@var{dir}
252b5132
RH
2296When using ELF or SunOS, one shared library may require another. This
2297happens when an @code{ld -shared} link includes a shared library as one
2298of the input files.
2299
2300When the linker encounters such a dependency when doing a non-shared,
2301non-relocatable link, it will automatically try to locate the required
2302shared library and include it in the link, if it is not included
ff5dcc92 2303explicitly. In such a case, the @option{-rpath-link} option
252b5132 2304specifies the first set of directories to search. The
ff5dcc92 2305@option{-rpath-link} option may specify a sequence of directory names
252b5132
RH
2306either by specifying a list of names separated by colons, or by
2307appearing multiple times.
2308
e680a6b6
NC
2309The tokens @var{$ORIGIN} and @var{$LIB} can appear in these search
2310directories. They will be replaced by the full path to the directory
2311containing the program or shared object in the case of @var{$ORIGIN}
2312and either @samp{lib} - for 32-bit binaries - or @samp{lib64} - for
231364-bit binaries - in the case of @var{$LIB}.
2314
2315The alternative form of these tokens - @var{$@{ORIGIN@}} and
2316@var{$@{LIB@}} can also be used. The token @var{$PLATFORM} is not
2317supported.
2318
28c309a2
NC
2319This option should be used with caution as it overrides the search path
2320that may have been hard compiled into a shared library. In such a case it
2321is possible to use unintentionally a different search path than the
2322runtime linker would do.
2323
252b5132 2324The linker uses the following search paths to locate required shared
ece2d90e 2325libraries:
d8e4137b 2326
252b5132
RH
2327@enumerate
2328@item
ff5dcc92 2329Any directories specified by @option{-rpath-link} options.
252b5132 2330@item
ff5dcc92
SC
2331Any directories specified by @option{-rpath} options. The difference
2332between @option{-rpath} and @option{-rpath-link} is that directories
2333specified by @option{-rpath} options are included in the executable and
2334used at runtime, whereas the @option{-rpath-link} option is only effective
ece2d90e
NC
2335at link time. Searching @option{-rpath} in this way is only supported
2336by native linkers and cross linkers which have been configured with
2337the @option{--with-sysroot} option.
252b5132 2338@item
e2a83dd0
NC
2339On an ELF system, for native linkers, if the @option{-rpath} and
2340@option{-rpath-link} options were not used, search the contents of the
2341environment variable @code{LD_RUN_PATH}.
252b5132 2342@item
ff5dcc92
SC
2343On SunOS, if the @option{-rpath} option was not used, search any
2344directories specified using @option{-L} options.
252b5132 2345@item
a1b8d843 2346For a native linker, search the contents of the environment
e2a83dd0 2347variable @code{LD_LIBRARY_PATH}.
252b5132 2348@item
ec4eb78a
L
2349For a native ELF linker, the directories in @code{DT_RUNPATH} or
2350@code{DT_RPATH} of a shared library are searched for shared
2351libraries needed by it. The @code{DT_RPATH} entries are ignored if
2352@code{DT_RUNPATH} entries exist.
2353@item
d8e4137b
NC
2354For a linker for a Linux system, if the file @file{/etc/ld.so.conf}
2355exists, the list of directories found in that file. Note: the path
2356to this file is prefixed with the @code{sysroot} value, if that is
2357defined, and then any @code{prefix} string if the linker was
2358configured with the @command{--prefix=<path>} option.
2359@item
2360For a native linker on a FreeBSD system, any directories specified by
2361the @code{_PATH_ELF_HINTS} macro defined in the @file{elf-hints.h}
2362header file.
2363@item
364d7729
AM
2364Any directories specified by a @code{SEARCH_DIR} command in a
2365linker script given on the command line, including scripts specified
2366by @option{-T} (but not @option{-dT}).
2367@item
2368The default directories, normally @file{/lib} and @file{/usr/lib}.
2369@item
2370Any directories specified by a plugin LDPT_SET_EXTRA_LIBRARY_PATH.
2371@item
2372Any directories specified by a @code{SEARCH_DIR} command in a default
2373linker script.
252b5132
RH
2374@end enumerate
2375
6418520e
NC
2376Note however on Linux based systems there is an additional caveat: If
2377the @option{--as-needed} option is active @emph{and} a shared library
2378is located which would normally satisfy the search @emph{and} this
2379library does not have DT_NEEDED tag for @file{libc.so}
2380@emph{and} there is a shared library later on in the set of search
2381directories which also satisfies the search @emph{and}
2382this second shared library does have a DT_NEEDED tag for
2383@file{libc.so} @emph{then} the second library will be selected instead
2384of the first.
2385
252b5132
RH
2386If the required shared library is not found, the linker will issue a
2387warning and continue with the link.
6418520e 2388
252b5132
RH
2389@end ifset
2390
2391@kindex -shared
2392@kindex -Bshareable
2393@item -shared
2394@itemx -Bshareable
2395@cindex shared libraries
2396Create a shared library. This is currently only supported on ELF, XCOFF
2397and SunOS platforms. On SunOS, the linker will automatically create a
ff5dcc92 2398shared library if the @option{-e} option is not used and there are
252b5132
RH
2399undefined symbols in the link.
2400
252b5132 2401@kindex --sort-common
2509a395
SL
2402@item --sort-common
2403@itemx --sort-common=ascending
2404@itemx --sort-common=descending
de7dd2bd
NC
2405This option tells @command{ld} to sort the common symbols by alignment in
2406ascending or descending order when it places them in the appropriate output
2407sections. The symbol alignments considered are sixteen-byte or larger,
2408eight-byte, four-byte, two-byte, and one-byte. This is to prevent gaps
2409between symbols due to alignment constraints. If no sorting order is
2410specified, then descending order is assumed.
252b5132 2411
2509a395
SL
2412@kindex --sort-section=name
2413@item --sort-section=name
bcaa7b3e
L
2414This option will apply @code{SORT_BY_NAME} to all wildcard section
2415patterns in the linker script.
2416
2509a395
SL
2417@kindex --sort-section=alignment
2418@item --sort-section=alignment
bcaa7b3e
L
2419This option will apply @code{SORT_BY_ALIGNMENT} to all wildcard section
2420patterns in the linker script.
2421
a70f34c0
NC
2422@kindex --spare-dynamic-tags
2423@item --spare-dynamic-tags=@var{count}
2424This option specifies the number of empty slots to leave in the
2425.dynamic section of ELF shared objects. Empty slots may be needed by
2426post processing tools, such as the prelinker. The default is 5.
2427
252b5132 2428@kindex --split-by-file
2509a395 2429@item --split-by-file[=@var{size}]
ff5dcc92 2430Similar to @option{--split-by-reloc} but creates a new output section for
a854a4a7
AM
2431each input file when @var{size} is reached. @var{size} defaults to a
2432size of 1 if not given.
252b5132
RH
2433
2434@kindex --split-by-reloc
2509a395 2435@item --split-by-reloc[=@var{count}]
a854a4a7 2436Tries to creates extra sections in the output file so that no single
252b5132 2437output section in the file contains more than @var{count} relocations.
a854a4a7 2438This is useful when generating huge relocatable files for downloading into
252b5132
RH
2439certain real time kernels with the COFF object file format; since COFF
2440cannot represent more than 65535 relocations in a single section. Note
2441that this will fail to work with object file formats which do not
2442support arbitrary sections. The linker will not split up individual
2443input sections for redistribution, so if a single input section contains
2444more than @var{count} relocations one output section will contain that
a854a4a7 2445many relocations. @var{count} defaults to a value of 32768.
252b5132
RH
2446
2447@kindex --stats
2448@item --stats
2449Compute and display statistics about the operation of the linker, such
2450as execution time and memory usage.
2451
2509a395 2452@kindex --sysroot=@var{directory}
e2243057
RS
2453@item --sysroot=@var{directory}
2454Use @var{directory} as the location of the sysroot, overriding the
2455configure-time default. This option is only supported by linkers
2456that were configured using @option{--with-sysroot}.
2457
a70f34c0
NC
2458@kindex --task-link
2459@item --task-link
2460This is used by COFF/PE based targets to create a task-linked object
2461file where all of the global symbols have been converted to statics.
2462
252b5132
RH
2463@kindex --traditional-format
2464@cindex traditional format
2465@item --traditional-format
ff5dcc92
SC
2466For some targets, the output of @command{ld} is different in some ways from
2467the output of some existing linker. This switch requests @command{ld} to
252b5132
RH
2468use the traditional format instead.
2469
2470@cindex dbx
ff5dcc92 2471For example, on SunOS, @command{ld} combines duplicate entries in the
252b5132
RH
2472symbol string table. This can reduce the size of an output file with
2473full debugging information by over 30 percent. Unfortunately, the SunOS
2474@code{dbx} program can not read the resulting program (@code{gdb} has no
ff5dcc92 2475trouble). The @samp{--traditional-format} switch tells @command{ld} to not
252b5132
RH
2476combine duplicate entries.
2477
2509a395
SL
2478@kindex --section-start=@var{sectionname}=@var{org}
2479@item --section-start=@var{sectionname}=@var{org}
176355da
NC
2480Locate a section in the output file at the absolute
2481address given by @var{org}. You may use this option as many
2482times as necessary to locate multiple sections in the command
2483line.
2484@var{org} must be a single hexadecimal integer;
2485for compatibility with other linkers, you may omit the leading
2486@samp{0x} usually associated with hexadecimal values. @emph{Note:} there
2487should be no white space between @var{sectionname}, the equals
2488sign (``@key{=}''), and @var{org}.
2489
2509a395
SL
2490@kindex -Tbss=@var{org}
2491@kindex -Tdata=@var{org}
2492@kindex -Ttext=@var{org}
252b5132 2493@cindex segment origins, cmd line
2509a395
SL
2494@item -Tbss=@var{org}
2495@itemx -Tdata=@var{org}
2496@itemx -Ttext=@var{org}
2497Same as @option{--section-start}, with @code{.bss}, @code{.data} or
a6e02871 2498@code{.text} as the @var{sectionname}.
252b5132 2499
2509a395
SL
2500@kindex -Ttext-segment=@var{org}
2501@item -Ttext-segment=@var{org}
258795f5 2502@cindex text segment origin, cmd line
2b8c06a3
L
2503When creating an ELF executable, it will set the address of the first
2504byte of the text segment.
258795f5 2505
9d5777a3
RM
2506@kindex -Trodata-segment=@var{org}
2507@item -Trodata-segment=@var{org}
2508@cindex rodata segment origin, cmd line
2509When creating an ELF executable or shared object for a target where
2510the read-only data is in its own segment separate from the executable
2511text, it will set the address of the first byte of the read-only data segment.
2512
0d705e9f
AM
2513@kindex -Tldata-segment=@var{org}
2514@item -Tldata-segment=@var{org}
2515@cindex ldata segment origin, cmd line
2516When creating an ELF executable or shared object for x86-64 medium memory
2517model, it will set the address of the first byte of the ldata segment.
2518
560e09e9
NC
2519@kindex --unresolved-symbols
2520@item --unresolved-symbols=@var{method}
2521Determine how to handle unresolved symbols. There are four possible
2522values for @samp{method}:
2523
2524@table @samp
2525@item ignore-all
da8bce14 2526Do not report any unresolved symbols.
560e09e9
NC
2527
2528@item report-all
da8bce14 2529Report all unresolved symbols. This is the default.
560e09e9
NC
2530
2531@item ignore-in-object-files
2532Report unresolved symbols that are contained in shared libraries, but
2533ignore them if they come from regular object files.
2534
2535@item ignore-in-shared-libs
2536Report unresolved symbols that come from regular object files, but
2537ignore them if they come from shared libraries. This can be useful
2538when creating a dynamic binary and it is known that all the shared
2539libraries that it should be referencing are included on the linker's
2540command line.
2541@end table
2542
2543The behaviour for shared libraries on their own can also be controlled
2544by the @option{--[no-]allow-shlib-undefined} option.
2545
2546Normally the linker will generate an error message for each reported
2547unresolved symbol but the option @option{--warn-unresolved-symbols}
2548can change this to a warning.
2549
1715a13c
L
2550@kindex --verbose[=@var{NUMBER}]
2551@cindex verbose[=@var{NUMBER}]
252b5132 2552@item --dll-verbose
1715a13c 2553@itemx --verbose[=@var{NUMBER}]
ff5dcc92 2554Display the version number for @command{ld} and list the linker emulations
252b5132 2555supported. Display which input files can and cannot be opened. Display
1715a13c
L
2556the linker script being used by the linker. If the optional @var{NUMBER}
2557argument > 1, plugin symbol status will also be displayed.
252b5132
RH
2558
2559@kindex --version-script=@var{version-scriptfile}
2560@cindex version script, symbol versions
2509a395 2561@item --version-script=@var{version-scriptfile}
252b5132
RH
2562Specify the name of a version script to the linker. This is typically
2563used when creating shared libraries to specify additional information
36f63dca 2564about the version hierarchy for the library being created. This option
09e2aba4
DK
2565is only fully supported on ELF platforms which support shared libraries;
2566see @ref{VERSION}. It is partially supported on PE platforms, which can
2567use version scripts to filter symbol visibility in auto-export mode: any
2568symbols marked @samp{local} in the version script will not be exported.
2569@xref{WIN32}.
252b5132 2570
7ce691ae 2571@kindex --warn-common
252b5132
RH
2572@cindex warnings, on combining symbols
2573@cindex combining symbols, warnings on
2574@item --warn-common
2575Warn when a common symbol is combined with another common symbol or with
11e7fd74 2576a symbol definition. Unix linkers allow this somewhat sloppy practice,
252b5132
RH
2577but linkers on some other operating systems do not. This option allows
2578you to find potential problems from combining global symbols.
11e7fd74 2579Unfortunately, some C libraries use this practice, so you may get some
252b5132
RH
2580warnings about symbols in the libraries as well as in your programs.
2581
2582There are three kinds of global symbols, illustrated here by C examples:
2583
2584@table @samp
2585@item int i = 1;
2586A definition, which goes in the initialized data section of the output
2587file.
2588
2589@item extern int i;
2590An undefined reference, which does not allocate space.
2591There must be either a definition or a common symbol for the
2592variable somewhere.
2593
2594@item int i;
2595A common symbol. If there are only (one or more) common symbols for a
2596variable, it goes in the uninitialized data area of the output file.
2597The linker merges multiple common symbols for the same variable into a
2598single symbol. If they are of different sizes, it picks the largest
2599size. The linker turns a common symbol into a declaration, if there is
2600a definition of the same variable.
2601@end table
2602
2603The @samp{--warn-common} option can produce five kinds of warnings.
2604Each warning consists of a pair of lines: the first describes the symbol
2605just encountered, and the second describes the previous symbol
2606encountered with the same name. One or both of the two symbols will be
2607a common symbol.
2608
2609@enumerate
2610@item
2611Turning a common symbol into a reference, because there is already a
2612definition for the symbol.
2613@smallexample
2614@var{file}(@var{section}): warning: common of `@var{symbol}'
2615 overridden by definition
2616@var{file}(@var{section}): warning: defined here
2617@end smallexample
2618
2619@item
2620Turning a common symbol into a reference, because a later definition for
2621the symbol is encountered. This is the same as the previous case,
2622except that the symbols are encountered in a different order.
2623@smallexample
2624@var{file}(@var{section}): warning: definition of `@var{symbol}'
2625 overriding common
2626@var{file}(@var{section}): warning: common is here
2627@end smallexample
2628
2629@item
2630Merging a common symbol with a previous same-sized common symbol.
2631@smallexample
2632@var{file}(@var{section}): warning: multiple common
2633 of `@var{symbol}'
2634@var{file}(@var{section}): warning: previous common is here
2635@end smallexample
2636
2637@item
2638Merging a common symbol with a previous larger common symbol.
2639@smallexample
2640@var{file}(@var{section}): warning: common of `@var{symbol}'
2641 overridden by larger common
2642@var{file}(@var{section}): warning: larger common is here
2643@end smallexample
2644
2645@item
2646Merging a common symbol with a previous smaller common symbol. This is
2647the same as the previous case, except that the symbols are
2648encountered in a different order.
2649@smallexample
2650@var{file}(@var{section}): warning: common of `@var{symbol}'
2651 overriding smaller common
2652@var{file}(@var{section}): warning: smaller common is here
2653@end smallexample
2654@end enumerate
2655
2656@kindex --warn-constructors
2657@item --warn-constructors
2658Warn if any global constructors are used. This is only useful for a few
2659object file formats. For formats like COFF or ELF, the linker can not
2660detect the use of global constructors.
2661
65daf5be 2662@kindex --warn-execstack
bd7d326d 2663@cindex warnings, on executable stack
65daf5be
NC
2664@cindex executable stack, warnings on
2665@item --warn-execstack
2666@itemx --no-warn-execstack
2667On ELF platforms this option controls how the linker generates warning
2668messages when it creates an output file with an executable stack. By
2669default the linker will not warn if the @command{-z execstack} command
2670line option has been used, but this behaviour can be overridden by the
2671@option{--warn-execstack} option.
2672
2673On the other hand the linker will normally warn if the stack is made
2674executable because one or more of the input files need an execuable
2675stack and neither of the @command{-z execstack} or @command{-z
bd7d326d 2676noexecstack} command line options have been specified. This warning
65daf5be
NC
2677can be disabled via the @command{--no-warn-execstack} option.
2678
2679Note: ELF format input files specify that they need an executable
2680stack by having a @var{.note.GNU-stack} section with the executable
2681bit set in its section flags. They can specify that they do not need
2682an executable stack by having that section, but without the executable
2683flag bit set. If an input file does not have a @var{.note.GNU-stack}
2684section present then the default behaviour is target specific. For
2685some targets, then absence of such a section implies that an
2686executable stack @emph{is} required. This is often a problem for hand
2687crafted assembler files.
2688
252b5132
RH
2689@kindex --warn-multiple-gp
2690@item --warn-multiple-gp
2691Warn if multiple global pointer values are required in the output file.
2692This is only meaningful for certain processors, such as the Alpha.
2693Specifically, some processors put large-valued constants in a special
2694section. A special register (the global pointer) points into the middle
2695of this section, so that constants can be loaded efficiently via a
2696base-register relative addressing mode. Since the offset in
2697base-register relative mode is fixed and relatively small (e.g., 16
2698bits), this limits the maximum size of the constant pool. Thus, in
2699large programs, it is often necessary to use multiple global pointer
2700values in order to be able to address all possible constants. This
2701option causes a warning to be issued whenever this case occurs.
2702
2703@kindex --warn-once
2704@cindex warnings, on undefined symbols
2705@cindex undefined symbols, warnings on
2706@item --warn-once
2707Only warn once for each undefined symbol, rather than once per module
2708which refers to it.
2709
ba951afb
NC
2710@kindex --warn-rwx-segments
2711@cindex warnings, on writeable and exectuable segments
2712@cindex executable segments, warnings on
2713@item --warn-rwx-segments
2714@itemx --no-warn-rwx-segments
2715Warn if the linker creates a loadable, non-zero sized segment that has
2716all three of the read, write and execute permission flags set. Such a
2717segment represents a potential security vulnerability. In addition
2718warnings will be generated if a thread local storage segment is
2719created with the execute permission flag set, regardless of whether or
2720not it has the read and/or write flags set.
2721
2722These warnings are enabled by default. They can be disabled via the
2723@option{--no-warn-rwx-segments} option and re-enabled via the
2724@option{--warn-rwx-segments} option.
2725
252b5132
RH
2726@kindex --warn-section-align
2727@cindex warnings, on section alignment
2728@cindex section alignment, warnings on
2729@item --warn-section-align
2730Warn if the address of an output section is changed because of
2731alignment. Typically, the alignment will be set by an input section.
2732The address will only be changed if it not explicitly specified; that
2733is, if the @code{SECTIONS} command does not specify a start address for
2734the section (@pxref{SECTIONS}).
2735
a6dbf402
L
2736@kindex --warn-textrel
2737@item --warn-textrel
2738Warn if the linker adds DT_TEXTREL to a position-independent executable
2739or shared object.
8fdd7217 2740
a0c402a5
L
2741@kindex --warn-alternate-em
2742@item --warn-alternate-em
2743Warn if an object has alternate ELF machine code.
2744
560e09e9
NC
2745@kindex --warn-unresolved-symbols
2746@item --warn-unresolved-symbols
2747If the linker is going to report an unresolved symbol (see the option
2748@option{--unresolved-symbols}) it will normally generate an error.
2749This option makes it generate a warning instead.
2750
2751@kindex --error-unresolved-symbols
2752@item --error-unresolved-symbols
2753This restores the linker's default behaviour of generating errors when
2754it is reporting unresolved symbols.
2755
252b5132
RH
2756@kindex --whole-archive
2757@cindex including an entire archive
2758@item --whole-archive
2759For each archive mentioned on the command line after the
ff5dcc92 2760@option{--whole-archive} option, include every object file in the archive
252b5132
RH
2761in the link, rather than searching the archive for the required object
2762files. This is normally used to turn an archive file into a shared
2763library, forcing every object to be included in the resulting shared
2764library. This option may be used more than once.
2765
7ec229ce 2766Two notes when using this option from gcc: First, gcc doesn't know
ff5dcc92
SC
2767about this option, so you have to use @option{-Wl,-whole-archive}.
2768Second, don't forget to use @option{-Wl,-no-whole-archive} after your
7ec229ce
DD
2769list of archives, because gcc will add its own list of archives to
2770your link and you may not want this flag to affect those as well.
2771
2509a395
SL
2772@kindex --wrap=@var{symbol}
2773@item --wrap=@var{symbol}
252b5132
RH
2774Use a wrapper function for @var{symbol}. Any undefined reference to
2775@var{symbol} will be resolved to @code{__wrap_@var{symbol}}. Any
2776undefined reference to @code{__real_@var{symbol}} will be resolved to
2777@var{symbol}.
2778
2779This can be used to provide a wrapper for a system function. The
2780wrapper function should be called @code{__wrap_@var{symbol}}. If it
2781wishes to call the system function, it should call
2782@code{__real_@var{symbol}}.
2783
2784Here is a trivial example:
2785
2786@smallexample
2787void *
cc2f008e 2788__wrap_malloc (size_t c)
252b5132 2789@{
cc2f008e 2790 printf ("malloc called with %zu\n", c);
252b5132
RH
2791 return __real_malloc (c);
2792@}
2793@end smallexample
2794
ff5dcc92 2795If you link other code with this file using @option{--wrap malloc}, then
252b5132
RH
2796all calls to @code{malloc} will call the function @code{__wrap_malloc}
2797instead. The call to @code{__real_malloc} in @code{__wrap_malloc} will
2798call the real @code{malloc} function.
2799
2800You may wish to provide a @code{__real_malloc} function as well, so that
ff5dcc92 2801links without the @option{--wrap} option will succeed. If you do this,
252b5132
RH
2802you should not put the definition of @code{__real_malloc} in the same
2803file as @code{__wrap_malloc}; if you do, the assembler may resolve the
2804call before the linker has a chance to wrap it to @code{malloc}.
2805
4ea904ed
SH
2806Only undefined references are replaced by the linker. So, translation unit
2807internal references to @var{symbol} are not resolved to
2808@code{__wrap_@var{symbol}}. In the next example, the call to @code{f} in
2809@code{g} is not resolved to @code{__wrap_f}.
2810
2811@smallexample
2812int
2813f (void)
2814@{
2815 return 123;
2816@}
2817
2818int
2819g (void)
2820@{
2821 return f();
2822@}
2823@end smallexample
2824
6aa29e7b 2825@kindex --eh-frame-hdr
29063f8b 2826@kindex --no-eh-frame-hdr
6aa29e7b 2827@item --eh-frame-hdr
29063f8b
NC
2828@itemx --no-eh-frame-hdr
2829Request (@option{--eh-frame-hdr}) or suppress
2830(@option{--no-eh-frame-hdr}) the creation of @code{.eh_frame_hdr}
2831section and ELF @code{PT_GNU_EH_FRAME} segment header.
6aa29e7b 2832
e41b3a13
JJ
2833@kindex --ld-generated-unwind-info
2834@item --no-ld-generated-unwind-info
2835Request creation of @code{.eh_frame} unwind info for linker
2836generated code sections like PLT. This option is on by default
cf0e0a0b
IB
2837if linker generated unwind info is supported. This option also
2838controls the generation of @code{.sframe} unwind info for linker
2839generated code sections like PLT.
e41b3a13 2840
6c1439be
L
2841@kindex --enable-new-dtags
2842@kindex --disable-new-dtags
2843@item --enable-new-dtags
2844@itemx --disable-new-dtags
2845This linker can create the new dynamic tags in ELF. But the older ELF
2846systems may not understand them. If you specify
b1b00fcc
MF
2847@option{--enable-new-dtags}, the new dynamic tags will be created as needed
2848and older dynamic tags will be omitted.
ff5dcc92 2849If you specify @option{--disable-new-dtags}, no new dynamic tags will be
6c1439be
L
2850created. By default, the new dynamic tags are not created. Note that
2851those options are only available for ELF systems.
2852
2d643429 2853@kindex --hash-size=@var{number}
e185dd51 2854@item --hash-size=@var{number}
2d643429
NC
2855Set the default size of the linker's hash tables to a prime number
2856close to @var{number}. Increasing this value can reduce the length of
2857time it takes the linker to perform its tasks, at the expense of
2858increasing the linker's memory requirements. Similarly reducing this
2859value can reduce the memory requirements at the expense of speed.
2860
fdc90cb4
JJ
2861@kindex --hash-style=@var{style}
2862@item --hash-style=@var{style}
2863Set the type of linker's hash table(s). @var{style} can be either
2864@code{sysv} for classic ELF @code{.hash} section, @code{gnu} for
2865new style GNU @code{.gnu.hash} section or @code{both} for both
2866the classic ELF @code{.hash} and new style GNU @code{.gnu.hash}
c8455dc9
NC
2867hash tables. The default depends upon how the linker was configured,
2868but for most Linux based systems it will be @code{both}.
fdc90cb4 2869
0ce398f1
L
2870@kindex --compress-debug-sections=none
2871@kindex --compress-debug-sections=zlib
2872@kindex --compress-debug-sections=zlib-gnu
2873@kindex --compress-debug-sections=zlib-gabi
2cac01e3 2874@kindex --compress-debug-sections=zstd
0ce398f1
L
2875@item --compress-debug-sections=none
2876@itemx --compress-debug-sections=zlib
2877@itemx --compress-debug-sections=zlib-gnu
2878@itemx --compress-debug-sections=zlib-gabi
2cac01e3 2879@itemx --compress-debug-sections=zstd
9af89fba
NC
2880On ELF platforms, these options control how DWARF debug sections are
2881compressed using zlib.
2882
2883@option{--compress-debug-sections=none} doesn't compress DWARF debug
2884sections. @option{--compress-debug-sections=zlib-gnu} compresses
2885DWARF debug sections and renames them to begin with @samp{.zdebug}
2886instead of @samp{.debug}. @option{--compress-debug-sections=zlib-gabi}
2887also compresses DWARF debug sections, but rather than renaming them it
2888sets the SHF_COMPRESSED flag in the sections' headers.
2889
2890The @option{--compress-debug-sections=zlib} option is an alias for
2891@option{--compress-debug-sections=zlib-gabi}.
2892
2cac01e3
FS
2893@option{--compress-debug-sections=zstd} compresses DWARF debug sections using
2894zstd.
2895
9af89fba
NC
2896Note that this option overrides any compression in input debug
2897sections, so if a binary is linked with @option{--compress-debug-sections=none}
2898for example, then any compressed debug sections in input files will be
2899uncompressed before they are copied into the output binary.
2900
2901The default compression behaviour varies depending upon the target
2902involved and the configure options used to build the toolchain. The
2903default can be determined by examining the output from the linker's
2904@option{--help} option.
0ce398f1 2905
35835446
JR
2906@kindex --reduce-memory-overheads
2907@item --reduce-memory-overheads
2908This option reduces memory requirements at ld runtime, at the expense of
f2a8f148 2909linking speed. This was introduced to select the old O(n^2) algorithm
35835446 2910for link map file generation, rather than the new O(n) algorithm which uses
2d643429
NC
2911about 40% more memory for symbol storage.
2912
4f9c04f7 2913Another effect of the switch is to set the default hash table size to
2d643429 29141021, which again saves memory at the cost of lengthening the linker's
a85785bc 2915run time. This is not done however if the @option{--hash-size} switch
2d643429
NC
2916has been used.
2917
2918The @option{--reduce-memory-overheads} switch may be also be used to
2919enable other tradeoffs in future versions of the linker.
35835446 2920
a8dde0a2
L
2921@kindex --max-cache-size=@var{size}
2922@item --max-cache-size=@var{size}
2923@command{ld} normally caches the relocation information and symbol tables
2924of input files in memory with the unlimited size. This option sets the
2925maximum cache size to @var{size}.
2926
c0065db7
RM
2927@kindex --build-id
2928@kindex --build-id=@var{style}
2929@item --build-id
2930@itemx --build-id=@var{style}
61e2488c 2931Request the creation of a @code{.note.gnu.build-id} ELF note section
6033bf41 2932or a @code{.buildid} COFF section. The contents of the note are
61e2488c
JT
2933unique bits identifying this linked file. @var{style} can be
2934@code{uuid} to use 128 random bits, @code{sha1} to use a 160-bit
2935@sc{SHA1} hash on the normative parts of the output contents,
2936@code{md5} to use a 128-bit @sc{MD5} hash on the normative parts of
2937the output contents, or @code{0x@var{hexstring}} to use a chosen bit
2938string specified as an even number of hexadecimal digits (@code{-} and
2939@code{:} characters between digit pairs are ignored). If @var{style}
2940is omitted, @code{sha1} is used.
24382dca
RM
2941
2942The @code{md5} and @code{sha1} styles produces an identifier
2943that is always the same in an identical output file, but will be
2944unique among all nonidentical output files. It is not intended
2945to be compared as a checksum for the file's contents. A linked
2946file may be changed later by other tools, but the build ID bit
2947string identifying the original linked file does not change.
c0065db7
RM
2948
2949Passing @code{none} for @var{style} disables the setting from any
2950@code{--build-id} options earlier on the command line.
9e2bb0cb
LB
2951
2952@kindex --package-metadata=@var{JSON}
2953@item --package-metadata=@var{JSON}
2954Request the creation of a @code{.note.package} ELF note section. The
2955contents of the note are in JSON format, as per the package metadata
2956specification. For more information see:
2957https://systemd.io/ELF_PACKAGE_METADATA/
2958If the JSON argument is missing/empty then this will disable the
2959creation of the metadata note, if one had been enabled by an earlier
2960occurrence of the --package-metdata option.
2961If the linker has been built with libjansson, then the JSON string
2962will be validated.
252b5132
RH
2963@end table
2964
0285c67d
NC
2965@c man end
2966
36f63dca 2967@subsection Options Specific to i386 PE Targets
252b5132 2968
0285c67d
NC
2969@c man begin OPTIONS
2970
ff5dcc92 2971The i386 PE linker supports the @option{-shared} option, which causes
252b5132
RH
2972the output to be a dynamically linked library (DLL) instead of a
2973normal executable. You should name the output @code{*.dll} when you
2974use this option. In addition, the linker fully supports the standard
2975@code{*.def} files, which may be specified on the linker command line
2976like an object file (in fact, it should precede archives it exports
2977symbols from, to ensure that they get linked in, just like a normal
2978object file).
2979
2980In addition to the options common to all targets, the i386 PE linker
a05a5b64 2981support additional command-line options that are specific to the i386
252b5132
RH
2982PE target. Options that take values may be separated from their
2983values by either a space or an equals sign.
2984
ff5dcc92 2985@table @gcctabopt
252b5132
RH
2986
2987@kindex --add-stdcall-alias
2988@item --add-stdcall-alias
2989If given, symbols with a stdcall suffix (@@@var{nn}) will be exported
2990as-is and also with the suffix stripped.
bb10df36 2991[This option is specific to the i386 PE targeted port of the linker]
252b5132
RH
2992
2993@kindex --base-file
2994@item --base-file @var{file}
2995Use @var{file} as the name of a file in which to save the base
2996addresses of all the relocations needed for generating DLLs with
2997@file{dlltool}.
bb10df36 2998[This is an i386 PE specific option]
252b5132
RH
2999
3000@kindex --dll
3001@item --dll
3002Create a DLL instead of a regular executable. You may also use
ff5dcc92 3003@option{-shared} or specify a @code{LIBRARY} in a given @code{.def}
252b5132 3004file.
bb10df36 3005[This option is specific to the i386 PE targeted port of the linker]
252b5132 3006
88183869
DK
3007@kindex --enable-long-section-names
3008@kindex --disable-long-section-names
3009@item --enable-long-section-names
3010@itemx --disable-long-section-names
56e6cf80 3011The PE variants of the COFF object format add an extension that permits
88183869 3012the use of section names longer than eight characters, the normal limit
56e6cf80
NC
3013for COFF. By default, these names are only allowed in object files, as
3014fully-linked executable images do not carry the COFF string table required
88183869
DK
3015to support the longer names. As a GNU extension, it is possible to
3016allow their use in executable images as well, or to (probably pointlessly!)
3017disallow it in object files, by using these two options. Executable images
3018generated with these long section names are slightly non-standard, carrying
3019as they do a string table, and may generate confusing output when examined
9d5777a3
RM
3020with non-GNU PE-aware tools, such as file viewers and dumpers. However,
3021GDB relies on the use of PE long section names to find Dwarf-2 debug
3efd345c
DK
3022information sections in an executable image at runtime, and so if neither
3023option is specified on the command-line, @command{ld} will enable long
3024section names, overriding the default and technically correct behaviour,
3025when it finds the presence of debug information while linking an executable
3026image and not stripping symbols.
88183869
DK
3027[This option is valid for all PE targeted ports of the linker]
3028
252b5132
RH
3029@kindex --enable-stdcall-fixup
3030@kindex --disable-stdcall-fixup
3031@item --enable-stdcall-fixup
3032@itemx --disable-stdcall-fixup
3033If the link finds a symbol that it cannot resolve, it will attempt to
36f63dca 3034do ``fuzzy linking'' by looking for another defined symbol that differs
252b5132
RH
3035only in the format of the symbol name (cdecl vs stdcall) and will
3036resolve that symbol by linking to the match. For example, the
3037undefined symbol @code{_foo} might be linked to the function
3038@code{_foo@@12}, or the undefined symbol @code{_bar@@16} might be linked
3039to the function @code{_bar}. When the linker does this, it prints a
3040warning, since it normally should have failed to link, but sometimes
3041import libraries generated from third-party dlls may need this feature
ff5dcc92 3042to be usable. If you specify @option{--enable-stdcall-fixup}, this
252b5132 3043feature is fully enabled and warnings are not printed. If you specify
ff5dcc92 3044@option{--disable-stdcall-fixup}, this feature is disabled and such
252b5132 3045mismatches are considered to be errors.
bb10df36 3046[This option is specific to the i386 PE targeted port of the linker]
252b5132 3047
522f09cd
KT
3048@kindex --leading-underscore
3049@kindex --no-leading-underscore
3050@item --leading-underscore
3051@itemx --no-leading-underscore
3052For most targets default symbol-prefix is an underscore and is defined
3053in target's description. By this option it is possible to
3054disable/enable the default underscore symbol-prefix.
3055
252b5132
RH
3056@cindex DLLs, creating
3057@kindex --export-all-symbols
3058@item --export-all-symbols
3059If given, all global symbols in the objects used to build a DLL will
3060be exported by the DLL. Note that this is the default if there
3061otherwise wouldn't be any exported symbols. When symbols are
3062explicitly exported via DEF files or implicitly exported via function
3063attributes, the default is to not export anything else unless this
3064option is given. Note that the symbols @code{DllMain@@12},
ece2d90e 3065@code{DllEntryPoint@@0}, @code{DllMainCRTStartup@@12}, and
b044cda1 3066@code{impure_ptr} will not be automatically
ece2d90e
NC
3067exported. Also, symbols imported from other DLLs will not be
3068re-exported, nor will symbols specifying the DLL's internal layout
3069such as those beginning with @code{_head_} or ending with
3070@code{_iname}. In addition, no symbols from @code{libgcc},
b044cda1
CW
3071@code{libstd++}, @code{libmingw32}, or @code{crtX.o} will be exported.
3072Symbols whose names begin with @code{__rtti_} or @code{__builtin_} will
3073not be exported, to help with C++ DLLs. Finally, there is an
ece2d90e 3074extensive list of cygwin-private symbols that are not exported
b044cda1 3075(obviously, this applies on when building DLLs for cygwin targets).
ece2d90e 3076These cygwin-excludes are: @code{_cygwin_dll_entry@@12},
b044cda1 3077@code{_cygwin_crt0_common@@8}, @code{_cygwin_noncygwin_dll_entry@@12},
ece2d90e 3078@code{_fmode}, @code{_impure_ptr}, @code{cygwin_attach_dll},
b044cda1 3079@code{cygwin_premain0}, @code{cygwin_premain1}, @code{cygwin_premain2},
ece2d90e 3080@code{cygwin_premain3}, and @code{environ}.
bb10df36 3081[This option is specific to the i386 PE targeted port of the linker]
252b5132
RH
3082
3083@kindex --exclude-symbols
1d0a3c9c 3084@item --exclude-symbols @var{symbol},@var{symbol},...
252b5132
RH
3085Specifies a list of symbols which should not be automatically
3086exported. The symbol names may be delimited by commas or colons.
bb10df36 3087[This option is specific to the i386 PE targeted port of the linker]
252b5132 3088
2927aaca
NC
3089@kindex --exclude-all-symbols
3090@item --exclude-all-symbols
3091Specifies no symbols should be automatically exported.
3092[This option is specific to the i386 PE targeted port of the linker]
3093
252b5132
RH
3094@kindex --file-alignment
3095@item --file-alignment
3096Specify the file alignment. Sections in the file will always begin at
3097file offsets which are multiples of this number. This defaults to
3098512.
bb10df36 3099[This option is specific to the i386 PE targeted port of the linker]
252b5132
RH
3100
3101@cindex heap size
3102@kindex --heap
3103@item --heap @var{reserve}
3104@itemx --heap @var{reserve},@var{commit}
a00b50c5 3105Specify the number of bytes of memory to reserve (and optionally commit)
fe6d7d6a 3106to be used as heap for this program. The default is 1MB reserved, 4K
252b5132 3107committed.
bb10df36 3108[This option is specific to the i386 PE targeted port of the linker]
252b5132
RH
3109
3110@cindex image base
3111@kindex --image-base
3112@item --image-base @var{value}
3113Use @var{value} as the base address of your program or dll. This is
3114the lowest memory location that will be used when your program or dll
3115is loaded. To reduce the need to relocate and improve performance of
3116your dlls, each should have a unique base address and not overlap any
3117other dlls. The default is 0x400000 for executables, and 0x10000000
3118for dlls.
bb10df36 3119[This option is specific to the i386 PE targeted port of the linker]
252b5132
RH
3120
3121@kindex --kill-at
3122@item --kill-at
3123If given, the stdcall suffixes (@@@var{nn}) will be stripped from
3124symbols before they are exported.
bb10df36 3125[This option is specific to the i386 PE targeted port of the linker]
252b5132 3126
26d2d8a2
BF
3127@kindex --large-address-aware
3128@item --large-address-aware
b45619c0 3129If given, the appropriate bit in the ``Characteristics'' field of the COFF
26d2d8a2 3130header is set to indicate that this executable supports virtual addresses
b45619c0 3131greater than 2 gigabytes. This should be used in conjunction with the /3GB
26d2d8a2
BF
3132or /USERVA=@var{value} megabytes switch in the ``[operating systems]''
3133section of the BOOT.INI. Otherwise, this bit has no effect.
3134[This option is specific to PE targeted ports of the linker]
3135
f69a2f97
NC
3136@kindex --disable-large-address-aware
3137@item --disable-large-address-aware
3138Reverts the effect of a previous @samp{--large-address-aware} option.
3139This is useful if @samp{--large-address-aware} is always set by the compiler
3140driver (e.g. Cygwin gcc) and the executable does not support virtual
3141addresses greater than 2 gigabytes.
3142[This option is specific to PE targeted ports of the linker]
3143
252b5132
RH
3144@kindex --major-image-version
3145@item --major-image-version @var{value}
36f63dca 3146Sets the major number of the ``image version''. Defaults to 1.
bb10df36 3147[This option is specific to the i386 PE targeted port of the linker]
252b5132
RH
3148
3149@kindex --major-os-version
3150@item --major-os-version @var{value}
36f63dca 3151Sets the major number of the ``os version''. Defaults to 4.
bb10df36 3152[This option is specific to the i386 PE targeted port of the linker]
252b5132
RH
3153
3154@kindex --major-subsystem-version
3155@item --major-subsystem-version @var{value}
36f63dca 3156Sets the major number of the ``subsystem version''. Defaults to 4.
bb10df36 3157[This option is specific to the i386 PE targeted port of the linker]
252b5132
RH
3158
3159@kindex --minor-image-version
3160@item --minor-image-version @var{value}
36f63dca 3161Sets the minor number of the ``image version''. Defaults to 0.
bb10df36 3162[This option is specific to the i386 PE targeted port of the linker]
252b5132
RH
3163
3164@kindex --minor-os-version
3165@item --minor-os-version @var{value}
36f63dca 3166Sets the minor number of the ``os version''. Defaults to 0.
bb10df36 3167[This option is specific to the i386 PE targeted port of the linker]
252b5132
RH
3168
3169@kindex --minor-subsystem-version
3170@item --minor-subsystem-version @var{value}
36f63dca 3171Sets the minor number of the ``subsystem version''. Defaults to 0.
bb10df36 3172[This option is specific to the i386 PE targeted port of the linker]
252b5132
RH
3173
3174@cindex DEF files, creating
3175@cindex DLLs, creating
3176@kindex --output-def
3177@item --output-def @var{file}
3178The linker will create the file @var{file} which will contain a DEF
3179file corresponding to the DLL the linker is generating. This DEF file
3180(which should be called @code{*.def}) may be used to create an import
3181library with @code{dlltool} or may be used as a reference to
3182automatically or implicitly exported symbols.
bb10df36 3183[This option is specific to the i386 PE targeted port of the linker]
252b5132 3184
b044cda1 3185@cindex DLLs, creating
b044cda1
CW
3186@kindex --enable-auto-image-base
3187@item --enable-auto-image-base
d0e6d77b
CF
3188@itemx --enable-auto-image-base=@var{value}
3189Automatically choose the image base for DLLs, optionally starting with base
3190@var{value}, unless one is specified using the @code{--image-base} argument.
3191By using a hash generated from the dllname to create unique image bases
3192for each DLL, in-memory collisions and relocations which can delay program
3193execution are avoided.
bb10df36 3194[This option is specific to the i386 PE targeted port of the linker]
b044cda1
CW
3195
3196@kindex --disable-auto-image-base
3197@item --disable-auto-image-base
3198Do not automatically generate a unique image base. If there is no
3199user-specified image base (@code{--image-base}) then use the platform
3200default.
bb10df36 3201[This option is specific to the i386 PE targeted port of the linker]
b044cda1
CW
3202
3203@cindex DLLs, linking to
3204@kindex --dll-search-prefix
3205@item --dll-search-prefix @var{string}
489d0400 3206When linking dynamically to a dll without an import library,
ece2d90e 3207search for @code{<string><basename>.dll} in preference to
560e09e9 3208@code{lib<basename>.dll}. This behaviour allows easy distinction
b044cda1
CW
3209between DLLs built for the various "subplatforms": native, cygwin,
3210uwin, pw, etc. For instance, cygwin DLLs typically use
ece2d90e 3211@code{--dll-search-prefix=cyg}.
bb10df36 3212[This option is specific to the i386 PE targeted port of the linker]
b044cda1
CW
3213
3214@kindex --enable-auto-import
3215@item --enable-auto-import
ece2d90e 3216Do sophisticated linking of @code{_symbol} to @code{__imp__symbol} for
317ff008
EB
3217DATA imports from DLLs, thus making it possible to bypass the dllimport
3218mechanism on the user side and to reference unmangled symbol names.
3219[This option is specific to the i386 PE targeted port of the linker]
3220
3221The following remarks pertain to the original implementation of the
3222feature and are obsolete nowadays for Cygwin and MinGW targets.
3223
3224Note: Use of the 'auto-import' extension will cause the text section
3225of the image file to be made writable. This does not conform to the
3226PE-COFF format specification published by Microsoft.
4d8907ac 3227
e2a83dd0
NC
3228Note - use of the 'auto-import' extension will also cause read only
3229data which would normally be placed into the .rdata section to be
3230placed into the .data section instead. This is in order to work
3231around a problem with consts that is described here:
3232http://www.cygwin.com/ml/cygwin/2004-09/msg01101.html
3233
4d8907ac
DS
3234Using 'auto-import' generally will 'just work' -- but sometimes you may
3235see this message:
0d888aac 3236
ece2d90e 3237"variable '<var>' can't be auto-imported. Please read the
0d888aac
CW
3238documentation for ld's @code{--enable-auto-import} for details."
3239
ece2d90e
NC
3240This message occurs when some (sub)expression accesses an address
3241ultimately given by the sum of two constants (Win32 import tables only
c0065db7
RM
3242allow one). Instances where this may occur include accesses to member
3243fields of struct variables imported from a DLL, as well as using a
3244constant index into an array variable imported from a DLL. Any
2f8d8971
NC
3245multiword variable (arrays, structs, long long, etc) may trigger
3246this error condition. However, regardless of the exact data type
3247of the offending exported variable, ld will always detect it, issue
3248the warning, and exit.
3249
3250There are several ways to address this difficulty, regardless of the
3251data type of the exported variable:
0d888aac 3252
2fa9fc65
NC
3253One way is to use --enable-runtime-pseudo-reloc switch. This leaves the task
3254of adjusting references in your client code for runtime environment, so
560e09e9 3255this method works only when runtime environment supports this feature.
2fa9fc65 3256
c0065db7
RM
3257A second solution is to force one of the 'constants' to be a variable --
3258that is, unknown and un-optimizable at compile time. For arrays,
3259there are two possibilities: a) make the indexee (the array's address)
0d888aac
CW
3260a variable, or b) make the 'constant' index a variable. Thus:
3261
3262@example
3263extern type extern_array[];
c0065db7 3264extern_array[1] -->
0d888aac
CW
3265 @{ volatile type *t=extern_array; t[1] @}
3266@end example
3267
3268or
3269
3270@example
3271extern type extern_array[];
c0065db7 3272extern_array[1] -->
0d888aac
CW
3273 @{ volatile int t=1; extern_array[t] @}
3274@end example
3275
c0065db7 3276For structs (and most other multiword data types) the only option
2f8d8971 3277is to make the struct itself (or the long long, or the ...) variable:
0d888aac
CW
3278
3279@example
3280extern struct s extern_struct;
c0065db7 3281extern_struct.field -->
0d888aac
CW
3282 @{ volatile struct s *t=&extern_struct; t->field @}
3283@end example
3284
c406afaf
NC
3285or
3286
3287@example
3288extern long long extern_ll;
3289extern_ll -->
3290 @{ volatile long long * local_ll=&extern_ll; *local_ll @}
3291@end example
3292
2fa9fc65 3293A third method of dealing with this difficulty is to abandon
c0065db7 3294'auto-import' for the offending symbol and mark it with
11e7fd74 3295@code{__declspec(dllimport)}. However, in practice that
0d888aac 3296requires using compile-time #defines to indicate whether you are
c0065db7
RM
3297building a DLL, building client code that will link to the DLL, or
3298merely building/linking to a static library. In making the choice
3299between the various methods of resolving the 'direct address with
0d888aac
CW
3300constant offset' problem, you should consider typical real-world usage:
3301
3302Original:
3303@example
3304--foo.h
3305extern int arr[];
3306--foo.c
3307#include "foo.h"
3308void main(int argc, char **argv)@{
3309 printf("%d\n",arr[1]);
3310@}
3311@end example
3312
3313Solution 1:
3314@example
3315--foo.h
3316extern int arr[];
3317--foo.c
3318#include "foo.h"
3319void main(int argc, char **argv)@{
3320 /* This workaround is for win32 and cygwin; do not "optimize" */
3321 volatile int *parr = arr;
3322 printf("%d\n",parr[1]);
3323@}
3324@end example
3325
3326Solution 2:
3327@example
3328--foo.h
3329/* Note: auto-export is assumed (no __declspec(dllexport)) */
3330#if (defined(_WIN32) || defined(__CYGWIN__)) && \
3331 !(defined(FOO_BUILD_DLL) || defined(FOO_STATIC))
3332#define FOO_IMPORT __declspec(dllimport)
3333#else
3334#define FOO_IMPORT
3335#endif
3336extern FOO_IMPORT int arr[];
3337--foo.c
3338#include "foo.h"
3339void main(int argc, char **argv)@{
3340 printf("%d\n",arr[1]);
3341@}
3342@end example
3343
c0065db7 3344A fourth way to avoid this problem is to re-code your
0d888aac
CW
3345library to use a functional interface rather than a data interface
3346for the offending variables (e.g. set_foo() and get_foo() accessor
3347functions).
b044cda1
CW
3348
3349@kindex --disable-auto-import
3350@item --disable-auto-import
c0065db7 3351Do not attempt to do sophisticated linking of @code{_symbol} to
b044cda1 3352@code{__imp__symbol} for DATA imports from DLLs.
bb10df36 3353[This option is specific to the i386 PE targeted port of the linker]
b044cda1 3354
2fa9fc65
NC
3355@kindex --enable-runtime-pseudo-reloc
3356@item --enable-runtime-pseudo-reloc
3357If your code contains expressions described in --enable-auto-import section,
3358that is, DATA imports from DLL with non-zero offset, this switch will create
3359a vector of 'runtime pseudo relocations' which can be used by runtime
c0065db7 3360environment to adjust references to such data in your client code.
bb10df36 3361[This option is specific to the i386 PE targeted port of the linker]
2fa9fc65
NC
3362
3363@kindex --disable-runtime-pseudo-reloc
3364@item --disable-runtime-pseudo-reloc
317ff008 3365Do not create pseudo relocations for non-zero offset DATA imports from DLLs.
bb10df36 3366[This option is specific to the i386 PE targeted port of the linker]
2fa9fc65 3367
b044cda1
CW
3368@kindex --enable-extra-pe-debug
3369@item --enable-extra-pe-debug
3370Show additional debug info related to auto-import symbol thunking.
bb10df36 3371[This option is specific to the i386 PE targeted port of the linker]
b044cda1 3372
252b5132
RH
3373@kindex --section-alignment
3374@item --section-alignment
3375Sets the section alignment. Sections in memory will always begin at
3376addresses which are a multiple of this number. Defaults to 0x1000.
bb10df36 3377[This option is specific to the i386 PE targeted port of the linker]
252b5132
RH
3378
3379@cindex stack size
3380@kindex --stack
3381@item --stack @var{reserve}
3382@itemx --stack @var{reserve},@var{commit}
a00b50c5 3383Specify the number of bytes of memory to reserve (and optionally commit)
fe6d7d6a 3384to be used as stack for this program. The default is 2MB reserved, 4K
252b5132 3385committed.
bb10df36 3386[This option is specific to the i386 PE targeted port of the linker]
252b5132
RH
3387
3388@kindex --subsystem
3389@item --subsystem @var{which}
3390@itemx --subsystem @var{which}:@var{major}
3391@itemx --subsystem @var{which}:@var{major}.@var{minor}
3392Specifies the subsystem under which your program will execute. The
3393legal values for @var{which} are @code{native}, @code{windows},
33f362e1
NC
3394@code{console}, @code{posix}, and @code{xbox}. You may optionally set
3395the subsystem version also. Numeric values are also accepted for
3396@var{which}.
bb10df36 3397[This option is specific to the i386 PE targeted port of the linker]
252b5132 3398
2f563b51
DK
3399The following options set flags in the @code{DllCharacteristics} field
3400of the PE file header:
3401[These options are specific to PE targeted ports of the linker]
3402
2d5c3743
NC
3403@kindex --high-entropy-va
3404@item --high-entropy-va
514b4e19 3405@itemx --disable-high-entropy-va
2d5c3743 3406Image is compatible with 64-bit address space layout randomization
514b4e19
JD
3407(ASLR). This option is enabled by default for 64-bit PE images.
3408
dc9bd8c9
HD
3409This option also implies @option{--dynamicbase} and
3410@option{--enable-reloc-section}.
2d5c3743 3411
2f563b51
DK
3412@kindex --dynamicbase
3413@item --dynamicbase
514b4e19 3414@itemx --disable-dynamicbase
2f563b51
DK
3415The image base address may be relocated using address space layout
3416randomization (ASLR). This feature was introduced with MS Windows
514b4e19
JD
3417Vista for i386 PE targets. This option is enabled by default but
3418can be disabled via the @option{--disable-dynamicbase} option.
dc9bd8c9 3419This option also implies @option{--enable-reloc-section}.
2f563b51
DK
3420
3421@kindex --forceinteg
3422@item --forceinteg
514b4e19
JD
3423@itemx --disable-forceinteg
3424Code integrity checks are enforced. This option is disabled by
3425default.
2f563b51
DK
3426
3427@kindex --nxcompat
3428@item --nxcompat
514b4e19 3429@item --disable-nxcompat
2f563b51 3430The image is compatible with the Data Execution Prevention.
514b4e19
JD
3431This feature was introduced with MS Windows XP SP2 for i386 PE
3432targets. The option is enabled by default.
2f563b51
DK
3433
3434@kindex --no-isolation
3435@item --no-isolation
514b4e19 3436@itemx --disable-no-isolation
2f563b51 3437Although the image understands isolation, do not isolate the image.
514b4e19 3438This option is disabled by default.
2f563b51
DK
3439
3440@kindex --no-seh
3441@item --no-seh
514b4e19 3442@itemx --disable-no-seh
2f563b51 3443The image does not use SEH. No SE handler may be called from
514b4e19 3444this image. This option is disabled by default.
2f563b51
DK
3445
3446@kindex --no-bind
3447@item --no-bind
514b4e19
JD
3448@itemx --disable-no-bind
3449Do not bind this image. This option is disabled by default.
2f563b51
DK
3450
3451@kindex --wdmdriver
3452@item --wdmdriver
514b4e19
JD
3453@itemx --disable-wdmdriver
3454The driver uses the MS Windows Driver Model. This option is disabled
3455by default.
9d5777a3 3456
2f563b51
DK
3457@kindex --tsaware
3458@item --tsaware
514b4e19
JD
3459@itemx --disable-tsaware
3460The image is Terminal Server aware. This option is disabled by
3461default.
2f563b51 3462
0cb112f7
CF
3463@kindex --insert-timestamp
3464@item --insert-timestamp
eeb14e5a
LZ
3465@itemx --no-insert-timestamp
3466Insert a real timestamp into the image. This is the default behaviour
3467as it matches legacy code and it means that the image will work with
3468other, proprietary tools. The problem with this default is that it
56e6cf80 3469will result in slightly different images being produced each time the
eeb14e5a
LZ
3470same sources are linked. The option @option{--no-insert-timestamp}
3471can be used to insert a zero value for the timestamp, this ensuring
56e6cf80 3472that binaries produced from identical sources will compare
eeb14e5a 3473identically.
dc9bd8c9
HD
3474
3475@kindex --enable-reloc-section
3476@item --enable-reloc-section
514b4e19 3477@itemx --disable-reloc-section
dc9bd8c9
HD
3478Create the base relocation table, which is necessary if the image
3479is loaded at a different image base than specified in the PE header.
514b4e19 3480This option is enabled by default.
252b5132
RH
3481@end table
3482
0285c67d
NC
3483@c man end
3484
ac145307
BS
3485@ifset C6X
3486@subsection Options specific to C6X uClinux targets
3487
3488@c man begin OPTIONS
3489
3490The C6X uClinux target uses a binary format called DSBT to support shared
3491libraries. Each shared library in the system needs to have a unique index;
3492all executables use an index of 0.
3493
3494@table @gcctabopt
3495
3496@kindex --dsbt-size
3497@item --dsbt-size @var{size}
56e6cf80 3498This option sets the number of entries in the DSBT of the current executable
ac145307
BS
3499or shared library to @var{size}. The default is to create a table with 64
3500entries.
3501
3502@kindex --dsbt-index
3503@item --dsbt-index @var{index}
3504This option sets the DSBT index of the current executable or shared library
3505to @var{index}. The default is 0, which is appropriate for generating
3506executables. If a shared library is generated with a DSBT index of 0, the
3507@code{R_C6000_DSBT_INDEX} relocs are copied into the output file.
3508
fbd9ad90
PB
3509@kindex --no-merge-exidx-entries
3510The @samp{--no-merge-exidx-entries} switch disables the merging of adjacent
3511exidx entries in frame unwind info.
3512
ac145307
BS
3513@end table
3514
3515@c man end
3516@end ifset
3517
b8891f8d
AJ
3518@ifset CSKY
3519@subsection Options specific to C-SKY targets
3520
3521@c man begin OPTIONS
3522
3523@table @gcctabopt
3524
3525@kindex --branch-stub on C-SKY
3526@item --branch-stub
3527This option enables linker branch relaxation by inserting branch stub
3528sections when needed to extend the range of branches. This option is
3529usually not required since C-SKY supports branch and call instructions that
3530can access the full memory range and branch relaxation is normally handled by
3531the compiler or assembler.
3532
3533@kindex --stub-group-size on C-SKY
3534@item --stub-group-size=@var{N}
3535This option allows finer control of linker branch stub creation.
3536It sets the maximum size of a group of input sections that can
3537be handled by one stub section. A negative value of @var{N} locates
3538stub sections after their branches, while a positive value allows stub
3539sections to appear either before or after the branches. Values of
3540@samp{1} or @samp{-1} indicate that the
3541linker should choose suitable defaults.
3542
3543@end table
3544
3545@c man end
3546@end ifset
3547
93fd0973
SC
3548@ifset M68HC11
3549@subsection Options specific to Motorola 68HC11 and 68HC12 targets
3550
3551@c man begin OPTIONS
3552
3553The 68HC11 and 68HC12 linkers support specific options to control the
3554memory bank switching mapping and trampoline code generation.
3555
3556@table @gcctabopt
3557
3558@kindex --no-trampoline
3559@item --no-trampoline
3560This option disables the generation of trampoline. By default a trampoline
3561is generated for each far function which is called using a @code{jsr}
3562instruction (this happens when a pointer to a far function is taken).
3563
3564@kindex --bank-window
3565@item --bank-window @var{name}
3566This option indicates to the linker the name of the memory region in
3567the @samp{MEMORY} specification that describes the memory bank window.
3568The definition of such region is then used by the linker to compute
3569paging and addresses within the memory window.
3570
3571@end table
3572
3573@c man end
3574@end ifset
3575
7fb9f789
NC
3576@ifset M68K
3577@subsection Options specific to Motorola 68K target
3578
3579@c man begin OPTIONS
3580
3581The following options are supported to control handling of GOT generation
3582when linking for 68K targets.
3583
3584@table @gcctabopt
3585
3586@kindex --got
3587@item --got=@var{type}
3588This option tells the linker which GOT generation scheme to use.
3589@var{type} should be one of @samp{single}, @samp{negative},
3590@samp{multigot} or @samp{target}. For more information refer to the
3591Info entry for @file{ld}.
3592
3593@end table
3594
3595@c man end
3596@end ifset
3597
833794fc
MR
3598@ifset MIPS
3599@subsection Options specific to MIPS targets
3600
3601@c man begin OPTIONS
3602
3603The following options are supported to control microMIPS instruction
8b10b0b3
MR
3604generation and branch relocation checks for ISA mode transitions when
3605linking for MIPS targets.
833794fc
MR
3606
3607@table @gcctabopt
3608
3609@kindex --insn32
3610@item --insn32
3611@kindex --no-insn32
3612@itemx --no-insn32
3613These options control the choice of microMIPS instructions used in code
3614generated by the linker, such as that in the PLT or lazy binding stubs,
3615or in relaxation. If @samp{--insn32} is used, then the linker only uses
361632-bit instruction encodings. By default or if @samp{--no-insn32} is
3617used, all instruction encodings are used, including 16-bit ones where
3618possible.
3619
8b10b0b3
MR
3620@kindex --ignore-branch-isa
3621@item --ignore-branch-isa
3622@kindex --no-ignore-branch-isa
3623@itemx --no-ignore-branch-isa
3624These options control branch relocation checks for invalid ISA mode
3625transitions. If @samp{--ignore-branch-isa} is used, then the linker
3626accepts any branch relocations and any ISA mode transition required
3627is lost in relocation calculation, except for some cases of @code{BAL}
3628instructions which meet relaxation conditions and are converted to
3629equivalent @code{JALX} instructions as the associated relocation is
3630calculated. By default or if @samp{--no-ignore-branch-isa} is used
3631a check is made causing the loss of an ISA mode transition to produce
3632an error.
3633
3734320d
MF
3634@kindex --compact-branches
3635@item --compact-branches
3636@kindex --no-compact-branches
fa1477dc 3637@itemx --no-compact-branches
3734320d
MF
3638These options control the generation of compact instructions by the linker
3639in the PLT entries for MIPS R6.
3640
833794fc
MR
3641@end table
3642
3643@c man end
3644@end ifset
3645
fa1477dc
SC
3646
3647@ifset PDP11
3648@subsection Options specific to PDP11 targets
3649
3650@c man begin OPTIONS
3651
3652For the pdp11-aout target, three variants of the output format can be
3653produced as selected by the following options. The default variant
3654for pdp11-aout is the @samp{--omagic} option, whereas for other
3655targets @samp{--nmagic} is the default. The @samp{--imagic} option is
3656defined only for the pdp11-aout target, while the others are described
3657here as they apply to the pdp11-aout target.
3658
3659@table @gcctabopt
3660
3661@kindex -N
3662@item -N
3663@kindex --omagic
3664@itemx --omagic
3665
3666Mark the output as @code{OMAGIC} (0407) in the @file{a.out} header to
3667indicate that the text segment is not to be write-protected and
3668shared. Since the text and data sections are both readable and
3669writable, the data section is allocated immediately contiguous after
3670the text segment. This is the oldest format for PDP11 executable
3671programs and is the default for @command{ld} on PDP11 Unix systems
3672from the beginning through 2.11BSD.
3673
3674@kindex -n
3675@item -n
3676@kindex --nmagic
3677@itemx --nmagic
3678
3679Mark the output as @code{NMAGIC} (0410) in the @file{a.out} header to
3680indicate that when the output file is executed, the text portion will
3681be read-only and shareable among all processes executing the same
3682file. This involves moving the data areas up to the first possible 8K
3683byte page boundary following the end of the text. This option creates
3684a @emph{pure executable} format.
3685
3686@kindex -z
3687@item -z
3688@kindex --imagic
3689@itemx --imagic
3690
3691Mark the output as @code{IMAGIC} (0411) in the @file{a.out} header to
3692indicate that when the output file is executed, the program text and
3693data areas will be loaded into separate address spaces using the split
3694instruction and data space feature of the memory management unit in
3695larger models of the PDP11. This doubles the address space available
3696to the program. The text segment is again pure, write-protected, and
3697shareable. The only difference in the output format between this
3698option and the others, besides the magic number, is that both the text
3699and data sections start at location 0. The @samp{-z} option selected
3700this format in 2.11BSD. This option creates a @emph{separate
3701executable} format.
3702
3703@kindex --no-omagic
3704@item --no-omagic
3705
3706Equivalent to @samp{--nmagic} for pdp11-aout.
3707
3708@end table
3709
3710@c man end
3711@end ifset
3712
252b5132
RH
3713@ifset UsesEnvVars
3714@node Environment
3715@section Environment Variables
3716
0285c67d
NC
3717@c man begin ENVIRONMENT
3718
560e09e9 3719You can change the behaviour of @command{ld} with the environment variables
36f63dca
NC
3720@ifclear SingleFormat
3721@code{GNUTARGET},
3722@end ifclear
3723@code{LDEMULATION} and @code{COLLECT_NO_DEMANGLE}.
252b5132 3724
36f63dca 3725@ifclear SingleFormat
252b5132
RH
3726@kindex GNUTARGET
3727@cindex default input format
3728@code{GNUTARGET} determines the input-file object format if you don't
3729use @samp{-b} (or its synonym @samp{--format}). Its value should be one
3730of the BFD names for an input format (@pxref{BFD}). If there is no
ff5dcc92 3731@code{GNUTARGET} in the environment, @command{ld} uses the natural format
252b5132
RH
3732of the target. If @code{GNUTARGET} is set to @code{default} then BFD
3733attempts to discover the input format by examining binary input files;
3734this method often succeeds, but there are potential ambiguities, since
3735there is no method of ensuring that the magic number used to specify
3736object-file formats is unique. However, the configuration procedure for
3737BFD on each system places the conventional format for that system first
3738in the search-list, so ambiguities are resolved in favor of convention.
36f63dca 3739@end ifclear
252b5132
RH
3740
3741@kindex LDEMULATION
3742@cindex default emulation
3743@cindex emulation, default
3744@code{LDEMULATION} determines the default emulation if you don't use the
3745@samp{-m} option. The emulation can affect various aspects of linker
3746behaviour, particularly the default linker script. You can list the
3747available emulations with the @samp{--verbose} or @samp{-V} options. If
3748the @samp{-m} option is not used, and the @code{LDEMULATION} environment
3749variable is not defined, the default emulation depends upon how the
3750linker was configured.
252b5132
RH
3751
3752@kindex COLLECT_NO_DEMANGLE
3753@cindex demangling, default
3754Normally, the linker will default to demangling symbols. However, if
3755@code{COLLECT_NO_DEMANGLE} is set in the environment, then it will
3756default to not demangling symbols. This environment variable is used in
3757a similar fashion by the @code{gcc} linker wrapper program. The default
3758may be overridden by the @samp{--demangle} and @samp{--no-demangle}
3759options.
3760
0285c67d
NC
3761@c man end
3762@end ifset
3763
252b5132
RH
3764@node Scripts
3765@chapter Linker Scripts
3766
3767@cindex scripts
3768@cindex linker scripts
3769@cindex command files
3770Every link is controlled by a @dfn{linker script}. This script is
3771written in the linker command language.
3772
3773The main purpose of the linker script is to describe how the sections in
3774the input files should be mapped into the output file, and to control
3775the memory layout of the output file. Most linker scripts do nothing
3776more than this. However, when necessary, the linker script can also
3777direct the linker to perform many other operations, using the commands
3778described below.
3779
3780The linker always uses a linker script. If you do not supply one
3781yourself, the linker will use a default script that is compiled into the
a05a5b64
TP
3782linker executable. You can use the @samp{--verbose} command-line option
3783to display the default linker script. Certain command-line options,
252b5132
RH
3784such as @samp{-r} or @samp{-N}, will affect the default linker script.
3785
3786You may supply your own linker script by using the @samp{-T} command
3787line option. When you do this, your linker script will replace the
3788default linker script.
3789
3790You may also use linker scripts implicitly by naming them as input files
3791to the linker, as though they were files to be linked. @xref{Implicit
3792Linker Scripts}.
3793
3794@menu
3795* Basic Script Concepts:: Basic Linker Script Concepts
3796* Script Format:: Linker Script Format
3797* Simple Example:: Simple Linker Script Example
3798* Simple Commands:: Simple Linker Script Commands
3799* Assignments:: Assigning Values to Symbols
3800* SECTIONS:: SECTIONS Command
3801* MEMORY:: MEMORY Command
3802* PHDRS:: PHDRS Command
3803* VERSION:: VERSION Command
3804* Expressions:: Expressions in Linker Scripts
3805* Implicit Linker Scripts:: Implicit Linker Scripts
3806@end menu
3807
3808@node Basic Script Concepts
3809@section Basic Linker Script Concepts
3810@cindex linker script concepts
3811We need to define some basic concepts and vocabulary in order to
3812describe the linker script language.
3813
3814The linker combines input files into a single output file. The output
3815file and each input file are in a special data format known as an
3816@dfn{object file format}. Each file is called an @dfn{object file}.
3817The output file is often called an @dfn{executable}, but for our
3818purposes we will also call it an object file. Each object file has,
3819among other things, a list of @dfn{sections}. We sometimes refer to a
3820section in an input file as an @dfn{input section}; similarly, a section
3821in the output file is an @dfn{output section}.
3822
3823Each section in an object file has a name and a size. Most sections
3824also have an associated block of data, known as the @dfn{section
56dd11f0 3825contents}. A section may be marked as @dfn{loadable}, which means that
252b5132
RH
3826the contents should be loaded into memory when the output file is run.
3827A section with no contents may be @dfn{allocatable}, which means that an
3828area in memory should be set aside, but nothing in particular should be
3829loaded there (in some cases this memory must be zeroed out). A section
3830which is neither loadable nor allocatable typically contains some sort
3831of debugging information.
3832
3833Every loadable or allocatable output section has two addresses. The
3834first is the @dfn{VMA}, or virtual memory address. This is the address
3835the section will have when the output file is run. The second is the
3836@dfn{LMA}, or load memory address. This is the address at which the
3837section will be loaded. In most cases the two addresses will be the
3838same. An example of when they might be different is when a data section
3839is loaded into ROM, and then copied into RAM when the program starts up
3840(this technique is often used to initialize global variables in a ROM
3841based system). In this case the ROM address would be the LMA, and the
3842RAM address would be the VMA.
3843
3844You can see the sections in an object file by using the @code{objdump}
3845program with the @samp{-h} option.
3846
3847Every object file also has a list of @dfn{symbols}, known as the
3848@dfn{symbol table}. A symbol may be defined or undefined. Each symbol
3849has a name, and each defined symbol has an address, among other
3850information. If you compile a C or C++ program into an object file, you
3851will get a defined symbol for every defined function and global or
3852static variable. Every undefined function or global variable which is
3853referenced in the input file will become an undefined symbol.
3854
3855You can see the symbols in an object file by using the @code{nm}
3856program, or by using the @code{objdump} program with the @samp{-t}
3857option.
3858
3859@node Script Format
3860@section Linker Script Format
3861@cindex linker script format
3862Linker scripts are text files.
3863
3864You write a linker script as a series of commands. Each command is
3865either a keyword, possibly followed by arguments, or an assignment to a
3866symbol. You may separate commands using semicolons. Whitespace is
3867generally ignored.
3868
3869Strings such as file or format names can normally be entered directly.
3870If the file name contains a character such as a comma which would
3871otherwise serve to separate file names, you may put the file name in
3872double quotes. There is no way to use a double quote character in a
3873file name.
3874
3875You may include comments in linker scripts just as in C, delimited by
3876@samp{/*} and @samp{*/}. As in C, comments are syntactically equivalent
3877to whitespace.
3878
3879@node Simple Example
3880@section Simple Linker Script Example
3881@cindex linker script example
3882@cindex example of linker script
3883Many linker scripts are fairly simple.
3884
3885The simplest possible linker script has just one command:
3886@samp{SECTIONS}. You use the @samp{SECTIONS} command to describe the
3887memory layout of the output file.
3888
3889The @samp{SECTIONS} command is a powerful command. Here we will
3890describe a simple use of it. Let's assume your program consists only of
3891code, initialized data, and uninitialized data. These will be in the
3892@samp{.text}, @samp{.data}, and @samp{.bss} sections, respectively.
3893Let's assume further that these are the only sections which appear in
3894your input files.
3895
3896For this example, let's say that the code should be loaded at address
38970x10000, and that the data should start at address 0x8000000. Here is a
3898linker script which will do that:
3899@smallexample
3900SECTIONS
3901@{
3902 . = 0x10000;
3903 .text : @{ *(.text) @}
3904 . = 0x8000000;
3905 .data : @{ *(.data) @}
3906 .bss : @{ *(.bss) @}
3907@}
3908@end smallexample
3909
3910You write the @samp{SECTIONS} command as the keyword @samp{SECTIONS},
3911followed by a series of symbol assignments and output section
3912descriptions enclosed in curly braces.
3913
252b5132
RH
3914The first line inside the @samp{SECTIONS} command of the above example
3915sets the value of the special symbol @samp{.}, which is the location
3916counter. If you do not specify the address of an output section in some
3917other way (other ways are described later), the address is set from the
3918current value of the location counter. The location counter is then
3919incremented by the size of the output section. At the start of the
3920@samp{SECTIONS} command, the location counter has the value @samp{0}.
3921
3922The second line defines an output section, @samp{.text}. The colon is
3923required syntax which may be ignored for now. Within the curly braces
3924after the output section name, you list the names of the input sections
3925which should be placed into this output section. The @samp{*} is a
3926wildcard which matches any file name. The expression @samp{*(.text)}
3927means all @samp{.text} input sections in all input files.
3928
3929Since the location counter is @samp{0x10000} when the output section
3930@samp{.text} is defined, the linker will set the address of the
3931@samp{.text} section in the output file to be @samp{0x10000}.
3932
3933The remaining lines define the @samp{.data} and @samp{.bss} sections in
3934the output file. The linker will place the @samp{.data} output section
3935at address @samp{0x8000000}. After the linker places the @samp{.data}
3936output section, the value of the location counter will be
3937@samp{0x8000000} plus the size of the @samp{.data} output section. The
3938effect is that the linker will place the @samp{.bss} output section
58434bc1 3939immediately after the @samp{.data} output section in memory.
252b5132
RH
3940
3941The linker will ensure that each output section has the required
3942alignment, by increasing the location counter if necessary. In this
3943example, the specified addresses for the @samp{.text} and @samp{.data}
3944sections will probably satisfy any alignment constraints, but the linker
3945may have to create a small gap between the @samp{.data} and @samp{.bss}
3946sections.
3947
3948That's it! That's a simple and complete linker script.
3949
3950@node Simple Commands
3951@section Simple Linker Script Commands
3952@cindex linker script simple commands
3953In this section we describe the simple linker script commands.
3954
3955@menu
3956* Entry Point:: Setting the entry point
3957* File Commands:: Commands dealing with files
3958@ifclear SingleFormat
3959* Format Commands:: Commands dealing with object file formats
3960@end ifclear
3961
4a93e180 3962* REGION_ALIAS:: Assign alias names to memory regions
252b5132
RH
3963* Miscellaneous Commands:: Other linker script commands
3964@end menu
3965
3966@node Entry Point
36f63dca 3967@subsection Setting the Entry Point
252b5132
RH
3968@kindex ENTRY(@var{symbol})
3969@cindex start of execution
3970@cindex first instruction
3971@cindex entry point
3972The first instruction to execute in a program is called the @dfn{entry
3973point}. You can use the @code{ENTRY} linker script command to set the
3974entry point. The argument is a symbol name:
3975@smallexample
3976ENTRY(@var{symbol})
3977@end smallexample
3978
3979There are several ways to set the entry point. The linker will set the
3980entry point by trying each of the following methods in order, and
3981stopping when one of them succeeds:
3982@itemize @bullet
a1ab1d2a 3983@item
252b5132 3984the @samp{-e} @var{entry} command-line option;
a1ab1d2a 3985@item
252b5132 3986the @code{ENTRY(@var{symbol})} command in a linker script;
a1ab1d2a 3987@item
a094d01f 3988the value of a target-specific symbol, if it is defined; For many
8a758655 3989targets this is @code{start}, but PE- and BeOS-based systems for example
3ab904c4 3990check a list of possible entry symbols, matching the first one found.
a1ab1d2a 3991@item
5226a6a8
NC
3992the address of the first byte of the code section, if present and an
3993executable is being created - the code section is usually
5c14cc55 3994@samp{.text}, but can be something else;
a1ab1d2a 3995@item
252b5132
RH
3996The address @code{0}.
3997@end itemize
3998
3999@node File Commands
36f63dca 4000@subsection Commands Dealing with Files
252b5132
RH
4001@cindex linker script file commands
4002Several linker script commands deal with files.
4003
4004@table @code
4005@item INCLUDE @var{filename}
4006@kindex INCLUDE @var{filename}
4007@cindex including a linker script
4008Include the linker script @var{filename} at this point. The file will
4009be searched for in the current directory, and in any directory specified
ff5dcc92 4010with the @option{-L} option. You can nest calls to @code{INCLUDE} up to
252b5132
RH
401110 levels deep.
4012
4006703d
NS
4013You can place @code{INCLUDE} directives at the top level, in @code{MEMORY} or
4014@code{SECTIONS} commands, or in output section descriptions.
4015
252b5132
RH
4016@item INPUT(@var{file}, @var{file}, @dots{})
4017@itemx INPUT(@var{file} @var{file} @dots{})
4018@kindex INPUT(@var{files})
4019@cindex input files in linker scripts
4020@cindex input object files in linker scripts
4021@cindex linker script input object files
4022The @code{INPUT} command directs the linker to include the named files
4023in the link, as though they were named on the command line.
4024
4025For example, if you always want to include @file{subr.o} any time you do
4026a link, but you can't be bothered to put it on every link command line,
4027then you can put @samp{INPUT (subr.o)} in your linker script.
4028
4029In fact, if you like, you can list all of your input files in the linker
4030script, and then invoke the linker with nothing but a @samp{-T} option.
4031
e3f2db7f
AO
4032In case a @dfn{sysroot prefix} is configured, and the filename starts
4033with the @samp{/} character, and the script being processed was
4034located inside the @dfn{sysroot prefix}, the filename will be looked
16171946
FS
4035for in the @dfn{sysroot prefix}. The @dfn{sysroot prefix} can also be forced by specifying
4036@code{=} as the first character in the filename path, or prefixing the
4037filename path with @code{$SYSROOT}. See also the description of
4038@samp{-L} in @ref{Options,,Command-line Options}.
4039
4040If a @dfn{sysroot prefix} is not used then the linker will try to open
4041the file in the directory containing the linker script. If it is not
4042found the linker will then search the current directory. If it is still
4043not found the linker will search through the archive library search
4044path.
252b5132 4045
ff5dcc92 4046If you use @samp{INPUT (-l@var{file})}, @command{ld} will transform the
a05a5b64 4047name to @code{lib@var{file}.a}, as with the command-line argument
252b5132
RH
4048@samp{-l}.
4049
4050When you use the @code{INPUT} command in an implicit linker script, the
4051files will be included in the link at the point at which the linker
4052script file is included. This can affect archive searching.
4053
4054@item GROUP(@var{file}, @var{file}, @dots{})
4055@itemx GROUP(@var{file} @var{file} @dots{})
4056@kindex GROUP(@var{files})
4057@cindex grouping input files
4058The @code{GROUP} command is like @code{INPUT}, except that the named
4059files should all be archives, and they are searched repeatedly until no
4060new undefined references are created. See the description of @samp{-(}
a05a5b64 4061in @ref{Options,,Command-line Options}.
252b5132 4062
b717d30e
JJ
4063@item AS_NEEDED(@var{file}, @var{file}, @dots{})
4064@itemx AS_NEEDED(@var{file} @var{file} @dots{})
4065@kindex AS_NEEDED(@var{files})
4066This construct can appear only inside of the @code{INPUT} or @code{GROUP}
4067commands, among other filenames. The files listed will be handled
4068as if they appear directly in the @code{INPUT} or @code{GROUP} commands,
4069with the exception of ELF shared libraries, that will be added only
4070when they are actually needed. This construct essentially enables
4071@option{--as-needed} option for all the files listed inside of it
4072and restores previous @option{--as-needed} resp. @option{--no-as-needed}
4073setting afterwards.
4074
252b5132
RH
4075@item OUTPUT(@var{filename})
4076@kindex OUTPUT(@var{filename})
b45619c0 4077@cindex output file name in linker script
252b5132
RH
4078The @code{OUTPUT} command names the output file. Using
4079@code{OUTPUT(@var{filename})} in the linker script is exactly like using
4080@samp{-o @var{filename}} on the command line (@pxref{Options,,Command
a05a5b64 4081Line Options}). If both are used, the command-line option takes
252b5132
RH
4082precedence.
4083
4084You can use the @code{OUTPUT} command to define a default name for the
4085output file other than the usual default of @file{a.out}.
4086
4087@item SEARCH_DIR(@var{path})
4088@kindex SEARCH_DIR(@var{path})
4089@cindex library search path in linker script
4090@cindex archive search path in linker script
4091@cindex search path in linker script
4092The @code{SEARCH_DIR} command adds @var{path} to the list of paths where
ff5dcc92 4093@command{ld} looks for archive libraries. Using
252b5132 4094@code{SEARCH_DIR(@var{path})} is exactly like using @samp{-L @var{path}}
a05a5b64 4095on the command line (@pxref{Options,,Command-line Options}). If both
252b5132 4096are used, then the linker will search both paths. Paths specified using
a05a5b64 4097the command-line option are searched first.
252b5132
RH
4098
4099@item STARTUP(@var{filename})
4100@kindex STARTUP(@var{filename})
4101@cindex first input file
4102The @code{STARTUP} command is just like the @code{INPUT} command, except
4103that @var{filename} will become the first input file to be linked, as
4104though it were specified first on the command line. This may be useful
4105when using a system in which the entry point is always the start of the
4106first file.
4107@end table
4108
4109@ifclear SingleFormat
4110@node Format Commands
36f63dca 4111@subsection Commands Dealing with Object File Formats
252b5132
RH
4112A couple of linker script commands deal with object file formats.
4113
4114@table @code
4115@item OUTPUT_FORMAT(@var{bfdname})
4116@itemx OUTPUT_FORMAT(@var{default}, @var{big}, @var{little})
4117@kindex OUTPUT_FORMAT(@var{bfdname})
4118@cindex output file format in linker script
4119The @code{OUTPUT_FORMAT} command names the BFD format to use for the
4120output file (@pxref{BFD}). Using @code{OUTPUT_FORMAT(@var{bfdname})} is
024531e2 4121exactly like using @samp{--oformat @var{bfdname}} on the command line
a05a5b64 4122(@pxref{Options,,Command-line Options}). If both are used, the command
252b5132
RH
4123line option takes precedence.
4124
4125You can use @code{OUTPUT_FORMAT} with three arguments to use different
a05a5b64 4126formats based on the @samp{-EB} and @samp{-EL} command-line options.
252b5132
RH
4127This permits the linker script to set the output format based on the
4128desired endianness.
4129
4130If neither @samp{-EB} nor @samp{-EL} are used, then the output format
4131will be the first argument, @var{default}. If @samp{-EB} is used, the
4132output format will be the second argument, @var{big}. If @samp{-EL} is
4133used, the output format will be the third argument, @var{little}.
4134
4135For example, the default linker script for the MIPS ELF target uses this
4136command:
4137@smallexample
4138OUTPUT_FORMAT(elf32-bigmips, elf32-bigmips, elf32-littlemips)
4139@end smallexample
4140This says that the default format for the output file is
a05a5b64 4141@samp{elf32-bigmips}, but if the user uses the @samp{-EL} command-line
252b5132
RH
4142option, the output file will be created in the @samp{elf32-littlemips}
4143format.
4144
4145@item TARGET(@var{bfdname})
4146@kindex TARGET(@var{bfdname})
4147@cindex input file format in linker script
4148The @code{TARGET} command names the BFD format to use when reading input
4149files. It affects subsequent @code{INPUT} and @code{GROUP} commands.
4150This command is like using @samp{-b @var{bfdname}} on the command line
a05a5b64 4151(@pxref{Options,,Command-line Options}). If the @code{TARGET} command
252b5132
RH
4152is used but @code{OUTPUT_FORMAT} is not, then the last @code{TARGET}
4153command is also used to set the format for the output file. @xref{BFD}.
4154@end table
4155@end ifclear
4156
4a93e180
NC
4157@node REGION_ALIAS
4158@subsection Assign alias names to memory regions
4159@kindex REGION_ALIAS(@var{alias}, @var{region})
4160@cindex region alias
4161@cindex region names
4162
4163Alias names can be added to existing memory regions created with the
4164@ref{MEMORY} command. Each name corresponds to at most one memory region.
4165
4166@smallexample
4167REGION_ALIAS(@var{alias}, @var{region})
4168@end smallexample
4169
4170The @code{REGION_ALIAS} function creates an alias name @var{alias} for the
4171memory region @var{region}. This allows a flexible mapping of output sections
4172to memory regions. An example follows.
4173
4174Suppose we have an application for embedded systems which come with various
4175memory storage devices. All have a general purpose, volatile memory @code{RAM}
4176that allows code execution or data storage. Some may have a read-only,
4177non-volatile memory @code{ROM} that allows code execution and read-only data
4178access. The last variant is a read-only, non-volatile memory @code{ROM2} with
4179read-only data access and no code execution capability. We have four output
4180sections:
4181
4182@itemize @bullet
4183@item
4184@code{.text} program code;
4185@item
4186@code{.rodata} read-only data;
4187@item
4188@code{.data} read-write initialized data;
4189@item
4190@code{.bss} read-write zero initialized data.
4191@end itemize
4192
4193The goal is to provide a linker command file that contains a system independent
4194part defining the output sections and a system dependent part mapping the
4195output sections to the memory regions available on the system. Our embedded
4196systems come with three different memory setups @code{A}, @code{B} and
4197@code{C}:
4198@multitable @columnfractions .25 .25 .25 .25
4199@item Section @tab Variant A @tab Variant B @tab Variant C
9d5777a3 4200@item .text @tab RAM @tab ROM @tab ROM
4a93e180
NC
4201@item .rodata @tab RAM @tab ROM @tab ROM2
4202@item .data @tab RAM @tab RAM/ROM @tab RAM/ROM2
4203@item .bss @tab RAM @tab RAM @tab RAM
4204@end multitable
4205The notation @code{RAM/ROM} or @code{RAM/ROM2} means that this section is
4206loaded into region @code{ROM} or @code{ROM2} respectively. Please note that
4207the load address of the @code{.data} section starts in all three variants at
4208the end of the @code{.rodata} section.
4209
4210The base linker script that deals with the output sections follows. It
4211includes the system dependent @code{linkcmds.memory} file that describes the
4212memory layout:
4213@smallexample
4214INCLUDE linkcmds.memory
4215
4216SECTIONS
4217 @{
4218 .text :
4219 @{
4220 *(.text)
4221 @} > REGION_TEXT
4222 .rodata :
4223 @{
4224 *(.rodata)
4225 rodata_end = .;
4226 @} > REGION_RODATA
4227 .data : AT (rodata_end)
4228 @{
4229 data_start = .;
4230 *(.data)
4231 @} > REGION_DATA
4232 data_size = SIZEOF(.data);
4233 data_load_start = LOADADDR(.data);
4234 .bss :
4235 @{
4236 *(.bss)
4237 @} > REGION_BSS
4238 @}
4239@end smallexample
4240
4241Now we need three different @code{linkcmds.memory} files to define memory
4242regions and alias names. The content of @code{linkcmds.memory} for the three
4243variants @code{A}, @code{B} and @code{C}:
4244@table @code
4245@item A
4246Here everything goes into the @code{RAM}.
4247@smallexample
4248MEMORY
4249 @{
4250 RAM : ORIGIN = 0, LENGTH = 4M
4251 @}
4252
4253REGION_ALIAS("REGION_TEXT", RAM);
4254REGION_ALIAS("REGION_RODATA", RAM);
4255REGION_ALIAS("REGION_DATA", RAM);
4256REGION_ALIAS("REGION_BSS", RAM);
4257@end smallexample
4258@item B
4259Program code and read-only data go into the @code{ROM}. Read-write data goes
4260into the @code{RAM}. An image of the initialized data is loaded into the
4261@code{ROM} and will be copied during system start into the @code{RAM}.
4262@smallexample
4263MEMORY
4264 @{
4265 ROM : ORIGIN = 0, LENGTH = 3M
4266 RAM : ORIGIN = 0x10000000, LENGTH = 1M
4267 @}
4268
4269REGION_ALIAS("REGION_TEXT", ROM);
4270REGION_ALIAS("REGION_RODATA", ROM);
4271REGION_ALIAS("REGION_DATA", RAM);
4272REGION_ALIAS("REGION_BSS", RAM);
4273@end smallexample
4274@item C
4275Program code goes into the @code{ROM}. Read-only data goes into the
4276@code{ROM2}. Read-write data goes into the @code{RAM}. An image of the
4277initialized data is loaded into the @code{ROM2} and will be copied during
4278system start into the @code{RAM}.
4279@smallexample
4280MEMORY
4281 @{
4282 ROM : ORIGIN = 0, LENGTH = 2M
4283 ROM2 : ORIGIN = 0x10000000, LENGTH = 1M
4284 RAM : ORIGIN = 0x20000000, LENGTH = 1M
4285 @}
4286
4287REGION_ALIAS("REGION_TEXT", ROM);
4288REGION_ALIAS("REGION_RODATA", ROM2);
4289REGION_ALIAS("REGION_DATA", RAM);
4290REGION_ALIAS("REGION_BSS", RAM);
4291@end smallexample
4292@end table
4293
4294It is possible to write a common system initialization routine to copy the
4295@code{.data} section from @code{ROM} or @code{ROM2} into the @code{RAM} if
4296necessary:
4297@smallexample
4298#include <string.h>
4299
4300extern char data_start [];
4301extern char data_size [];
4302extern char data_load_start [];
4303
4304void copy_data(void)
4305@{
4306 if (data_start != data_load_start)
4307 @{
4308 memcpy(data_start, data_load_start, (size_t) data_size);
4309 @}
4310@}
4311@end smallexample
4312
252b5132 4313@node Miscellaneous Commands
36f63dca 4314@subsection Other Linker Script Commands
252b5132
RH
4315There are a few other linker scripts commands.
4316
4317@table @code
4318@item ASSERT(@var{exp}, @var{message})
4319@kindex ASSERT
4320@cindex assertion in linker script
4321Ensure that @var{exp} is non-zero. If it is zero, then exit the linker
4322with an error code, and print @var{message}.
4323
fd1c4238
NC
4324Note that assertions are checked before the final stages of linking
4325take place. This means that expressions involving symbols PROVIDEd
4326inside section definitions will fail if the user has not set values
4327for those symbols. The only exception to this rule is PROVIDEd
4328symbols that just reference dot. Thus an assertion like this:
4329
4330@smallexample
4331 .stack :
4332 @{
4333 PROVIDE (__stack = .);
4334 PROVIDE (__stack_size = 0x100);
4335 ASSERT ((__stack > (_end + __stack_size)), "Error: No room left for the stack");
4336 @}
4337@end smallexample
4338
4339will fail if @code{__stack_size} is not defined elsewhere. Symbols
4340PROVIDEd outside of section definitions are evaluated earlier, so they
4341can be used inside ASSERTions. Thus:
4342
4343@smallexample
4344 PROVIDE (__stack_size = 0x100);
4345 .stack :
4346 @{
4347 PROVIDE (__stack = .);
4348 ASSERT ((__stack > (_end + __stack_size)), "Error: No room left for the stack");
4349 @}
4350@end smallexample
4351
4352will work.
4353
252b5132
RH
4354@item EXTERN(@var{symbol} @var{symbol} @dots{})
4355@kindex EXTERN
4356@cindex undefined symbol in linker script
4357Force @var{symbol} to be entered in the output file as an undefined
4358symbol. Doing this may, for example, trigger linking of additional
4359modules from standard libraries. You may list several @var{symbol}s for
4360each @code{EXTERN}, and you may use @code{EXTERN} multiple times. This
4361command has the same effect as the @samp{-u} command-line option.
4362
4363@item FORCE_COMMON_ALLOCATION
4364@kindex FORCE_COMMON_ALLOCATION
4365@cindex common allocation in linker script
4366This command has the same effect as the @samp{-d} command-line option:
ff5dcc92 4367to make @command{ld} assign space to common symbols even if a relocatable
252b5132
RH
4368output file is specified (@samp{-r}).
4369
4818e05f
AM
4370@item INHIBIT_COMMON_ALLOCATION
4371@kindex INHIBIT_COMMON_ALLOCATION
4372@cindex common allocation in linker script
4373This command has the same effect as the @samp{--no-define-common}
4374command-line option: to make @code{ld} omit the assignment of addresses
4375to common symbols even for a non-relocatable output file.
4376
7bdf4127
AB
4377@item FORCE_GROUP_ALLOCATION
4378@kindex FORCE_GROUP_ALLOCATION
4379@cindex group allocation in linker script
4380@cindex section groups
4381@cindex COMDAT
4382This command has the same effect as the
4383@samp{--force-group-allocation} command-line option: to make
4384@command{ld} place section group members like normal input sections,
4385and to delete the section groups even if a relocatable output file is
4386specified (@samp{-r}).
4387
53d25da6
AM
4388@item INSERT [ AFTER | BEFORE ] @var{output_section}
4389@kindex INSERT
4390@cindex insert user script into default script
4391This command is typically used in a script specified by @samp{-T} to
4392augment the default @code{SECTIONS} with, for example, overlays. It
4393inserts all prior linker script statements after (or before)
4394@var{output_section}, and also causes @samp{-T} to not override the
4395default linker script. The exact insertion point is as for orphan
4396sections. @xref{Location Counter}. The insertion happens after the
4397linker has mapped input sections to output sections. Prior to the
4398insertion, since @samp{-T} scripts are parsed before the default
4399linker script, statements in the @samp{-T} script occur before the
4400default linker script statements in the internal linker representation
4401of the script. In particular, input section assignments will be made
4402to @samp{-T} output sections before those in the default script. Here
4403is an example of how a @samp{-T} script using @code{INSERT} might look:
4404
4405@smallexample
4406SECTIONS
4407@{
4408 OVERLAY :
4409 @{
4410 .ov1 @{ ov1*(.text) @}
4411 .ov2 @{ ov2*(.text) @}
4412 @}
4413@}
4414INSERT AFTER .text;
4415@end smallexample
4416
252b5132
RH
4417@item NOCROSSREFS(@var{section} @var{section} @dots{})
4418@kindex NOCROSSREFS(@var{sections})
4419@cindex cross references
ff5dcc92 4420This command may be used to tell @command{ld} to issue an error about any
252b5132
RH
4421references among certain output sections.
4422
4423In certain types of programs, particularly on embedded systems when
4424using overlays, when one section is loaded into memory, another section
4425will not be. Any direct references between the two sections would be
4426errors. For example, it would be an error if code in one section called
4427a function defined in the other section.
4428
4429The @code{NOCROSSREFS} command takes a list of output section names. If
ff5dcc92 4430@command{ld} detects any cross references between the sections, it reports
252b5132
RH
4431an error and returns a non-zero exit status. Note that the
4432@code{NOCROSSREFS} command uses output section names, not input section
4433names.
4434
cdf96953
MF
4435@item NOCROSSREFS_TO(@var{tosection} @var{fromsection} @dots{})
4436@kindex NOCROSSREFS_TO(@var{tosection} @var{fromsections})
4437@cindex cross references
4438This command may be used to tell @command{ld} to issue an error about any
4439references to one section from a list of other sections.
4440
4441The @code{NOCROSSREFS} command is useful when ensuring that two or more
4442output sections are entirely independent but there are situations where
4443a one-way dependency is needed. For example, in a multi-core application
4444there may be shared code that can be called from each core but for safety
4445must never call back.
4446
4447The @code{NOCROSSREFS_TO} command takes a list of output section names.
4448The first section can not be referenced from any of the other sections.
4449If @command{ld} detects any references to the first section from any of
4450the other sections, it reports an error and returns a non-zero exit
4451status. Note that the @code{NOCROSSREFS_TO} command uses output section
4452names, not input section names.
4453
252b5132
RH
4454@ifclear SingleFormat
4455@item OUTPUT_ARCH(@var{bfdarch})
4456@kindex OUTPUT_ARCH(@var{bfdarch})
4457@cindex machine architecture
4458@cindex architecture
4459Specify a particular output machine architecture. The argument is one
4460of the names used by the BFD library (@pxref{BFD}). You can see the
4461architecture of an object file by using the @code{objdump} program with
4462the @samp{-f} option.
4463@end ifclear
01554a74
AM
4464
4465@item LD_FEATURE(@var{string})
4466@kindex LD_FEATURE(@var{string})
4467This command may be used to modify @command{ld} behavior. If
4468@var{string} is @code{"SANE_EXPR"} then absolute symbols and numbers
4469in a script are simply treated as numbers everywhere.
4470@xref{Expression Section}.
252b5132
RH
4471@end table
4472
4473@node Assignments
4474@section Assigning Values to Symbols
4475@cindex assignment in scripts
4476@cindex symbol definition, scripts
4477@cindex variables, defining
4478You may assign a value to a symbol in a linker script. This will define
73ae6183 4479the symbol and place it into the symbol table with a global scope.
252b5132
RH
4480
4481@menu
4482* Simple Assignments:: Simple Assignments
eb8476a6 4483* HIDDEN:: HIDDEN
252b5132 4484* PROVIDE:: PROVIDE
7af8e998 4485* PROVIDE_HIDDEN:: PROVIDE_HIDDEN
73ae6183 4486* Source Code Reference:: How to use a linker script defined symbol in source code
252b5132
RH
4487@end menu
4488
4489@node Simple Assignments
4490@subsection Simple Assignments
4491
4492You may assign to a symbol using any of the C assignment operators:
4493
4494@table @code
4495@item @var{symbol} = @var{expression} ;
4496@itemx @var{symbol} += @var{expression} ;
4497@itemx @var{symbol} -= @var{expression} ;
4498@itemx @var{symbol} *= @var{expression} ;
4499@itemx @var{symbol} /= @var{expression} ;
4500@itemx @var{symbol} <<= @var{expression} ;
4501@itemx @var{symbol} >>= @var{expression} ;
4502@itemx @var{symbol} &= @var{expression} ;
4503@itemx @var{symbol} |= @var{expression} ;
4504@end table
4505
4506The first case will define @var{symbol} to the value of
4507@var{expression}. In the other cases, @var{symbol} must already be
4508defined, and the value will be adjusted accordingly.
4509
4510The special symbol name @samp{.} indicates the location counter. You
b5666f2f 4511may only use this within a @code{SECTIONS} command. @xref{Location Counter}.
252b5132
RH
4512
4513The semicolon after @var{expression} is required.
4514
4515Expressions are defined below; see @ref{Expressions}.
4516
4517You may write symbol assignments as commands in their own right, or as
4518statements within a @code{SECTIONS} command, or as part of an output
4519section description in a @code{SECTIONS} command.
4520
4521The section of the symbol will be set from the section of the
4522expression; for more information, see @ref{Expression Section}.
4523
4524Here is an example showing the three different places that symbol
4525assignments may be used:
4526
4527@smallexample
4528floating_point = 0;
4529SECTIONS
4530@{
4531 .text :
4532 @{
4533 *(.text)
4534 _etext = .;
4535 @}
156e34dd 4536 _bdata = (. + 3) & ~ 3;
252b5132
RH
4537 .data : @{ *(.data) @}
4538@}
4539@end smallexample
4540@noindent
4541In this example, the symbol @samp{floating_point} will be defined as
4542zero. The symbol @samp{_etext} will be defined as the address following
4543the last @samp{.text} input section. The symbol @samp{_bdata} will be
4544defined as the address following the @samp{.text} output section aligned
4545upward to a 4 byte boundary.
4546
eb8476a6
MR
4547@node HIDDEN
4548@subsection HIDDEN
4549@cindex HIDDEN
4550For ELF targeted ports, define a symbol that will be hidden and won't be
4551exported. The syntax is @code{HIDDEN(@var{symbol} = @var{expression})}.
4552
4553Here is the example from @ref{Simple Assignments}, rewritten to use
4554@code{HIDDEN}:
4555
4556@smallexample
4557HIDDEN(floating_point = 0);
4558SECTIONS
4559@{
4560 .text :
4561 @{
4562 *(.text)
4563 HIDDEN(_etext = .);
4564 @}
4565 HIDDEN(_bdata = (. + 3) & ~ 3);
4566 .data : @{ *(.data) @}
4567@}
4568@end smallexample
4569@noindent
4570In this case none of the three symbols will be visible outside this module.
4571
252b5132
RH
4572@node PROVIDE
4573@subsection PROVIDE
4574@cindex PROVIDE
4575In some cases, it is desirable for a linker script to define a symbol
4576only if it is referenced and is not defined by any object included in
4577the link. For example, traditional linkers defined the symbol
4578@samp{etext}. However, ANSI C requires that the user be able to use
4579@samp{etext} as a function name without encountering an error. The
4580@code{PROVIDE} keyword may be used to define a symbol, such as
4581@samp{etext}, only if it is referenced but not defined. The syntax is
4582@code{PROVIDE(@var{symbol} = @var{expression})}.
4583
4584Here is an example of using @code{PROVIDE} to define @samp{etext}:
4585@smallexample
4586SECTIONS
4587@{
4588 .text :
4589 @{
4590 *(.text)
4591 _etext = .;
4592 PROVIDE(etext = .);
4593 @}
4594@}
4595@end smallexample
4596
4597In this example, if the program defines @samp{_etext} (with a leading
3c27360b
JB
4598underscore), the linker will give a multiple definition diagnostic. If,
4599on the other hand, the program defines @samp{etext} (with no leading
252b5132
RH
4600underscore), the linker will silently use the definition in the program.
4601If the program references @samp{etext} but does not define it, the
4602linker will use the definition in the linker script.
4603
b0daac83
NC
4604Note - the @code{PROVIDE} directive considers a common symbol to be
4605defined, even though such a symbol could be combined with the symbol
4606that the @code{PROVIDE} would create. This is particularly important
4607when considering constructor and destructor list symbols such as
4608@samp{__CTOR_LIST__} as these are often defined as common symbols.
4609
7af8e998
L
4610@node PROVIDE_HIDDEN
4611@subsection PROVIDE_HIDDEN
4612@cindex PROVIDE_HIDDEN
4613Similar to @code{PROVIDE}. For ELF targeted ports, the symbol will be
4614hidden and won't be exported.
4615
73ae6183
NC
4616@node Source Code Reference
4617@subsection Source Code Reference
4618
4619Accessing a linker script defined variable from source code is not
4620intuitive. In particular a linker script symbol is not equivalent to
4621a variable declaration in a high level language, it is instead a
4622symbol that does not have a value.
4623
4624Before going further, it is important to note that compilers often
4625transform names in the source code into different names when they are
4626stored in the symbol table. For example, Fortran compilers commonly
4627prepend or append an underscore, and C++ performs extensive @samp{name
4628mangling}. Therefore there might be a discrepancy between the name
4629of a variable as it is used in source code and the name of the same
4630variable as it is defined in a linker script. For example in C a
4631linker script variable might be referred to as:
4632
4633@smallexample
4634 extern int foo;
4635@end smallexample
4636
4637But in the linker script it might be defined as:
4638
4639@smallexample
4640 _foo = 1000;
4641@end smallexample
4642
4643In the remaining examples however it is assumed that no name
4644transformation has taken place.
4645
4646When a symbol is declared in a high level language such as C, two
4647things happen. The first is that the compiler reserves enough space
4648in the program's memory to hold the @emph{value} of the symbol. The
4649second is that the compiler creates an entry in the program's symbol
4650table which holds the symbol's @emph{address}. ie the symbol table
4651contains the address of the block of memory holding the symbol's
4652value. So for example the following C declaration, at file scope:
4653
4654@smallexample
4655 int foo = 1000;
4656@end smallexample
4657
10bf6894 4658creates an entry called @samp{foo} in the symbol table. This entry
73ae6183
NC
4659holds the address of an @samp{int} sized block of memory where the
4660number 1000 is initially stored.
4661
4662When a program references a symbol the compiler generates code that
4663first accesses the symbol table to find the address of the symbol's
4664memory block and then code to read the value from that memory block.
4665So:
4666
4667@smallexample
4668 foo = 1;
4669@end smallexample
4670
4671looks up the symbol @samp{foo} in the symbol table, gets the address
4672associated with this symbol and then writes the value 1 into that
4673address. Whereas:
4674
4675@smallexample
4676 int * a = & foo;
4677@end smallexample
4678
10bf6894 4679looks up the symbol @samp{foo} in the symbol table, gets its address
73ae6183
NC
4680and then copies this address into the block of memory associated with
4681the variable @samp{a}.
4682
4683Linker scripts symbol declarations, by contrast, create an entry in
4684the symbol table but do not assign any memory to them. Thus they are
4685an address without a value. So for example the linker script definition:
4686
4687@smallexample
4688 foo = 1000;
4689@end smallexample
4690
4691creates an entry in the symbol table called @samp{foo} which holds
4692the address of memory location 1000, but nothing special is stored at
4693address 1000. This means that you cannot access the @emph{value} of a
4694linker script defined symbol - it has no value - all you can do is
4695access the @emph{address} of a linker script defined symbol.
4696
4697Hence when you are using a linker script defined symbol in source code
4698you should always take the address of the symbol, and never attempt to
4699use its value. For example suppose you want to copy the contents of a
4700section of memory called .ROM into a section called .FLASH and the
4701linker script contains these declarations:
4702
4703@smallexample
4704@group
4705 start_of_ROM = .ROM;
a5e406b5 4706 end_of_ROM = .ROM + sizeof (.ROM);
73ae6183
NC
4707 start_of_FLASH = .FLASH;
4708@end group
4709@end smallexample
4710
4711Then the C source code to perform the copy would be:
4712
4713@smallexample
4714@group
4715 extern char start_of_ROM, end_of_ROM, start_of_FLASH;
c0065db7 4716
73ae6183
NC
4717 memcpy (& start_of_FLASH, & start_of_ROM, & end_of_ROM - & start_of_ROM);
4718@end group
4719@end smallexample
4720
4721Note the use of the @samp{&} operators. These are correct.
5707d2ad
NC
4722Alternatively the symbols can be treated as the names of vectors or
4723arrays and then the code will again work as expected:
4724
4725@smallexample
4726@group
4727 extern char start_of_ROM[], end_of_ROM[], start_of_FLASH[];
4728
4729 memcpy (start_of_FLASH, start_of_ROM, end_of_ROM - start_of_ROM);
4730@end group
4731@end smallexample
4732
4733Note how using this method does not require the use of @samp{&}
4734operators.
73ae6183 4735
252b5132 4736@node SECTIONS
36f63dca 4737@section SECTIONS Command
252b5132
RH
4738@kindex SECTIONS
4739The @code{SECTIONS} command tells the linker how to map input sections
4740into output sections, and how to place the output sections in memory.
4741
4742The format of the @code{SECTIONS} command is:
4743@smallexample
4744SECTIONS
4745@{
4746 @var{sections-command}
4747 @var{sections-command}
4748 @dots{}
4749@}
4750@end smallexample
4751
4752Each @var{sections-command} may of be one of the following:
4753
4754@itemize @bullet
4755@item
4756an @code{ENTRY} command (@pxref{Entry Point,,Entry command})
4757@item
4758a symbol assignment (@pxref{Assignments})
4759@item
4760an output section description
4761@item
4762an overlay description
4763@end itemize
4764
4765The @code{ENTRY} command and symbol assignments are permitted inside the
4766@code{SECTIONS} command for convenience in using the location counter in
4767those commands. This can also make the linker script easier to
4768understand because you can use those commands at meaningful points in
4769the layout of the output file.
4770
4771Output section descriptions and overlay descriptions are described
4772below.
4773
4774If you do not use a @code{SECTIONS} command in your linker script, the
4775linker will place each input section into an identically named output
4776section in the order that the sections are first encountered in the
4777input files. If all input sections are present in the first file, for
4778example, the order of sections in the output file will match the order
4779in the first input file. The first section will be at address zero.
4780
4781@menu
4782* Output Section Description:: Output section description
4783* Output Section Name:: Output section name
4784* Output Section Address:: Output section address
4785* Input Section:: Input section description
4786* Output Section Data:: Output section data
4787* Output Section Keywords:: Output section keywords
4788* Output Section Discarding:: Output section discarding
4789* Output Section Attributes:: Output section attributes
4790* Overlay Description:: Overlay description
4791@end menu
4792
4793@node Output Section Description
36f63dca 4794@subsection Output Section Description
252b5132
RH
4795The full description of an output section looks like this:
4796@smallexample
a1ab1d2a 4797@group
7e7d5768 4798@var{section} [@var{address}] [(@var{type})] :
0c71d759 4799 [AT(@var{lma})]
1eec346e 4800 [ALIGN(@var{section_align}) | ALIGN_WITH_INPUT]
0c71d759
NC
4801 [SUBALIGN(@var{subsection_align})]
4802 [@var{constraint}]
252b5132
RH
4803 @{
4804 @var{output-section-command}
4805 @var{output-section-command}
4806 @dots{}
abc9061b 4807 @} [>@var{region}] [AT>@var{lma_region}] [:@var{phdr} :@var{phdr} @dots{}] [=@var{fillexp}] [,]
252b5132
RH
4808@end group
4809@end smallexample
4810
4811Most output sections do not use most of the optional section attributes.
4812
4813The whitespace around @var{section} is required, so that the section
4814name is unambiguous. The colon and the curly braces are also required.
abc9061b
CC
4815The comma at the end may be required if a @var{fillexp} is used and
4816the next @var{sections-command} looks like a continuation of the expression.
252b5132
RH
4817The line breaks and other white space are optional.
4818
4819Each @var{output-section-command} may be one of the following:
4820
4821@itemize @bullet
4822@item
4823a symbol assignment (@pxref{Assignments})
4824@item
4825an input section description (@pxref{Input Section})
4826@item
4827data values to include directly (@pxref{Output Section Data})
4828@item
4829a special output section keyword (@pxref{Output Section Keywords})
4830@end itemize
4831
4832@node Output Section Name
36f63dca 4833@subsection Output Section Name
252b5132
RH
4834@cindex name, section
4835@cindex section name
4836The name of the output section is @var{section}. @var{section} must
4837meet the constraints of your output format. In formats which only
4838support a limited number of sections, such as @code{a.out}, the name
4839must be one of the names supported by the format (@code{a.out}, for
4840example, allows only @samp{.text}, @samp{.data} or @samp{.bss}). If the
4841output format supports any number of sections, but with numbers and not
4842names (as is the case for Oasys), the name should be supplied as a
4843quoted numeric string. A section name may consist of any sequence of
4844characters, but a name which contains any unusual characters such as
4845commas must be quoted.
4846
4847The output section name @samp{/DISCARD/} is special; @ref{Output Section
4848Discarding}.
4849
4850@node Output Section Address
2a16d82a 4851@subsection Output Section Address
252b5132
RH
4852@cindex address, section
4853@cindex section address
4854The @var{address} is an expression for the VMA (the virtual memory
ea5cae92
NC
4855address) of the output section. This address is optional, but if it
4856is provided then the output address will be set exactly as specified.
4857
4858If the output address is not specified then one will be chosen for the
4859section, based on the heuristic below. This address will be adjusted
4860to fit the alignment requirement of the output section. The
4861alignment requirement is the strictest alignment of any input section
4862contained within the output section.
4863
4864The output section address heuristic is as follows:
4865
4866@itemize @bullet
4867@item
4868If an output memory @var{region} is set for the section then it
4869is added to this region and its address will be the next free address
4870in that region.
4871
4872@item
4873If the MEMORY command has been used to create a list of memory
4874regions then the first region which has attributes compatible with the
4875section is selected to contain it. The section's output address will
4876be the next free address in that region; @ref{MEMORY}.
4877
4878@item
4879If no memory regions were specified, or none match the section then
4880the output address will be based on the current value of the location
4881counter.
4882@end itemize
4883
4884@noindent
4885For example:
4886
252b5132
RH
4887@smallexample
4888.text . : @{ *(.text) @}
4889@end smallexample
ea5cae92 4890
252b5132
RH
4891@noindent
4892and
ea5cae92 4893
252b5132
RH
4894@smallexample
4895.text : @{ *(.text) @}
4896@end smallexample
ea5cae92 4897
252b5132
RH
4898@noindent
4899are subtly different. The first will set the address of the
4900@samp{.text} output section to the current value of the location
4901counter. The second will set it to the current value of the location
ea5cae92
NC
4902counter aligned to the strictest alignment of any of the @samp{.text}
4903input sections.
252b5132
RH
4904
4905The @var{address} may be an arbitrary expression; @ref{Expressions}.
4906For example, if you want to align the section on a 0x10 byte boundary,
4907so that the lowest four bits of the section address are zero, you could
4908do something like this:
4909@smallexample
4910.text ALIGN(0x10) : @{ *(.text) @}
4911@end smallexample
4912@noindent
4913This works because @code{ALIGN} returns the current location counter
4914aligned upward to the specified value.
4915
4916Specifying @var{address} for a section will change the value of the
6ce340f1
NC
4917location counter, provided that the section is non-empty. (Empty
4918sections are ignored).
252b5132
RH
4919
4920@node Input Section
36f63dca 4921@subsection Input Section Description
252b5132
RH
4922@cindex input sections
4923@cindex mapping input sections to output sections
4924The most common output section command is an input section description.
4925
4926The input section description is the most basic linker script operation.
4927You use output sections to tell the linker how to lay out your program
4928in memory. You use input section descriptions to tell the linker how to
4929map the input files into your memory layout.
4930
4931@menu
4932* Input Section Basics:: Input section basics
4933* Input Section Wildcards:: Input section wildcard patterns
4934* Input Section Common:: Input section for common symbols
4935* Input Section Keep:: Input section and garbage collection
4936* Input Section Example:: Input section example
4937@end menu
4938
4939@node Input Section Basics
36f63dca 4940@subsubsection Input Section Basics
252b5132
RH
4941@cindex input section basics
4942An input section description consists of a file name optionally followed
4943by a list of section names in parentheses.
4944
4945The file name and the section name may be wildcard patterns, which we
4946describe further below (@pxref{Input Section Wildcards}).
4947
4948The most common input section description is to include all input
4949sections with a particular name in the output section. For example, to
4950include all input @samp{.text} sections, you would write:
4951@smallexample
4952*(.text)
4953@end smallexample
4954@noindent
18625d54 4955Here the @samp{*} is a wildcard which matches any file name. To exclude a list
8f1732fc 4956@cindex EXCLUDE_FILE
18625d54
CM
4957of files from matching the file name wildcard, EXCLUDE_FILE may be used to
4958match all files except the ones specified in the EXCLUDE_FILE list. For
4959example:
252b5132 4960@smallexample
8f1732fc
AB
4961EXCLUDE_FILE (*crtend.o *otherfile.o) *(.ctors)
4962@end smallexample
4963@noindent
4964will cause all .ctors sections from all files except @file{crtend.o}
4965and @file{otherfile.o} to be included. The EXCLUDE_FILE can also be
4966placed inside the section list, for example:
4967@smallexample
b4346c09 4968*(EXCLUDE_FILE (*crtend.o *otherfile.o) .ctors)
252b5132 4969@end smallexample
8f1732fc
AB
4970@noindent
4971The result of this is identically to the previous example. Supporting
4972two syntaxes for EXCLUDE_FILE is useful if the section list contains
4973more than one section, as described below.
252b5132
RH
4974
4975There are two ways to include more than one section:
4976@smallexample
4977*(.text .rdata)
4978*(.text) *(.rdata)
4979@end smallexample
4980@noindent
4981The difference between these is the order in which the @samp{.text} and
4982@samp{.rdata} input sections will appear in the output section. In the
b6bf44ba
AM
4983first example, they will be intermingled, appearing in the same order as
4984they are found in the linker input. In the second example, all
252b5132
RH
4985@samp{.text} input sections will appear first, followed by all
4986@samp{.rdata} input sections.
4987
8f1732fc
AB
4988When using EXCLUDE_FILE with more than one section, if the exclusion
4989is within the section list then the exclusion only applies to the
4990immediately following section, for example:
a5bf7d4f
AB
4991@smallexample
4992*(EXCLUDE_FILE (*somefile.o) .text .rdata)
4993@end smallexample
4994@noindent
4995will cause all @samp{.text} sections from all files except
4996@file{somefile.o} to be included, while all @samp{.rdata} sections
4997from all files, including @file{somefile.o}, will be included. To
4998exclude the @samp{.rdata} sections from @file{somefile.o} the example
8f1732fc 4999could be modified to:
a5bf7d4f
AB
5000@smallexample
5001*(EXCLUDE_FILE (*somefile.o) .text EXCLUDE_FILE (*somefile.o) .rdata)
5002@end smallexample
8f1732fc
AB
5003@noindent
5004Alternatively, placing the EXCLUDE_FILE outside of the section list,
5005before the input file selection, will cause the exclusion to apply for
5006all sections. Thus the previous example can be rewritten as:
5007@smallexample
5008EXCLUDE_FILE (*somefile.o) *(.text .rdata)
5009@end smallexample
a5bf7d4f 5010
252b5132
RH
5011You can specify a file name to include sections from a particular file.
5012You would do this if one or more of your files contain special data that
5013needs to be at a particular location in memory. For example:
5014@smallexample
5015data.o(.data)
5016@end smallexample
5017
ae17ab41
CM
5018To refine the sections that are included based on the section flags
5019of an input section, INPUT_SECTION_FLAGS may be used.
5020
5021Here is a simple example for using Section header flags for ELF sections:
5022
5023@smallexample
5024@group
5025SECTIONS @{
5026 .text : @{ INPUT_SECTION_FLAGS (SHF_MERGE & SHF_STRINGS) *(.text) @}
5027 .text2 : @{ INPUT_SECTION_FLAGS (!SHF_WRITE) *(.text) @}
5028@}
5029@end group
5030@end smallexample
5031
5032In this example, the output section @samp{.text} will be comprised of any
5033input section matching the name *(.text) whose section header flags
5034@code{SHF_MERGE} and @code{SHF_STRINGS} are set. The output section
5035@samp{.text2} will be comprised of any input section matching the name *(.text)
5036whose section header flag @code{SHF_WRITE} is clear.
5037
967928e9
AM
5038You can also specify files within archives by writing a pattern
5039matching the archive, a colon, then the pattern matching the file,
5040with no whitespace around the colon.
5041
5042@table @samp
5043@item archive:file
5044matches file within archive
5045@item archive:
5046matches the whole archive
5047@item :file
5048matches file but not one in an archive
5049@end table
5050
5051Either one or both of @samp{archive} and @samp{file} can contain shell
5052wildcards. On DOS based file systems, the linker will assume that a
5053single letter followed by a colon is a drive specifier, so
5054@samp{c:myfile.o} is a simple file specification, not @samp{myfile.o}
5055within an archive called @samp{c}. @samp{archive:file} filespecs may
5056also be used within an @code{EXCLUDE_FILE} list, but may not appear in
5057other linker script contexts. For instance, you cannot extract a file
5058from an archive by using @samp{archive:file} in an @code{INPUT}
5059command.
5060
252b5132
RH
5061If you use a file name without a list of sections, then all sections in
5062the input file will be included in the output section. This is not
5063commonly done, but it may by useful on occasion. For example:
5064@smallexample
5065data.o
5066@end smallexample
5067
967928e9
AM
5068When you use a file name which is not an @samp{archive:file} specifier
5069and does not contain any wild card
252b5132
RH
5070characters, the linker will first see if you also specified the file
5071name on the linker command line or in an @code{INPUT} command. If you
5072did not, the linker will attempt to open the file as an input file, as
5073though it appeared on the command line. Note that this differs from an
5074@code{INPUT} command, because the linker will not search for the file in
5075the archive search path.
5076
5077@node Input Section Wildcards
36f63dca 5078@subsubsection Input Section Wildcard Patterns
252b5132
RH
5079@cindex input section wildcards
5080@cindex wildcard file name patterns
5081@cindex file name wildcard patterns
5082@cindex section name wildcard patterns
5083In an input section description, either the file name or the section
5084name or both may be wildcard patterns.
5085
5086The file name of @samp{*} seen in many examples is a simple wildcard
5087pattern for the file name.
5088
5089The wildcard patterns are like those used by the Unix shell.
5090
5091@table @samp
5092@item *
5093matches any number of characters
5094@item ?
5095matches any single character
5096@item [@var{chars}]
5097matches a single instance of any of the @var{chars}; the @samp{-}
5098character may be used to specify a range of characters, as in
5099@samp{[a-z]} to match any lower case letter
5100@item \
5101quotes the following character
5102@end table
5103
252b5132
RH
5104File name wildcard patterns only match files which are explicitly
5105specified on the command line or in an @code{INPUT} command. The linker
5106does not search directories to expand wildcards.
5107
5108If a file name matches more than one wildcard pattern, or if a file name
5109appears explicitly and is also matched by a wildcard pattern, the linker
5110will use the first match in the linker script. For example, this
5111sequence of input section descriptions is probably in error, because the
5112@file{data.o} rule will not be used:
5113@smallexample
5114.data : @{ *(.data) @}
5115.data1 : @{ data.o(.data) @}
5116@end smallexample
5117
bcaa7b3e 5118@cindex SORT_BY_NAME
252b5132
RH
5119Normally, the linker will place files and sections matched by wildcards
5120in the order in which they are seen during the link. You can change
bcaa7b3e
L
5121this by using the @code{SORT_BY_NAME} keyword, which appears before a wildcard
5122pattern in parentheses (e.g., @code{SORT_BY_NAME(.text*)}). When the
5123@code{SORT_BY_NAME} keyword is used, the linker will sort the files or sections
252b5132
RH
5124into ascending order by name before placing them in the output file.
5125
bcaa7b3e 5126@cindex SORT_BY_ALIGNMENT
9a24a276
AM
5127@code{SORT_BY_ALIGNMENT} is similar to @code{SORT_BY_NAME}.
5128@code{SORT_BY_ALIGNMENT} will sort sections into descending order of
5129alignment before placing them in the output file. Placing larger
5130alignments before smaller alignments can reduce the amount of padding
5131needed.
bcaa7b3e 5132
02ecc8e9 5133@cindex SORT_BY_INIT_PRIORITY
9a24a276
AM
5134@code{SORT_BY_INIT_PRIORITY} is also similar to @code{SORT_BY_NAME}.
5135@code{SORT_BY_INIT_PRIORITY} will sort sections into ascending
5136numerical order of the GCC init_priority attribute encoded in the
5137section name before placing them in the output file. In
5138@code{.init_array.NNNNN} and @code{.fini_array.NNNNN}, @code{NNNNN} is
5139the init_priority. In @code{.ctors.NNNNN} and @code{.dtors.NNNNN},
5140@code{NNNNN} is 65535 minus the init_priority.
02ecc8e9 5141
bcaa7b3e
L
5142@cindex SORT
5143@code{SORT} is an alias for @code{SORT_BY_NAME}.
5144
5145When there are nested section sorting commands in linker script, there
5146can be at most 1 level of nesting for section sorting commands.
5147
5148@enumerate
5149@item
5150@code{SORT_BY_NAME} (@code{SORT_BY_ALIGNMENT} (wildcard section pattern)).
1ae5c3ae 5151It will sort the input sections by name first, then by alignment if two
bcaa7b3e
L
5152sections have the same name.
5153@item
5154@code{SORT_BY_ALIGNMENT} (@code{SORT_BY_NAME} (wildcard section pattern)).
1ae5c3ae 5155It will sort the input sections by alignment first, then by name if two
bcaa7b3e
L
5156sections have the same alignment.
5157@item
c0065db7 5158@code{SORT_BY_NAME} (@code{SORT_BY_NAME} (wildcard section pattern)) is
bcaa7b3e
L
5159treated the same as @code{SORT_BY_NAME} (wildcard section pattern).
5160@item
5161@code{SORT_BY_ALIGNMENT} (@code{SORT_BY_ALIGNMENT} (wildcard section pattern))
5162is treated the same as @code{SORT_BY_ALIGNMENT} (wildcard section pattern).
5163@item
5164All other nested section sorting commands are invalid.
5165@end enumerate
5166
a05a5b64 5167When both command-line section sorting option and linker script
bcaa7b3e 5168section sorting command are used, section sorting command always
a05a5b64 5169takes precedence over the command-line option.
bcaa7b3e
L
5170
5171If the section sorting command in linker script isn't nested, the
a05a5b64 5172command-line option will make the section sorting command to be
bcaa7b3e
L
5173treated as nested sorting command.
5174
5175@enumerate
5176@item
5177@code{SORT_BY_NAME} (wildcard section pattern ) with
5178@option{--sort-sections alignment} is equivalent to
5179@code{SORT_BY_NAME} (@code{SORT_BY_ALIGNMENT} (wildcard section pattern)).
5180@item
5181@code{SORT_BY_ALIGNMENT} (wildcard section pattern) with
5182@option{--sort-section name} is equivalent to
5183@code{SORT_BY_ALIGNMENT} (@code{SORT_BY_NAME} (wildcard section pattern)).
5184@end enumerate
5185
5186If the section sorting command in linker script is nested, the
a05a5b64 5187command-line option will be ignored.
bcaa7b3e 5188
eda680f8 5189@cindex SORT_NONE
a05a5b64 5190@code{SORT_NONE} disables section sorting by ignoring the command-line
eda680f8
L
5191section sorting option.
5192
252b5132
RH
5193If you ever get confused about where input sections are going, use the
5194@samp{-M} linker option to generate a map file. The map file shows
5195precisely how input sections are mapped to output sections.
5196
5197This example shows how wildcard patterns might be used to partition
5198files. This linker script directs the linker to place all @samp{.text}
5199sections in @samp{.text} and all @samp{.bss} sections in @samp{.bss}.
5200The linker will place the @samp{.data} section from all files beginning
5201with an upper case character in @samp{.DATA}; for all other files, the
5202linker will place the @samp{.data} section in @samp{.data}.
5203@smallexample
5204@group
5205SECTIONS @{
5206 .text : @{ *(.text) @}
5207 .DATA : @{ [A-Z]*(.data) @}
5208 .data : @{ *(.data) @}
5209 .bss : @{ *(.bss) @}
5210@}
5211@end group
5212@end smallexample
5213
5214@node Input Section Common
36f63dca 5215@subsubsection Input Section for Common Symbols
252b5132
RH
5216@cindex common symbol placement
5217@cindex uninitialized data placement
5218A special notation is needed for common symbols, because in many object
5219file formats common symbols do not have a particular input section. The
5220linker treats common symbols as though they are in an input section
5221named @samp{COMMON}.
5222
5223You may use file names with the @samp{COMMON} section just as with any
5224other input sections. You can use this to place common symbols from a
5225particular input file in one section while common symbols from other
5226input files are placed in another section.
5227
5228In most cases, common symbols in input files will be placed in the
5229@samp{.bss} section in the output file. For example:
5230@smallexample
5231.bss @{ *(.bss) *(COMMON) @}
5232@end smallexample
5233
5234@cindex scommon section
5235@cindex small common symbols
5236Some object file formats have more than one type of common symbol. For
5237example, the MIPS ELF object file format distinguishes standard common
5238symbols and small common symbols. In this case, the linker will use a
5239different special section name for other types of common symbols. In
5240the case of MIPS ELF, the linker uses @samp{COMMON} for standard common
5241symbols and @samp{.scommon} for small common symbols. This permits you
5242to map the different types of common symbols into memory at different
5243locations.
5244
5245@cindex [COMMON]
5246You will sometimes see @samp{[COMMON]} in old linker scripts. This
5247notation is now considered obsolete. It is equivalent to
5248@samp{*(COMMON)}.
5249
5250@node Input Section Keep
36f63dca 5251@subsubsection Input Section and Garbage Collection
252b5132
RH
5252@cindex KEEP
5253@cindex garbage collection
5254When link-time garbage collection is in use (@samp{--gc-sections}),
a1ab1d2a 5255it is often useful to mark sections that should not be eliminated.
252b5132
RH
5256This is accomplished by surrounding an input section's wildcard entry
5257with @code{KEEP()}, as in @code{KEEP(*(.init))} or
bcaa7b3e 5258@code{KEEP(SORT_BY_NAME(*)(.ctors))}.
252b5132
RH
5259
5260@node Input Section Example
36f63dca 5261@subsubsection Input Section Example
252b5132
RH
5262The following example is a complete linker script. It tells the linker
5263to read all of the sections from file @file{all.o} and place them at the
5264start of output section @samp{outputa} which starts at location
5265@samp{0x10000}. All of section @samp{.input1} from file @file{foo.o}
5266follows immediately, in the same output section. All of section
5267@samp{.input2} from @file{foo.o} goes into output section
5268@samp{outputb}, followed by section @samp{.input1} from @file{foo1.o}.
5269All of the remaining @samp{.input1} and @samp{.input2} sections from any
5270files are written to output section @samp{outputc}.
5271
5272@smallexample
5273@group
5274SECTIONS @{
5275 outputa 0x10000 :
5276 @{
5277 all.o
5278 foo.o (.input1)
5279 @}
36f63dca
NC
5280@end group
5281@group
252b5132
RH
5282 outputb :
5283 @{
5284 foo.o (.input2)
5285 foo1.o (.input1)
5286 @}
36f63dca
NC
5287@end group
5288@group
252b5132
RH
5289 outputc :
5290 @{
5291 *(.input1)
5292 *(.input2)
5293 @}
5294@}
5295@end group
a1ab1d2a 5296@end smallexample
252b5132 5297
cbd0eecf
L
5298If an output section's name is the same as the input section's name
5299and is representable as a C identifier, then the linker will
5300automatically @pxref{PROVIDE} two symbols: __start_SECNAME and
5301__stop_SECNAME, where SECNAME is the name of the section. These
5302indicate the start address and end address of the output section
5303respectively. Note: most section names are not representable as
5304C identifiers because they contain a @samp{.} character.
5305
252b5132 5306@node Output Section Data
36f63dca 5307@subsection Output Section Data
252b5132
RH
5308@cindex data
5309@cindex section data
5310@cindex output section data
5311@kindex BYTE(@var{expression})
5312@kindex SHORT(@var{expression})
5313@kindex LONG(@var{expression})
5314@kindex QUAD(@var{expression})
5315@kindex SQUAD(@var{expression})
5316You can include explicit bytes of data in an output section by using
5317@code{BYTE}, @code{SHORT}, @code{LONG}, @code{QUAD}, or @code{SQUAD} as
5318an output section command. Each keyword is followed by an expression in
5319parentheses providing the value to store (@pxref{Expressions}). The
5320value of the expression is stored at the current value of the location
5321counter.
5322
5323The @code{BYTE}, @code{SHORT}, @code{LONG}, and @code{QUAD} commands
5324store one, two, four, and eight bytes (respectively). After storing the
5325bytes, the location counter is incremented by the number of bytes
5326stored.
5327
5328For example, this will store the byte 1 followed by the four byte value
5329of the symbol @samp{addr}:
5330@smallexample
5331BYTE(1)
5332LONG(addr)
5333@end smallexample
5334
5335When using a 64 bit host or target, @code{QUAD} and @code{SQUAD} are the
5336same; they both store an 8 byte, or 64 bit, value. When both host and
5337target are 32 bits, an expression is computed as 32 bits. In this case
5338@code{QUAD} stores a 32 bit value zero extended to 64 bits, and
5339@code{SQUAD} stores a 32 bit value sign extended to 64 bits.
5340
5341If the object file format of the output file has an explicit endianness,
5342which is the normal case, the value will be stored in that endianness.
5343When the object file format does not have an explicit endianness, as is
5344true of, for example, S-records, the value will be stored in the
5345endianness of the first input object file.
5346
36f63dca 5347Note---these commands only work inside a section description and not
2b5fc1f5
NC
5348between them, so the following will produce an error from the linker:
5349@smallexample
5350SECTIONS @{@ .text : @{@ *(.text) @}@ LONG(1) .data : @{@ *(.data) @}@ @}@
5351@end smallexample
5352whereas this will work:
5353@smallexample
5354SECTIONS @{@ .text : @{@ *(.text) ; LONG(1) @}@ .data : @{@ *(.data) @}@ @}@
5355@end smallexample
5356
252b5132
RH
5357@kindex FILL(@var{expression})
5358@cindex holes, filling
5359@cindex unspecified memory
5360You may use the @code{FILL} command to set the fill pattern for the
5361current section. It is followed by an expression in parentheses. Any
5362otherwise unspecified regions of memory within the section (for example,
5363gaps left due to the required alignment of input sections) are filled
a139d329 5364with the value of the expression, repeated as
252b5132
RH
5365necessary. A @code{FILL} statement covers memory locations after the
5366point at which it occurs in the section definition; by including more
5367than one @code{FILL} statement, you can have different fill patterns in
5368different parts of an output section.
5369
5370This example shows how to fill unspecified regions of memory with the
563e308f 5371value @samp{0x90}:
252b5132 5372@smallexample
563e308f 5373FILL(0x90909090)
252b5132
RH
5374@end smallexample
5375
5376The @code{FILL} command is similar to the @samp{=@var{fillexp}} output
9673c93c 5377section attribute, but it only affects the
252b5132
RH
5378part of the section following the @code{FILL} command, rather than the
5379entire section. If both are used, the @code{FILL} command takes
9673c93c 5380precedence. @xref{Output Section Fill}, for details on the fill
a139d329 5381expression.
252b5132
RH
5382
5383@node Output Section Keywords
36f63dca 5384@subsection Output Section Keywords
252b5132
RH
5385There are a couple of keywords which can appear as output section
5386commands.
5387
5388@table @code
5389@kindex CREATE_OBJECT_SYMBOLS
5390@cindex input filename symbols
5391@cindex filename symbols
5392@item CREATE_OBJECT_SYMBOLS
5393The command tells the linker to create a symbol for each input file.
5394The name of each symbol will be the name of the corresponding input
5395file. The section of each symbol will be the output section in which
5396the @code{CREATE_OBJECT_SYMBOLS} command appears.
5397
5398This is conventional for the a.out object file format. It is not
5399normally used for any other object file format.
5400
5401@kindex CONSTRUCTORS
5402@cindex C++ constructors, arranging in link
5403@cindex constructors, arranging in link
5404@item CONSTRUCTORS
5405When linking using the a.out object file format, the linker uses an
5406unusual set construct to support C++ global constructors and
5407destructors. When linking object file formats which do not support
5408arbitrary sections, such as ECOFF and XCOFF, the linker will
5409automatically recognize C++ global constructors and destructors by name.
5410For these object file formats, the @code{CONSTRUCTORS} command tells the
5411linker to place constructor information in the output section where the
5412@code{CONSTRUCTORS} command appears. The @code{CONSTRUCTORS} command is
5413ignored for other object file formats.
5414
5415The symbol @w{@code{__CTOR_LIST__}} marks the start of the global
7e69709c
AM
5416constructors, and the symbol @w{@code{__CTOR_END__}} marks the end.
5417Similarly, @w{@code{__DTOR_LIST__}} and @w{@code{__DTOR_END__}} mark
5418the start and end of the global destructors. The
252b5132
RH
5419first word in the list is the number of entries, followed by the address
5420of each constructor or destructor, followed by a zero word. The
5421compiler must arrange to actually run the code. For these object file
5422formats @sc{gnu} C++ normally calls constructors from a subroutine
5423@code{__main}; a call to @code{__main} is automatically inserted into
5424the startup code for @code{main}. @sc{gnu} C++ normally runs
5425destructors either by using @code{atexit}, or directly from the function
5426@code{exit}.
5427
5428For object file formats such as @code{COFF} or @code{ELF} which support
5429arbitrary section names, @sc{gnu} C++ will normally arrange to put the
5430addresses of global constructors and destructors into the @code{.ctors}
5431and @code{.dtors} sections. Placing the following sequence into your
5432linker script will build the sort of table which the @sc{gnu} C++
5433runtime code expects to see.
5434
5435@smallexample
5436 __CTOR_LIST__ = .;
5437 LONG((__CTOR_END__ - __CTOR_LIST__) / 4 - 2)
5438 *(.ctors)
5439 LONG(0)
5440 __CTOR_END__ = .;
5441 __DTOR_LIST__ = .;
5442 LONG((__DTOR_END__ - __DTOR_LIST__) / 4 - 2)
5443 *(.dtors)
5444 LONG(0)
5445 __DTOR_END__ = .;
5446@end smallexample
5447
5448If you are using the @sc{gnu} C++ support for initialization priority,
5449which provides some control over the order in which global constructors
5450are run, you must sort the constructors at link time to ensure that they
5451are executed in the correct order. When using the @code{CONSTRUCTORS}
bcaa7b3e
L
5452command, use @samp{SORT_BY_NAME(CONSTRUCTORS)} instead. When using the
5453@code{.ctors} and @code{.dtors} sections, use @samp{*(SORT_BY_NAME(.ctors))} and
5454@samp{*(SORT_BY_NAME(.dtors))} instead of just @samp{*(.ctors)} and
252b5132
RH
5455@samp{*(.dtors)}.
5456
5457Normally the compiler and linker will handle these issues automatically,
5458and you will not need to concern yourself with them. However, you may
5459need to consider this if you are using C++ and writing your own linker
5460scripts.
5461
5462@end table
5463
5464@node Output Section Discarding
36f63dca 5465@subsection Output Section Discarding
252b5132
RH
5466@cindex discarding sections
5467@cindex sections, discarding
5468@cindex removing sections
2edab91c
AM
5469The linker will not normally create output sections with no contents.
5470This is for convenience when referring to input sections that may or
5471may not be present in any of the input files. For example:
252b5132 5472@smallexample
49c13adb 5473.foo : @{ *(.foo) @}
252b5132
RH
5474@end smallexample
5475@noindent
5476will only create a @samp{.foo} section in the output file if there is a
74541ad4
AM
5477@samp{.foo} section in at least one input file, and if the input
5478sections are not all empty. Other link script directives that allocate
2edab91c
AM
5479space in an output section will also create the output section. So
5480too will assignments to dot even if the assignment does not create
5481space, except for @samp{. = 0}, @samp{. = . + 0}, @samp{. = sym},
5482@samp{. = . + sym} and @samp{. = ALIGN (. != 0, expr, 1)} when
5483@samp{sym} is an absolute symbol of value 0 defined in the script.
5484This allows you to force output of an empty section with @samp{. = .}.
74541ad4 5485
a0976ea4 5486The linker will ignore address assignments (@pxref{Output Section Address})
74541ad4
AM
5487on discarded output sections, except when the linker script defines
5488symbols in the output section. In that case the linker will obey
a0976ea4
AM
5489the address assignments, possibly advancing dot even though the
5490section is discarded.
252b5132
RH
5491
5492@cindex /DISCARD/
5493The special output section name @samp{/DISCARD/} may be used to discard
5494input sections. Any input sections which are assigned to an output
5495section named @samp{/DISCARD/} are not included in the output file.
5496
99fabbc9
JL
5497This can be used to discard input sections marked with the ELF flag
5498@code{SHF_GNU_RETAIN}, which would otherwise have been saved from linker
5499garbage collection.
5500
a2e098c3
NC
5501Note, sections that match the @samp{/DISCARD/} output section will be
5502discarded even if they are in an ELF section group which has other
5503members which are not being discarded. This is deliberate.
5504Discarding takes precedence over grouping.
5505
252b5132 5506@node Output Section Attributes
36f63dca 5507@subsection Output Section Attributes
252b5132
RH
5508@cindex output section attributes
5509We showed above that the full description of an output section looked
5510like this:
0c71d759 5511
252b5132 5512@smallexample
a1ab1d2a 5513@group
7e7d5768 5514@var{section} [@var{address}] [(@var{type})] :
0c71d759 5515 [AT(@var{lma})]
3bbec4bd 5516 [ALIGN(@var{section_align}) | ALIGN_WITH_INPUT]
0c71d759
NC
5517 [SUBALIGN(@var{subsection_align})]
5518 [@var{constraint}]
252b5132
RH
5519 @{
5520 @var{output-section-command}
5521 @var{output-section-command}
5522 @dots{}
562d3460 5523 @} [>@var{region}] [AT>@var{lma_region}] [:@var{phdr} :@var{phdr} @dots{}] [=@var{fillexp}]
252b5132
RH
5524@end group
5525@end smallexample
0c71d759 5526
252b5132
RH
5527We've already described @var{section}, @var{address}, and
5528@var{output-section-command}. In this section we will describe the
5529remaining section attributes.
5530
a1ab1d2a 5531@menu
252b5132
RH
5532* Output Section Type:: Output section type
5533* Output Section LMA:: Output section LMA
bbf115d3 5534* Forced Output Alignment:: Forced Output Alignment
7e7d5768 5535* Forced Input Alignment:: Forced Input Alignment
0c71d759 5536* Output Section Constraint:: Output section constraint
252b5132
RH
5537* Output Section Region:: Output section region
5538* Output Section Phdr:: Output section phdr
5539* Output Section Fill:: Output section fill
5540@end menu
5541
5542@node Output Section Type
36f63dca 5543@subsubsection Output Section Type
252b5132
RH
5544Each output section may have a type. The type is a keyword in
5545parentheses. The following types are defined:
5546
5547@table @code
dcb53d93 5548
252b5132
RH
5549@item NOLOAD
5550The section should be marked as not loadable, so that it will not be
5551loaded into memory when the program is run.
dcb53d93 5552
6b86da53
LB
5553@item READONLY
5554The section should be marked as read-only.
dcb53d93 5555
252b5132 5556@item DSECT
c212f39d
FS
5557@item COPY
5558@item INFO
5559@item OVERLAY
252b5132
RH
5560These type names are supported for backward compatibility, and are
5561rarely used. They all have the same effect: the section should be
5562marked as not allocatable, so that no memory is allocated for the
5563section when the program is run.
dcb53d93 5564
c212f39d
FS
5565@item TYPE = @var{type}
5566Set the section type to the integer @var{type}. When generating an ELF
5567output file, type names @code{SHT_PROGBITS}, @code{SHT_STRTAB},
5c14cc55 5568@code{SHT_NOTE}, @code{SHT_NOBITS}, @code{SHT_INIT_ARRAY},
c212f39d
FS
5569@code{SHT_FINI_ARRAY}, and @code{SHT_PREINIT_ARRAY} are also allowed
5570for @var{type}. It is the user's responsibility to ensure that any
5571special requirements of the section type are met.
dcb53d93
NC
5572
5573Note - the TYPE only is used if some or all of the contents of the
5574section do not have an implicit type of their own. So for example:
5575@smallexample
5576 .foo . TYPE = SHT_PROGBITS @{ *(.bar) @}
5577@end smallexample
5578will set the type of section @samp{.foo} to the type of the section
5579@samp{.bar} in the input files, which may not be the SHT_PROGBITS
5580type. Whereas:
5581@smallexample
5582 .foo . TYPE = SHT_PROGBITS @{ BYTE(1) @}
5583@end smallexample
5584will set the type of @samp{.foo} to SHT_PROGBBITS. If it is necessary
5585to override the type of incoming sections and force the output section
5586type then an extra piece of untyped data will be needed:
5587@smallexample
5588 .foo . TYPE = SHT_PROGBITS @{ BYTE(1); *(.bar) @}
5589@end smallexample
5590
c212f39d
FS
5591@item READONLY ( TYPE = @var{type} )
5592This form of the syntax combines the @var{READONLY} type with the
5593type specified by @var{type}.
dcb53d93 5594
252b5132
RH
5595@end table
5596
5597@kindex NOLOAD
5598@cindex prevent unnecessary loading
5599@cindex loading, preventing
5600The linker normally sets the attributes of an output section based on
5601the input sections which map into it. You can override this by using
5602the section type. For example, in the script sample below, the
5603@samp{ROM} section is addressed at memory location @samp{0} and does not
2e76e85a 5604need to be loaded when the program is run.
252b5132
RH
5605@smallexample
5606@group
5607SECTIONS @{
5608 ROM 0 (NOLOAD) : @{ @dots{} @}
5609 @dots{}
5610@}
5611@end group
5612@end smallexample
5613
5614@node Output Section LMA
36f63dca 5615@subsubsection Output Section LMA
562d3460 5616@kindex AT>@var{lma_region}
252b5132
RH
5617@kindex AT(@var{lma})
5618@cindex load address
5619@cindex section load address
5620Every section has a virtual address (VMA) and a load address (LMA); see
ea5cae92
NC
5621@ref{Basic Script Concepts}. The virtual address is specified by the
5622@pxref{Output Section Address} described earlier. The load address is
5623specified by the @code{AT} or @code{AT>} keywords. Specifying a load
5624address is optional.
6bdafbeb 5625
ea5cae92
NC
5626The @code{AT} keyword takes an expression as an argument. This
5627specifies the exact load address of the section. The @code{AT>} keyword
5628takes the name of a memory region as an argument. @xref{MEMORY}. The
5629load address of the section is set to the next free address in the
5630region, aligned to the section's alignment requirements.
dc0b6aa0
AM
5631
5632If neither @code{AT} nor @code{AT>} is specified for an allocatable
ea5cae92
NC
5633section, the linker will use the following heuristic to determine the
5634load address:
5635
5636@itemize @bullet
5637@item
5638If the section has a specific VMA address, then this is used as
5639the LMA address as well.
5640
5641@item
5642If the section is not allocatable then its LMA is set to its VMA.
5643
5644@item
5645Otherwise if a memory region can be found that is compatible
5646with the current section, and this region contains at least one
5647section, then the LMA is set so the difference between the
5648VMA and LMA is the same as the difference between the VMA and LMA of
5649the last section in the located region.
5650
5651@item
5652If no memory regions have been declared then a default region
5653that covers the entire address space is used in the previous step.
5654
5655@item
5656If no suitable region could be found, or there was no previous
5657section then the LMA is set equal to the VMA.
5658@end itemize
252b5132
RH
5659
5660@cindex ROM initialized data
5661@cindex initialized data in ROM
5662This feature is designed to make it easy to build a ROM image. For
5663example, the following linker script creates three output sections: one
5664called @samp{.text}, which starts at @code{0x1000}, one called
5665@samp{.mdata}, which is loaded at the end of the @samp{.text} section
5666even though its VMA is @code{0x2000}, and one called @samp{.bss} to hold
5667uninitialized data at address @code{0x3000}. The symbol @code{_data} is
5668defined with the value @code{0x2000}, which shows that the location
5669counter holds the VMA value, not the LMA value.
5670
5671@smallexample
5672@group
5673SECTIONS
5674 @{
5675 .text 0x1000 : @{ *(.text) _etext = . ; @}
a1ab1d2a 5676 .mdata 0x2000 :
252b5132
RH
5677 AT ( ADDR (.text) + SIZEOF (.text) )
5678 @{ _data = . ; *(.data); _edata = . ; @}
5679 .bss 0x3000 :
5680 @{ _bstart = . ; *(.bss) *(COMMON) ; _bend = . ;@}
5681@}
5682@end group
5683@end smallexample
5684
5685The run-time initialization code for use with a program generated with
5686this linker script would include something like the following, to copy
5687the initialized data from the ROM image to its runtime address. Notice
5688how this code takes advantage of the symbols defined by the linker
5689script.
5690
5691@smallexample
5692@group
5693extern char _etext, _data, _edata, _bstart, _bend;
5694char *src = &_etext;
5695char *dst = &_data;
5696
ea5cae92
NC
5697/* ROM has data at end of text; copy it. */
5698while (dst < &_edata)
252b5132 5699 *dst++ = *src++;
252b5132 5700
ea5cae92 5701/* Zero bss. */
252b5132
RH
5702for (dst = &_bstart; dst< &_bend; dst++)
5703 *dst = 0;
5704@end group
5705@end smallexample
5706
bbf115d3
L
5707@node Forced Output Alignment
5708@subsubsection Forced Output Alignment
5709@kindex ALIGN(@var{section_align})
5710@cindex forcing output section alignment
5711@cindex output section alignment
1eec346e 5712You can increase an output section's alignment by using ALIGN. As an
13075d04
SH
5713alternative you can enforce that the difference between the VMA and LMA remains
5714intact throughout this output section with the ALIGN_WITH_INPUT attribute.
bbf115d3 5715
7e7d5768
AM
5716@node Forced Input Alignment
5717@subsubsection Forced Input Alignment
5718@kindex SUBALIGN(@var{subsection_align})
5719@cindex forcing input section alignment
5720@cindex input section alignment
5721You can force input section alignment within an output section by using
5722SUBALIGN. The value specified overrides any alignment given by input
5723sections, whether larger or smaller.
5724
0c71d759
NC
5725@node Output Section Constraint
5726@subsubsection Output Section Constraint
5727@kindex ONLY_IF_RO
5728@kindex ONLY_IF_RW
5729@cindex constraints on output sections
5730You can specify that an output section should only be created if all
5731of its input sections are read-only or all of its input sections are
5732read-write by using the keyword @code{ONLY_IF_RO} and
5733@code{ONLY_IF_RW} respectively.
5734
252b5132 5735@node Output Section Region
36f63dca 5736@subsubsection Output Section Region
252b5132
RH
5737@kindex >@var{region}
5738@cindex section, assigning to memory region
5739@cindex memory regions and sections
5740You can assign a section to a previously defined region of memory by
5741using @samp{>@var{region}}. @xref{MEMORY}.
5742
5743Here is a simple example:
5744@smallexample
5745@group
5746MEMORY @{ rom : ORIGIN = 0x1000, LENGTH = 0x1000 @}
5747SECTIONS @{ ROM : @{ *(.text) @} >rom @}
5748@end group
5749@end smallexample
5750
5751@node Output Section Phdr
36f63dca 5752@subsubsection Output Section Phdr
252b5132
RH
5753@kindex :@var{phdr}
5754@cindex section, assigning to program header
5755@cindex program headers and sections
5756You can assign a section to a previously defined program segment by
5757using @samp{:@var{phdr}}. @xref{PHDRS}. If a section is assigned to
5758one or more segments, then all subsequent allocated sections will be
5759assigned to those segments as well, unless they use an explicitly
5760@code{:@var{phdr}} modifier. You can use @code{:NONE} to tell the
5761linker to not put the section in any segment at all.
5762
5763Here is a simple example:
5764@smallexample
5765@group
5766PHDRS @{ text PT_LOAD ; @}
5767SECTIONS @{ .text : @{ *(.text) @} :text @}
5768@end group
5769@end smallexample
5770
5771@node Output Section Fill
36f63dca 5772@subsubsection Output Section Fill
252b5132
RH
5773@kindex =@var{fillexp}
5774@cindex section fill pattern
5775@cindex fill pattern, entire section
5776You can set the fill pattern for an entire section by using
5777@samp{=@var{fillexp}}. @var{fillexp} is an expression
5778(@pxref{Expressions}). Any otherwise unspecified regions of memory
5779within the output section (for example, gaps left due to the required
a139d329
AM
5780alignment of input sections) will be filled with the value, repeated as
5781necessary. If the fill expression is a simple hex number, ie. a string
9673c93c 5782of hex digit starting with @samp{0x} and without a trailing @samp{k} or @samp{M}, then
a139d329
AM
5783an arbitrarily long sequence of hex digits can be used to specify the
5784fill pattern; Leading zeros become part of the pattern too. For all
9673c93c 5785other cases, including extra parentheses or a unary @code{+}, the fill
a139d329
AM
5786pattern is the four least significant bytes of the value of the
5787expression. In all cases, the number is big-endian.
252b5132
RH
5788
5789You can also change the fill value with a @code{FILL} command in the
9673c93c 5790output section commands; (@pxref{Output Section Data}).
252b5132
RH
5791
5792Here is a simple example:
5793@smallexample
5794@group
563e308f 5795SECTIONS @{ .text : @{ *(.text) @} =0x90909090 @}
252b5132
RH
5796@end group
5797@end smallexample
5798
5799@node Overlay Description
36f63dca 5800@subsection Overlay Description
252b5132
RH
5801@kindex OVERLAY
5802@cindex overlays
5803An overlay description provides an easy way to describe sections which
5804are to be loaded as part of a single memory image but are to be run at
5805the same memory address. At run time, some sort of overlay manager will
5806copy the overlaid sections in and out of the runtime memory address as
5807required, perhaps by simply manipulating addressing bits. This approach
5808can be useful, for example, when a certain region of memory is faster
5809than another.
5810
5811Overlays are described using the @code{OVERLAY} command. The
5812@code{OVERLAY} command is used within a @code{SECTIONS} command, like an
5813output section description. The full syntax of the @code{OVERLAY}
5814command is as follows:
5815@smallexample
5816@group
5817OVERLAY [@var{start}] : [NOCROSSREFS] [AT ( @var{ldaddr} )]
5818 @{
5819 @var{secname1}
5820 @{
5821 @var{output-section-command}
5822 @var{output-section-command}
5823 @dots{}
5824 @} [:@var{phdr}@dots{}] [=@var{fill}]
5825 @var{secname2}
5826 @{
5827 @var{output-section-command}
5828 @var{output-section-command}
5829 @dots{}
5830 @} [:@var{phdr}@dots{}] [=@var{fill}]
5831 @dots{}
abc9061b 5832 @} [>@var{region}] [:@var{phdr}@dots{}] [=@var{fill}] [,]
252b5132
RH
5833@end group
5834@end smallexample
5835
5836Everything is optional except @code{OVERLAY} (a keyword), and each
5837section must have a name (@var{secname1} and @var{secname2} above). The
5838section definitions within the @code{OVERLAY} construct are identical to
11e7fd74 5839those within the general @code{SECTIONS} construct (@pxref{SECTIONS}),
252b5132
RH
5840except that no addresses and no memory regions may be defined for
5841sections within an @code{OVERLAY}.
5842
abc9061b
CC
5843The comma at the end may be required if a @var{fill} is used and
5844the next @var{sections-command} looks like a continuation of the expression.
5845
252b5132
RH
5846The sections are all defined with the same starting address. The load
5847addresses of the sections are arranged such that they are consecutive in
5848memory starting at the load address used for the @code{OVERLAY} as a
5849whole (as with normal section definitions, the load address is optional,
5850and defaults to the start address; the start address is also optional,
5851and defaults to the current value of the location counter).
5852
56dd11f0
NC
5853If the @code{NOCROSSREFS} keyword is used, and there are any
5854references among the sections, the linker will report an error. Since
5855the sections all run at the same address, it normally does not make
5856sense for one section to refer directly to another.
5857@xref{Miscellaneous Commands, NOCROSSREFS}.
252b5132
RH
5858
5859For each section within the @code{OVERLAY}, the linker automatically
34711ca3 5860provides two symbols. The symbol @code{__load_start_@var{secname}} is
252b5132
RH
5861defined as the starting load address of the section. The symbol
5862@code{__load_stop_@var{secname}} is defined as the final load address of
5863the section. Any characters within @var{secname} which are not legal
5864within C identifiers are removed. C (or assembler) code may use these
5865symbols to move the overlaid sections around as necessary.
5866
5867At the end of the overlay, the value of the location counter is set to
5868the start address of the overlay plus the size of the largest section.
5869
5870Here is an example. Remember that this would appear inside a
5871@code{SECTIONS} construct.
5872@smallexample
5873@group
5874 OVERLAY 0x1000 : AT (0x4000)
5875 @{
5876 .text0 @{ o1/*.o(.text) @}
5877 .text1 @{ o2/*.o(.text) @}
5878 @}
5879@end group
5880@end smallexample
5881@noindent
5882This will define both @samp{.text0} and @samp{.text1} to start at
5883address 0x1000. @samp{.text0} will be loaded at address 0x4000, and
5884@samp{.text1} will be loaded immediately after @samp{.text0}. The
34711ca3 5885following symbols will be defined if referenced: @code{__load_start_text0},
252b5132
RH
5886@code{__load_stop_text0}, @code{__load_start_text1},
5887@code{__load_stop_text1}.
5888
5889C code to copy overlay @code{.text1} into the overlay area might look
5890like the following.
5891
5892@smallexample
5893@group
5894 extern char __load_start_text1, __load_stop_text1;
5895 memcpy ((char *) 0x1000, &__load_start_text1,
5896 &__load_stop_text1 - &__load_start_text1);
5897@end group
5898@end smallexample
5899
5900Note that the @code{OVERLAY} command is just syntactic sugar, since
5901everything it does can be done using the more basic commands. The above
5902example could have been written identically as follows.
5903
5904@smallexample
5905@group
5906 .text0 0x1000 : AT (0x4000) @{ o1/*.o(.text) @}
34711ca3
AM
5907 PROVIDE (__load_start_text0 = LOADADDR (.text0));
5908 PROVIDE (__load_stop_text0 = LOADADDR (.text0) + SIZEOF (.text0));
252b5132 5909 .text1 0x1000 : AT (0x4000 + SIZEOF (.text0)) @{ o2/*.o(.text) @}
34711ca3
AM
5910 PROVIDE (__load_start_text1 = LOADADDR (.text1));
5911 PROVIDE (__load_stop_text1 = LOADADDR (.text1) + SIZEOF (.text1));
252b5132
RH
5912 . = 0x1000 + MAX (SIZEOF (.text0), SIZEOF (.text1));
5913@end group
5914@end smallexample
5915
5916@node MEMORY
36f63dca 5917@section MEMORY Command
252b5132
RH
5918@kindex MEMORY
5919@cindex memory regions
5920@cindex regions of memory
5921@cindex allocating memory
5922@cindex discontinuous memory
5923The linker's default configuration permits allocation of all available
5924memory. You can override this by using the @code{MEMORY} command.
5925
5926The @code{MEMORY} command describes the location and size of blocks of
5927memory in the target. You can use it to describe which memory regions
5928may be used by the linker, and which memory regions it must avoid. You
5929can then assign sections to particular memory regions. The linker will
5930set section addresses based on the memory regions, and will warn about
5931regions that become too full. The linker will not shuffle sections
5932around to fit into the available regions.
5933
127fcdff
AB
5934A linker script may contain many uses of the @code{MEMORY} command,
5935however, all memory blocks defined are treated as if they were
5936specified inside a single @code{MEMORY} command. The syntax for
5937@code{MEMORY} is:
252b5132
RH
5938@smallexample
5939@group
a1ab1d2a 5940MEMORY
252b5132
RH
5941 @{
5942 @var{name} [(@var{attr})] : ORIGIN = @var{origin}, LENGTH = @var{len}
5943 @dots{}
5944 @}
5945@end group
5946@end smallexample
5947
5948The @var{name} is a name used in the linker script to refer to the
5949region. The region name has no meaning outside of the linker script.
5950Region names are stored in a separate name space, and will not conflict
5951with symbol names, file names, or section names. Each memory region
4a93e180
NC
5952must have a distinct name within the @code{MEMORY} command. However you can
5953add later alias names to existing memory regions with the @ref{REGION_ALIAS}
9d5777a3 5954command.
252b5132
RH
5955
5956@cindex memory region attributes
5957The @var{attr} string is an optional list of attributes that specify
5958whether to use a particular memory region for an input section which is
5959not explicitly mapped in the linker script. As described in
5960@ref{SECTIONS}, if you do not specify an output section for some input
5961section, the linker will create an output section with the same name as
5962the input section. If you define region attributes, the linker will use
5963them to select the memory region for the output section that it creates.
5964
5965The @var{attr} string must consist only of the following characters:
5966@table @samp
5967@item R
5968Read-only section
5969@item W
5970Read/write section
5971@item X
5972Executable section
5973@item A
5974Allocatable section
5975@item I
5976Initialized section
5977@item L
5978Same as @samp{I}
5979@item !
c09e9a8c 5980Invert the sense of any of the attributes that follow
252b5132
RH
5981@end table
5982
81c688d5 5983If an unmapped section matches any of the listed attributes other than
252b5132 5984@samp{!}, it will be placed in the memory region. The @samp{!}
81c688d5
NC
5985attribute reverses the test for the characters that follow, so that an
5986unmapped section will be placed in the memory region only if it does
5987not match any of the attributes listed afterwards. Thus an attribute
5988string of @samp{RW!X} will match any unmapped section that has either
5989or both of the @samp{R} and @samp{W} attributes, but only as long as
5990the section does not also have the @samp{X} attribute.
252b5132
RH
5991
5992@kindex ORIGIN =
5993@kindex o =
5994@kindex org =
9cd6d51a
NC
5995The @var{origin} is an numerical expression for the start address of
5996the memory region. The expression must evaluate to a constant and it
5997cannot involve any symbols. The keyword @code{ORIGIN} may be
5998abbreviated to @code{org} or @code{o} (but not, for example,
5999@code{ORG}).
252b5132
RH
6000
6001@kindex LENGTH =
6002@kindex len =
6003@kindex l =
6004The @var{len} is an expression for the size in bytes of the memory
6005region. As with the @var{origin} expression, the expression must
9cd6d51a
NC
6006be numerical only and must evaluate to a constant. The keyword
6007@code{LENGTH} may be abbreviated to @code{len} or @code{l}.
252b5132
RH
6008
6009In the following example, we specify that there are two memory regions
6010available for allocation: one starting at @samp{0} for 256 kilobytes,
6011and the other starting at @samp{0x40000000} for four megabytes. The
6012linker will place into the @samp{rom} memory region every section which
6013is not explicitly mapped into a memory region, and is either read-only
6014or executable. The linker will place other sections which are not
6015explicitly mapped into a memory region into the @samp{ram} memory
6016region.
6017
6018@smallexample
6019@group
a1ab1d2a 6020MEMORY
252b5132
RH
6021 @{
6022 rom (rx) : ORIGIN = 0, LENGTH = 256K
6023 ram (!rx) : org = 0x40000000, l = 4M
6024 @}
6025@end group
6026@end smallexample
6027
6028Once you define a memory region, you can direct the linker to place
6029specific output sections into that memory region by using the
6030@samp{>@var{region}} output section attribute. For example, if you have
6031a memory region named @samp{mem}, you would use @samp{>mem} in the
6032output section definition. @xref{Output Section Region}. If no address
6033was specified for the output section, the linker will set the address to
6034the next available address within the memory region. If the combined
6035output sections directed to a memory region are too large for the
6036region, the linker will issue an error message.
6037
3ec57632 6038It is possible to access the origin and length of a memory in an
c0065db7 6039expression via the @code{ORIGIN(@var{memory})} and
3ec57632
NC
6040@code{LENGTH(@var{memory})} functions:
6041
6042@smallexample
6043@group
c0065db7 6044 _fstack = ORIGIN(ram) + LENGTH(ram) - 4;
3ec57632
NC
6045@end group
6046@end smallexample
6047
252b5132
RH
6048@node PHDRS
6049@section PHDRS Command
6050@kindex PHDRS
6051@cindex program headers
6052@cindex ELF program headers
6053@cindex program segments
6054@cindex segments, ELF
6055The ELF object file format uses @dfn{program headers}, also knows as
6056@dfn{segments}. The program headers describe how the program should be
6057loaded into memory. You can print them out by using the @code{objdump}
6058program with the @samp{-p} option.
6059
6060When you run an ELF program on a native ELF system, the system loader
6061reads the program headers in order to figure out how to load the
6062program. This will only work if the program headers are set correctly.
6063This manual does not describe the details of how the system loader
6064interprets program headers; for more information, see the ELF ABI.
6065
6066The linker will create reasonable program headers by default. However,
6067in some cases, you may need to specify the program headers more
6068precisely. You may use the @code{PHDRS} command for this purpose. When
6069the linker sees the @code{PHDRS} command in the linker script, it will
6070not create any program headers other than the ones specified.
6071
6072The linker only pays attention to the @code{PHDRS} command when
6073generating an ELF output file. In other cases, the linker will simply
6074ignore @code{PHDRS}.
6075
6076This is the syntax of the @code{PHDRS} command. The words @code{PHDRS},
6077@code{FILEHDR}, @code{AT}, and @code{FLAGS} are keywords.
6078
6079@smallexample
6080@group
6081PHDRS
6082@{
6083 @var{name} @var{type} [ FILEHDR ] [ PHDRS ] [ AT ( @var{address} ) ]
6084 [ FLAGS ( @var{flags} ) ] ;
6085@}
6086@end group
6087@end smallexample
6088
6089The @var{name} is used only for reference in the @code{SECTIONS} command
6090of the linker script. It is not put into the output file. Program
6091header names are stored in a separate name space, and will not conflict
6092with symbol names, file names, or section names. Each program header
5c1a3f0f
NS
6093must have a distinct name. The headers are processed in order and it
6094is usual for them to map to sections in ascending load address order.
252b5132
RH
6095
6096Certain program header types describe segments of memory which the
6097system loader will load from the file. In the linker script, you
6098specify the contents of these segments by placing allocatable output
6099sections in the segments. You use the @samp{:@var{phdr}} output section
6100attribute to place a section in a particular segment. @xref{Output
6101Section Phdr}.
6102
6103It is normal to put certain sections in more than one segment. This
6104merely implies that one segment of memory contains another. You may
6105repeat @samp{:@var{phdr}}, using it once for each segment which should
6106contain the section.
6107
6108If you place a section in one or more segments using @samp{:@var{phdr}},
6109then the linker will place all subsequent allocatable sections which do
6110not specify @samp{:@var{phdr}} in the same segments. This is for
6111convenience, since generally a whole set of contiguous sections will be
6112placed in a single segment. You can use @code{:NONE} to override the
6113default segment and tell the linker to not put the section in any
6114segment at all.
6115
6116@kindex FILEHDR
6117@kindex PHDRS
5c1a3f0f 6118You may use the @code{FILEHDR} and @code{PHDRS} keywords after
252b5132
RH
6119the program header type to further describe the contents of the segment.
6120The @code{FILEHDR} keyword means that the segment should include the ELF
6121file header. The @code{PHDRS} keyword means that the segment should
5c1a3f0f 6122include the ELF program headers themselves. If applied to a loadable
4100cea3
AM
6123segment (@code{PT_LOAD}), all prior loadable segments must have one of
6124these keywords.
252b5132
RH
6125
6126The @var{type} may be one of the following. The numbers indicate the
6127value of the keyword.
6128
6129@table @asis
6130@item @code{PT_NULL} (0)
6131Indicates an unused program header.
6132
6133@item @code{PT_LOAD} (1)
6134Indicates that this program header describes a segment to be loaded from
6135the file.
6136
6137@item @code{PT_DYNAMIC} (2)
6138Indicates a segment where dynamic linking information can be found.
6139
6140@item @code{PT_INTERP} (3)
6141Indicates a segment where the name of the program interpreter may be
6142found.
6143
6144@item @code{PT_NOTE} (4)
6145Indicates a segment holding note information.
6146
6147@item @code{PT_SHLIB} (5)
6148A reserved program header type, defined but not specified by the ELF
6149ABI.
6150
6151@item @code{PT_PHDR} (6)
6152Indicates a segment where the program headers may be found.
6153
1a9ccd70
NC
6154@item @code{PT_TLS} (7)
6155Indicates a segment containing thread local storage.
6156
252b5132
RH
6157@item @var{expression}
6158An expression giving the numeric type of the program header. This may
6159be used for types not defined above.
6160@end table
6161
6162You can specify that a segment should be loaded at a particular address
6163in memory by using an @code{AT} expression. This is identical to the
6164@code{AT} command used as an output section attribute (@pxref{Output
6165Section LMA}). The @code{AT} command for a program header overrides the
6166output section attribute.
6167
6168The linker will normally set the segment flags based on the sections
6169which comprise the segment. You may use the @code{FLAGS} keyword to
6170explicitly specify the segment flags. The value of @var{flags} must be
6171an integer. It is used to set the @code{p_flags} field of the program
6172header.
6173
6174Here is an example of @code{PHDRS}. This shows a typical set of program
6175headers used on a native ELF system.
6176
6177@example
6178@group
6179PHDRS
6180@{
6181 headers PT_PHDR PHDRS ;
6182 interp PT_INTERP ;
6183 text PT_LOAD FILEHDR PHDRS ;
6184 data PT_LOAD ;
6185 dynamic PT_DYNAMIC ;
6186@}
6187
6188SECTIONS
6189@{
6190 . = SIZEOF_HEADERS;
6191 .interp : @{ *(.interp) @} :text :interp
6192 .text : @{ *(.text) @} :text
6193 .rodata : @{ *(.rodata) @} /* defaults to :text */
6194 @dots{}
6195 . = . + 0x1000; /* move to a new page in memory */
6196 .data : @{ *(.data) @} :data
6197 .dynamic : @{ *(.dynamic) @} :data :dynamic
6198 @dots{}
6199@}
6200@end group
6201@end example
6202
6203@node VERSION
6204@section VERSION Command
6205@kindex VERSION @{script text@}
6206@cindex symbol versions
6207@cindex version script
6208@cindex versions of symbols
6209The linker supports symbol versions when using ELF. Symbol versions are
6210only useful when using shared libraries. The dynamic linker can use
6211symbol versions to select a specific version of a function when it runs
6212a program that may have been linked against an earlier version of the
6213shared library.
6214
6215You can include a version script directly in the main linker script, or
6216you can supply the version script as an implicit linker script. You can
6217also use the @samp{--version-script} linker option.
6218
6219The syntax of the @code{VERSION} command is simply
6220@smallexample
6221VERSION @{ version-script-commands @}
6222@end smallexample
6223
6224The format of the version script commands is identical to that used by
6225Sun's linker in Solaris 2.5. The version script defines a tree of
6226version nodes. You specify the node names and interdependencies in the
6227version script. You can specify which symbols are bound to which
6228version nodes, and you can reduce a specified set of symbols to local
6229scope so that they are not globally visible outside of the shared
6230library.
6231
6232The easiest way to demonstrate the version script language is with a few
6233examples.
6234
6235@smallexample
6236VERS_1.1 @{
6237 global:
6238 foo1;
6239 local:
a1ab1d2a
UD
6240 old*;
6241 original*;
6242 new*;
252b5132
RH
6243@};
6244
6245VERS_1.2 @{
6246 foo2;
6247@} VERS_1.1;
6248
6249VERS_2.0 @{
6250 bar1; bar2;
c0065db7 6251 extern "C++" @{
86043bbb 6252 ns::*;
bb1515f2
MF
6253 "f(int, double)";
6254 @};
252b5132
RH
6255@} VERS_1.2;
6256@end smallexample
6257
6258This example version script defines three version nodes. The first
6259version node defined is @samp{VERS_1.1}; it has no other dependencies.
6260The script binds the symbol @samp{foo1} to @samp{VERS_1.1}. It reduces
6261a number of symbols to local scope so that they are not visible outside
313e35ee
AM
6262of the shared library; this is done using wildcard patterns, so that any
6263symbol whose name begins with @samp{old}, @samp{original}, or @samp{new}
6264is matched. The wildcard patterns available are the same as those used
6265in the shell when matching filenames (also known as ``globbing'').
86043bbb
MM
6266However, if you specify the symbol name inside double quotes, then the
6267name is treated as literal, rather than as a glob pattern.
252b5132
RH
6268
6269Next, the version script defines node @samp{VERS_1.2}. This node
6270depends upon @samp{VERS_1.1}. The script binds the symbol @samp{foo2}
6271to the version node @samp{VERS_1.2}.
6272
6273Finally, the version script defines node @samp{VERS_2.0}. This node
6274depends upon @samp{VERS_1.2}. The scripts binds the symbols @samp{bar1}
6275and @samp{bar2} are bound to the version node @samp{VERS_2.0}.
6276
6277When the linker finds a symbol defined in a library which is not
6278specifically bound to a version node, it will effectively bind it to an
6279unspecified base version of the library. You can bind all otherwise
a981ed6f 6280unspecified symbols to a given version node by using @samp{global: *;}
ae5a3597
AM
6281somewhere in the version script. Note that it's slightly crazy to use
6282wildcards in a global spec except on the last version node. Global
6283wildcards elsewhere run the risk of accidentally adding symbols to the
6284set exported for an old version. That's wrong since older versions
6285ought to have a fixed set of symbols.
252b5132
RH
6286
6287The names of the version nodes have no specific meaning other than what
6288they might suggest to the person reading them. The @samp{2.0} version
6289could just as well have appeared in between @samp{1.1} and @samp{1.2}.
6290However, this would be a confusing way to write a version script.
6291
0f6bf451 6292Node name can be omitted, provided it is the only version node
6b9b879a
JJ
6293in the version script. Such version script doesn't assign any versions to
6294symbols, only selects which symbols will be globally visible out and which
6295won't.
6296
6297@smallexample
7c9c73be 6298@{ global: foo; bar; local: *; @};
9d201f2f 6299@end smallexample
6b9b879a 6300
252b5132
RH
6301When you link an application against a shared library that has versioned
6302symbols, the application itself knows which version of each symbol it
6303requires, and it also knows which version nodes it needs from each
6304shared library it is linked against. Thus at runtime, the dynamic
6305loader can make a quick check to make sure that the libraries you have
6306linked against do in fact supply all of the version nodes that the
6307application will need to resolve all of the dynamic symbols. In this
6308way it is possible for the dynamic linker to know with certainty that
6309all external symbols that it needs will be resolvable without having to
6310search for each symbol reference.
6311
6312The symbol versioning is in effect a much more sophisticated way of
6313doing minor version checking that SunOS does. The fundamental problem
6314that is being addressed here is that typically references to external
6315functions are bound on an as-needed basis, and are not all bound when
6316the application starts up. If a shared library is out of date, a
6317required interface may be missing; when the application tries to use
6318that interface, it may suddenly and unexpectedly fail. With symbol
6319versioning, the user will get a warning when they start their program if
6320the libraries being used with the application are too old.
6321
6322There are several GNU extensions to Sun's versioning approach. The
6323first of these is the ability to bind a symbol to a version node in the
6324source file where the symbol is defined instead of in the versioning
6325script. This was done mainly to reduce the burden on the library
6326maintainer. You can do this by putting something like:
6327@smallexample
6328__asm__(".symver original_foo,foo@@VERS_1.1");
6329@end smallexample
6330@noindent
6331in the C source file. This renames the function @samp{original_foo} to
6332be an alias for @samp{foo} bound to the version node @samp{VERS_1.1}.
6333The @samp{local:} directive can be used to prevent the symbol
96a94295
L
6334@samp{original_foo} from being exported. A @samp{.symver} directive
6335takes precedence over a version script.
252b5132
RH
6336
6337The second GNU extension is to allow multiple versions of the same
6338function to appear in a given shared library. In this way you can make
6339an incompatible change to an interface without increasing the major
6340version number of the shared library, while still allowing applications
6341linked against the old interface to continue to function.
6342
6343To do this, you must use multiple @samp{.symver} directives in the
6344source file. Here is an example:
6345
6346@smallexample
6347__asm__(".symver original_foo,foo@@");
6348__asm__(".symver old_foo,foo@@VERS_1.1");
6349__asm__(".symver old_foo1,foo@@VERS_1.2");
6350__asm__(".symver new_foo,foo@@@@VERS_2.0");
6351@end smallexample
6352
6353In this example, @samp{foo@@} represents the symbol @samp{foo} bound to the
6354unspecified base version of the symbol. The source file that contains this
6355example would define 4 C functions: @samp{original_foo}, @samp{old_foo},
6356@samp{old_foo1}, and @samp{new_foo}.
6357
6358When you have multiple definitions of a given symbol, there needs to be
6359some way to specify a default version to which external references to
6360this symbol will be bound. You can do this with the
6361@samp{foo@@@@VERS_2.0} type of @samp{.symver} directive. You can only
6362declare one version of a symbol as the default in this manner; otherwise
6363you would effectively have multiple definitions of the same symbol.
6364
6365If you wish to bind a reference to a specific version of the symbol
6366within the shared library, you can use the aliases of convenience
36f63dca 6367(i.e., @samp{old_foo}), or you can use the @samp{.symver} directive to
252b5132
RH
6368specifically bind to an external version of the function in question.
6369
cb840a31
L
6370You can also specify the language in the version script:
6371
6372@smallexample
6373VERSION extern "lang" @{ version-script-commands @}
6374@end smallexample
6375
c0065db7 6376The supported @samp{lang}s are @samp{C}, @samp{C++}, and @samp{Java}.
cb840a31
L
6377The linker will iterate over the list of symbols at the link time and
6378demangle them according to @samp{lang} before matching them to the
bb1515f2
MF
6379patterns specified in @samp{version-script-commands}. The default
6380@samp{lang} is @samp{C}.
cb840a31 6381
86043bbb
MM
6382Demangled names may contains spaces and other special characters. As
6383described above, you can use a glob pattern to match demangled names,
6384or you can use a double-quoted string to match the string exactly. In
6385the latter case, be aware that minor differences (such as differing
6386whitespace) between the version script and the demangler output will
6387cause a mismatch. As the exact string generated by the demangler
6388might change in the future, even if the mangled name does not, you
6389should check that all of your version directives are behaving as you
6390expect when you upgrade.
6391
252b5132
RH
6392@node Expressions
6393@section Expressions in Linker Scripts
6394@cindex expressions
6395@cindex arithmetic
6396The syntax for expressions in the linker script language is identical to
fb0afe4c
AM
6397that of C expressions, except that whitespace is required in some
6398places to resolve syntactic ambiguities. All expressions are
6399evaluated as integers. All expressions are evaluated in the same
6400size, which is 32 bits if both the host and target are 32 bits, and is
6401otherwise 64 bits.
252b5132
RH
6402
6403You can use and set symbol values in expressions.
6404
6405The linker defines several special purpose builtin functions for use in
6406expressions.
6407
6408@menu
6409* Constants:: Constants
0c71d759 6410* Symbolic Constants:: Symbolic constants
252b5132 6411* Symbols:: Symbol Names
ecca9871 6412* Orphan Sections:: Orphan Sections
252b5132
RH
6413* Location Counter:: The Location Counter
6414* Operators:: Operators
6415* Evaluation:: Evaluation
6416* Expression Section:: The Section of an Expression
6417* Builtin Functions:: Builtin Functions
6418@end menu
6419
6420@node Constants
6421@subsection Constants
6422@cindex integer notation
6423@cindex constants in linker scripts
6424All constants are integers.
6425
6426As in C, the linker considers an integer beginning with @samp{0} to be
6427octal, and an integer beginning with @samp{0x} or @samp{0X} to be
8a308ae8 6428hexadecimal. Alternatively the linker accepts suffixes of @samp{h} or
11e7fd74 6429@samp{H} for hexadecimal, @samp{o} or @samp{O} for octal, @samp{b} or
8a308ae8
NC
6430@samp{B} for binary and @samp{d} or @samp{D} for decimal. Any integer
6431value without a prefix or a suffix is considered to be decimal.
252b5132
RH
6432
6433@cindex scaled integers
6434@cindex K and M integer suffixes
6435@cindex M and K integer suffixes
6436@cindex suffixes for integers
6437@cindex integer suffixes
6438In addition, you can use the suffixes @code{K} and @code{M} to scale a
6439constant by
6440@c TEXI2ROFF-KILL
36f63dca 6441@ifnottex
252b5132
RH
6442@c END TEXI2ROFF-KILL
6443@code{1024} or @code{1024*1024}
6444@c TEXI2ROFF-KILL
36f63dca 6445@end ifnottex
252b5132
RH
6446@tex
6447${\rm 1024}$ or ${\rm 1024}^2$
6448@end tex
6449@c END TEXI2ROFF-KILL
8a308ae8
NC
6450respectively. For example, the following
6451all refer to the same quantity:
6452
252b5132 6453@smallexample
36f63dca
NC
6454_fourk_1 = 4K;
6455_fourk_2 = 4096;
6456_fourk_3 = 0x1000;
8a308ae8 6457_fourk_4 = 10000o;
252b5132
RH
6458@end smallexample
6459
8a308ae8
NC
6460Note - the @code{K} and @code{M} suffixes cannot be used in
6461conjunction with the base suffixes mentioned above.
6462
0c71d759
NC
6463@node Symbolic Constants
6464@subsection Symbolic Constants
6465@cindex symbolic constants
6466@kindex CONSTANT
a094d01f 6467It is possible to refer to target-specific constants via the use of
0c71d759
NC
6468the @code{CONSTANT(@var{name})} operator, where @var{name} is one of:
6469
6470@table @code
6471@item MAXPAGESIZE
6472@kindex MAXPAGESIZE
6473The target's maximum page size.
6474
6475@item COMMONPAGESIZE
6476@kindex COMMONPAGESIZE
6477The target's default page size.
6478@end table
6479
6480So for example:
6481
6482@smallexample
9d5777a3 6483 .text ALIGN (CONSTANT (MAXPAGESIZE)) : @{ *(.text) @}
0c71d759
NC
6484@end smallexample
6485
6486will create a text section aligned to the largest page boundary
6487supported by the target.
6488
252b5132
RH
6489@node Symbols
6490@subsection Symbol Names
6491@cindex symbol names
6492@cindex names
6493@cindex quoted symbol names
6494@kindex "
6495Unless quoted, symbol names start with a letter, underscore, or period
6496and may include letters, digits, underscores, periods, and hyphens.
6497Unquoted symbol names must not conflict with any keywords. You can
6498specify a symbol which contains odd characters or has the same name as a
6499keyword by surrounding the symbol name in double quotes:
6500@smallexample
36f63dca
NC
6501"SECTION" = 9;
6502"with a space" = "also with a space" + 10;
252b5132
RH
6503@end smallexample
6504
6505Since symbols can contain many non-alphabetic characters, it is safest
6506to delimit symbols with spaces. For example, @samp{A-B} is one symbol,
6507whereas @samp{A - B} is an expression involving subtraction.
6508
ecca9871
L
6509@node Orphan Sections
6510@subsection Orphan Sections
6511@cindex orphan
6512Orphan sections are sections present in the input files which
6513are not explicitly placed into the output file by the linker
6514script. The linker will still copy these sections into the
a87ded7b
AB
6515output file by either finding, or creating a suitable output section
6516in which to place the orphaned input section.
6517
6518If the name of an orphaned input section exactly matches the name of
6519an existing output section, then the orphaned input section will be
6520placed at the end of that output section.
6521
6522If there is no output section with a matching name then new output
6523sections will be created. Each new output section will have the same
6524name as the orphan section placed within it. If there are multiple
6525orphan sections with the same name, these will all be combined into
6526one new output section.
6527
6528If new output sections are created to hold orphaned input sections,
6529then the linker must decide where to place these new output sections
e299b355
AM
6530in relation to existing output sections. On most modern targets, the
6531linker attempts to place orphan sections after sections of the same
6532attribute, such as code vs data, loadable vs non-loadable, etc. If no
6533sections with matching attributes are found, or your target lacks this
6534support, the orphan section is placed at the end of the file.
ecca9871 6535
a05a5b64
TP
6536The command-line options @samp{--orphan-handling} and @samp{--unique}
6537(@pxref{Options,,Command-line Options}) can be used to control which
c005eb9e
AB
6538output sections an orphan is placed in.
6539
252b5132
RH
6540@node Location Counter
6541@subsection The Location Counter
6542@kindex .
6543@cindex dot
6544@cindex location counter
6545@cindex current output location
6546The special linker variable @dfn{dot} @samp{.} always contains the
6547current output location counter. Since the @code{.} always refers to a
6548location in an output section, it may only appear in an expression
6549within a @code{SECTIONS} command. The @code{.} symbol may appear
6550anywhere that an ordinary symbol is allowed in an expression.
6551
6552@cindex holes
6553Assigning a value to @code{.} will cause the location counter to be
6554moved. This may be used to create holes in the output section. The
dc0b6aa0
AM
6555location counter may not be moved backwards inside an output section,
6556and may not be moved backwards outside of an output section if so
6557doing creates areas with overlapping LMAs.
252b5132
RH
6558
6559@smallexample
6560SECTIONS
6561@{
6562 output :
6563 @{
6564 file1(.text)
6565 . = . + 1000;
6566 file2(.text)
6567 . += 1000;
6568 file3(.text)
563e308f 6569 @} = 0x12345678;
252b5132
RH
6570@}
6571@end smallexample
6572@noindent
6573In the previous example, the @samp{.text} section from @file{file1} is
6574located at the beginning of the output section @samp{output}. It is
6575followed by a 1000 byte gap. Then the @samp{.text} section from
6576@file{file2} appears, also with a 1000 byte gap following before the
563e308f 6577@samp{.text} section from @file{file3}. The notation @samp{= 0x12345678}
252b5132
RH
6578specifies what data to write in the gaps (@pxref{Output Section Fill}).
6579
5c6bbab8
NC
6580@cindex dot inside sections
6581Note: @code{.} actually refers to the byte offset from the start of the
6582current containing object. Normally this is the @code{SECTIONS}
69da35b5 6583statement, whose start address is 0, hence @code{.} can be used as an
5c6bbab8
NC
6584absolute address. If @code{.} is used inside a section description
6585however, it refers to the byte offset from the start of that section,
6586not an absolute address. Thus in a script like this:
6587
6588@smallexample
6589SECTIONS
6590@{
6591 . = 0x100
6592 .text: @{
6593 *(.text)
6594 . = 0x200
6595 @}
6596 . = 0x500
6597 .data: @{
6598 *(.data)
6599 . += 0x600
6600 @}
6601@}
6602@end smallexample
6603
6604The @samp{.text} section will be assigned a starting address of 0x100
6605and a size of exactly 0x200 bytes, even if there is not enough data in
6606the @samp{.text} input sections to fill this area. (If there is too
6607much data, an error will be produced because this would be an attempt to
6608move @code{.} backwards). The @samp{.data} section will start at 0x500
6609and it will have an extra 0x600 bytes worth of space after the end of
6610the values from the @samp{.data} input sections and before the end of
6611the @samp{.data} output section itself.
6612
b5666f2f
AM
6613@cindex dot outside sections
6614Setting symbols to the value of the location counter outside of an
6615output section statement can result in unexpected values if the linker
6616needs to place orphan sections. For example, given the following:
6617
6618@smallexample
6619SECTIONS
6620@{
6621 start_of_text = . ;
6622 .text: @{ *(.text) @}
6623 end_of_text = . ;
6624
6625 start_of_data = . ;
6626 .data: @{ *(.data) @}
6627 end_of_data = . ;
6628@}
6629@end smallexample
6630
6631If the linker needs to place some input section, e.g. @code{.rodata},
6632not mentioned in the script, it might choose to place that section
6633between @code{.text} and @code{.data}. You might think the linker
6634should place @code{.rodata} on the blank line in the above script, but
6635blank lines are of no particular significance to the linker. As well,
6636the linker doesn't associate the above symbol names with their
6637sections. Instead, it assumes that all assignments or other
6638statements belong to the previous output section, except for the
6639special case of an assignment to @code{.}. I.e., the linker will
6640place the orphan @code{.rodata} section as if the script was written
6641as follows:
6642
6643@smallexample
6644SECTIONS
6645@{
6646 start_of_text = . ;
6647 .text: @{ *(.text) @}
6648 end_of_text = . ;
6649
6650 start_of_data = . ;
6651 .rodata: @{ *(.rodata) @}
6652 .data: @{ *(.data) @}
6653 end_of_data = . ;
6654@}
6655@end smallexample
6656
6657This may or may not be the script author's intention for the value of
6658@code{start_of_data}. One way to influence the orphan section
6659placement is to assign the location counter to itself, as the linker
6660assumes that an assignment to @code{.} is setting the start address of
6661a following output section and thus should be grouped with that
6662section. So you could write:
6663
6664@smallexample
6665SECTIONS
6666@{
6667 start_of_text = . ;
6668 .text: @{ *(.text) @}
6669 end_of_text = . ;
6670
6671 . = . ;
6672 start_of_data = . ;
6673 .data: @{ *(.data) @}
6674 end_of_data = . ;
6675@}
6676@end smallexample
6677
6678Now, the orphan @code{.rodata} section will be placed between
6679@code{end_of_text} and @code{start_of_data}.
6680
252b5132
RH
6681@need 2000
6682@node Operators
6683@subsection Operators
6684@cindex operators for arithmetic
6685@cindex arithmetic operators
6686@cindex precedence in expressions
6687The linker recognizes the standard C set of arithmetic operators, with
6688the standard bindings and precedence levels:
6689@c TEXI2ROFF-KILL
36f63dca 6690@ifnottex
252b5132
RH
6691@c END TEXI2ROFF-KILL
6692@smallexample
6693precedence associativity Operators Notes
6694(highest)
66951 left ! - ~ (1)
66962 left * / %
66973 left + -
66984 left >> <<
66995 left == != > < <= >=
67006 left &
67017 left |
67028 left &&
67039 left ||
670410 right ? :
670511 right &= += -= *= /= (2)
6706(lowest)
6707@end smallexample
6708Notes:
a1ab1d2a 6709(1) Prefix operators
252b5132
RH
6710(2) @xref{Assignments}.
6711@c TEXI2ROFF-KILL
36f63dca 6712@end ifnottex
252b5132
RH
6713@tex
6714\vskip \baselineskip
6715%"lispnarrowing" is the extra indent used generally for smallexample
6716\hskip\lispnarrowing\vbox{\offinterlineskip
6717\hrule
6718\halign
6719{\vrule#&\strut\hfil\ #\ \hfil&\vrule#&\strut\hfil\ #\ \hfil&\vrule#&\strut\hfil\ {\tt #}\ \hfil&\vrule#\cr
6720height2pt&\omit&&\omit&&\omit&\cr
6721&Precedence&& Associativity &&{\rm Operators}&\cr
6722height2pt&\omit&&\omit&&\omit&\cr
6723\noalign{\hrule}
6724height2pt&\omit&&\omit&&\omit&\cr
6725&highest&&&&&\cr
6726% '176 is tilde, '~' in tt font
a1ab1d2a 6727&1&&left&&\qquad- \char'176\ !\qquad\dag&\cr
252b5132
RH
6728&2&&left&&* / \%&\cr
6729&3&&left&&+ -&\cr
6730&4&&left&&>> <<&\cr
6731&5&&left&&== != > < <= >=&\cr
6732&6&&left&&\&&\cr
6733&7&&left&&|&\cr
6734&8&&left&&{\&\&}&\cr
6735&9&&left&&||&\cr
6736&10&&right&&? :&\cr
6737&11&&right&&\qquad\&= += -= *= /=\qquad\ddag&\cr
6738&lowest&&&&&\cr
6739height2pt&\omit&&\omit&&\omit&\cr}
6740\hrule}
6741@end tex
6742@iftex
6743{
6744@obeylines@parskip=0pt@parindent=0pt
6745@dag@quad Prefix operators.
6746@ddag@quad @xref{Assignments}.
6747}
6748@end iftex
6749@c END TEXI2ROFF-KILL
6750
6751@node Evaluation
6752@subsection Evaluation
6753@cindex lazy evaluation
6754@cindex expression evaluation order
6755The linker evaluates expressions lazily. It only computes the value of
6756an expression when absolutely necessary.
6757
6758The linker needs some information, such as the value of the start
6759address of the first section, and the origins and lengths of memory
6760regions, in order to do any linking at all. These values are computed
6761as soon as possible when the linker reads in the linker script.
6762
6763However, other values (such as symbol values) are not known or needed
6764until after storage allocation. Such values are evaluated later, when
6765other information (such as the sizes of output sections) is available
6766for use in the symbol assignment expression.
6767
6768The sizes of sections cannot be known until after allocation, so
6769assignments dependent upon these are not performed until after
6770allocation.
6771
6772Some expressions, such as those depending upon the location counter
6773@samp{.}, must be evaluated during section allocation.
6774
6775If the result of an expression is required, but the value is not
6776available, then an error results. For example, a script like the
6777following
6778@smallexample
6779@group
6780SECTIONS
6781 @{
a1ab1d2a 6782 .text 9+this_isnt_constant :
252b5132
RH
6783 @{ *(.text) @}
6784 @}
6785@end group
6786@end smallexample
6787@noindent
6788will cause the error message @samp{non constant expression for initial
6789address}.
6790
6791@node Expression Section
6792@subsection The Section of an Expression
6793@cindex expression sections
6794@cindex absolute expressions
6795@cindex relative expressions
6796@cindex absolute and relocatable symbols
6797@cindex relocatable and absolute symbols
6798@cindex symbols, relocatable and absolute
7542af2a
AM
6799Addresses and symbols may be section relative, or absolute. A section
6800relative symbol is relocatable. If you request relocatable output
6801using the @samp{-r} option, a further link operation may change the
6802value of a section relative symbol. On the other hand, an absolute
6803symbol will retain the same value throughout any further link
6804operations.
6805
abf4be64
AM
6806Some terms in linker expressions are addresses. This is true of
6807section relative symbols and for builtin functions that return an
6808address, such as @code{ADDR}, @code{LOADADDR}, @code{ORIGIN} and
6809@code{SEGMENT_START}. Other terms are simply numbers, or are builtin
6810functions that return a non-address value, such as @code{LENGTH}.
01554a74
AM
6811One complication is that unless you set @code{LD_FEATURE ("SANE_EXPR")}
6812(@pxref{Miscellaneous Commands}), numbers and absolute symbols are treated
5c3049d2
AM
6813differently depending on their location, for compatibility with older
6814versions of @code{ld}. Expressions appearing outside an output
6815section definition treat all numbers as absolute addresses.
6816Expressions appearing inside an output section definition treat
01554a74
AM
6817absolute symbols as numbers. If @code{LD_FEATURE ("SANE_EXPR")} is
6818given, then absolute symbols and numbers are simply treated as numbers
6819everywhere.
5c3049d2
AM
6820
6821In the following simple example,
252b5132 6822
7542af2a
AM
6823@smallexample
6824@group
6825SECTIONS
6826 @{
6827 . = 0x100;
6828 __executable_start = 0x100;
6829 .data :
6830 @{
6831 . = 0x10;
6832 __data_start = 0x10;
6833 *(.data)
6834 @}
6835 @dots{}
6836 @}
6837@end group
6838@end smallexample
252b5132 6839
7542af2a
AM
6840both @code{.} and @code{__executable_start} are set to the absolute
6841address 0x100 in the first two assignments, then both @code{.} and
6842@code{__data_start} are set to 0x10 relative to the @code{.data}
6843section in the second two assignments.
252b5132 6844
5c3049d2
AM
6845For expressions involving numbers, relative addresses and absolute
6846addresses, ld follows these rules to evaluate terms:
7542af2a
AM
6847
6848@itemize @bullet
6849@item
c05f749e
AM
6850Unary operations on an absolute address or number, and binary
6851operations on two absolute addresses or two numbers, or between one
6852absolute address and a number, apply the operator to the value(s).
6853@item
7542af2a
AM
6854Unary operations on a relative address, and binary operations on two
6855relative addresses in the same section or between one relative address
6856and a number, apply the operator to the offset part of the address(es).
6857@item
c05f749e
AM
6858Other binary operations, that is, between two relative addresses not
6859in the same section, or between a relative address and an absolute
6860address, first convert any non-absolute term to an absolute address
6861before applying the operator.
7542af2a
AM
6862@end itemize
6863
6864The result section of each sub-expression is as follows:
6865
6866@itemize @bullet
6867@item
6868An operation involving only numbers results in a number.
6869@item
6870The result of comparisons, @samp{&&} and @samp{||} is also a number.
6871@item
9bc8bb33 6872The result of other binary arithmetic and logical operations on two
11e7fd74 6873relative addresses in the same section or two absolute addresses
94b41882
AM
6874(after above conversions) is also a number when
6875@code{LD_FEATURE ("SANE_EXPR")} or inside an output section definition
6876but an absolute address otherwise.
9bc8bb33
AM
6877@item
6878The result of other operations on relative addresses or one
6879relative address and a number, is a relative address in the same
6880section as the relative operand(s).
7542af2a
AM
6881@item
6882The result of other operations on absolute addresses (after above
6883conversions) is an absolute address.
6884@end itemize
252b5132
RH
6885
6886You can use the builtin function @code{ABSOLUTE} to force an expression
6887to be absolute when it would otherwise be relative. For example, to
6888create an absolute symbol set to the address of the end of the output
6889section @samp{.data}:
6890@smallexample
6891SECTIONS
6892 @{
6893 .data : @{ *(.data) _edata = ABSOLUTE(.); @}
6894 @}
6895@end smallexample
6896@noindent
6897If @samp{ABSOLUTE} were not used, @samp{_edata} would be relative to the
6898@samp{.data} section.
6899
7542af2a
AM
6900Using @code{LOADADDR} also forces an expression absolute, since this
6901particular builtin function returns an absolute address.
6902
252b5132
RH
6903@node Builtin Functions
6904@subsection Builtin Functions
6905@cindex functions in expressions
6906The linker script language includes a number of builtin functions for
6907use in linker script expressions.
6908
6909@table @code
6910@item ABSOLUTE(@var{exp})
6911@kindex ABSOLUTE(@var{exp})
6912@cindex expression, absolute
6913Return the absolute (non-relocatable, as opposed to non-negative) value
6914of the expression @var{exp}. Primarily useful to assign an absolute
6915value to a symbol within a section definition, where symbol values are
6916normally section relative. @xref{Expression Section}.
6917
6918@item ADDR(@var{section})
6919@kindex ADDR(@var{section})
6920@cindex section address in expression
7542af2a 6921Return the address (VMA) of the named @var{section}. Your
252b5132 6922script must previously have defined the location of that section. In
7542af2a
AM
6923the following example, @code{start_of_output_1}, @code{symbol_1} and
6924@code{symbol_2} are assigned equivalent values, except that
6925@code{symbol_1} will be relative to the @code{.output1} section while
6926the other two will be absolute:
252b5132
RH
6927@smallexample
6928@group
6929SECTIONS @{ @dots{}
6930 .output1 :
a1ab1d2a 6931 @{
252b5132
RH
6932 start_of_output_1 = ABSOLUTE(.);
6933 @dots{}
6934 @}
6935 .output :
6936 @{
6937 symbol_1 = ADDR(.output1);
6938 symbol_2 = start_of_output_1;
6939 @}
6940@dots{} @}
6941@end group
6942@end smallexample
6943
876f4090
NS
6944@item ALIGN(@var{align})
6945@itemx ALIGN(@var{exp},@var{align})
6946@kindex ALIGN(@var{align})
6947@kindex ALIGN(@var{exp},@var{align})
252b5132
RH
6948@cindex round up location counter
6949@cindex align location counter
876f4090
NS
6950@cindex round up expression
6951@cindex align expression
6952Return the location counter (@code{.}) or arbitrary expression aligned
6953to the next @var{align} boundary. The single operand @code{ALIGN}
6954doesn't change the value of the location counter---it just does
6955arithmetic on it. The two operand @code{ALIGN} allows an arbitrary
6956expression to be aligned upwards (@code{ALIGN(@var{align})} is
e0a3af22 6957equivalent to @code{ALIGN(ABSOLUTE(.), @var{align})}).
876f4090
NS
6958
6959Here is an example which aligns the output @code{.data} section to the
6960next @code{0x2000} byte boundary after the preceding section and sets a
6961variable within the section to the next @code{0x8000} boundary after the
6962input sections:
252b5132
RH
6963@smallexample
6964@group
6965SECTIONS @{ @dots{}
6966 .data ALIGN(0x2000): @{
6967 *(.data)
6968 variable = ALIGN(0x8000);
6969 @}
6970@dots{} @}
6971@end group
6972@end smallexample
6973@noindent
6974The first use of @code{ALIGN} in this example specifies the location of
6975a section because it is used as the optional @var{address} attribute of
6976a section definition (@pxref{Output Section Address}). The second use
6977of @code{ALIGN} is used to defines the value of a symbol.
6978
6979The builtin function @code{NEXT} is closely related to @code{ALIGN}.
6980
362c1d1a
NS
6981@item ALIGNOF(@var{section})
6982@kindex ALIGNOF(@var{section})
6983@cindex section alignment
6984Return the alignment in bytes of the named @var{section}, if that section has
6985been allocated. If the section has not been allocated when this is
6986evaluated, the linker will report an error. In the following example,
6987the alignment of the @code{.output} section is stored as the first
6988value in that section.
6989@smallexample
6990@group
6991SECTIONS@{ @dots{}
6992 .output @{
6993 LONG (ALIGNOF (.output))
6994 @dots{}
6995 @}
6996@dots{} @}
6997@end group
6998@end smallexample
6999
252b5132
RH
7000@item BLOCK(@var{exp})
7001@kindex BLOCK(@var{exp})
7002This is a synonym for @code{ALIGN}, for compatibility with older linker
7003scripts. It is most often seen when setting the address of an output
7004section.
7005
2d20f7bf
JJ
7006@item DATA_SEGMENT_ALIGN(@var{maxpagesize}, @var{commonpagesize})
7007@kindex DATA_SEGMENT_ALIGN(@var{maxpagesize}, @var{commonpagesize})
7008This is equivalent to either
7009@smallexample
7010(ALIGN(@var{maxpagesize}) + (. & (@var{maxpagesize} - 1)))
7011@end smallexample
7012or
7013@smallexample
fe6052e1
AM
7014(ALIGN(@var{maxpagesize})
7015 + ((. + @var{commonpagesize} - 1) & (@var{maxpagesize} - @var{commonpagesize})))
2d20f7bf
JJ
7016@end smallexample
7017@noindent
7018depending on whether the latter uses fewer @var{commonpagesize} sized pages
7019for the data segment (area between the result of this expression and
7020@code{DATA_SEGMENT_END}) than the former or not.
7021If the latter form is used, it means @var{commonpagesize} bytes of runtime
7022memory will be saved at the expense of up to @var{commonpagesize} wasted
7023bytes in the on-disk file.
7024
7025This expression can only be used directly in @code{SECTIONS} commands, not in
7026any output section descriptions and only once in the linker script.
7027@var{commonpagesize} should be less or equal to @var{maxpagesize} and should
def5c83c
AM
7028be the system page size the object wants to be optimized for while still
7029running on system page sizes up to @var{maxpagesize}. Note however
7030that @samp{-z relro} protection will not be effective if the system
7031page size is larger than @var{commonpagesize}.
2d20f7bf
JJ
7032
7033@noindent
7034Example:
7035@smallexample
7036 . = DATA_SEGMENT_ALIGN(0x10000, 0x2000);
7037@end smallexample
7038
7039@item DATA_SEGMENT_END(@var{exp})
7040@kindex DATA_SEGMENT_END(@var{exp})
7041This defines the end of data segment for @code{DATA_SEGMENT_ALIGN}
7042evaluation purposes.
7043
7044@smallexample
7045 . = DATA_SEGMENT_END(.);
7046@end smallexample
7047
a4f5ad88
JJ
7048@item DATA_SEGMENT_RELRO_END(@var{offset}, @var{exp})
7049@kindex DATA_SEGMENT_RELRO_END(@var{offset}, @var{exp})
7050This defines the end of the @code{PT_GNU_RELRO} segment when
eec2f3ed 7051@samp{-z relro} option is used.
a4f5ad88
JJ
7052When @samp{-z relro} option is not present, @code{DATA_SEGMENT_RELRO_END}
7053does nothing, otherwise @code{DATA_SEGMENT_ALIGN} is padded so that
def5c83c
AM
7054@var{exp} + @var{offset} is aligned to the @var{commonpagesize}
7055argument given to @code{DATA_SEGMENT_ALIGN}. If present in the linker
7056script, it must be placed between @code{DATA_SEGMENT_ALIGN} and
eec2f3ed
AM
7057@code{DATA_SEGMENT_END}. Evaluates to the second argument plus any
7058padding needed at the end of the @code{PT_GNU_RELRO} segment due to
7059section alignment.
a4f5ad88
JJ
7060
7061@smallexample
7062 . = DATA_SEGMENT_RELRO_END(24, .);
7063@end smallexample
7064
252b5132
RH
7065@item DEFINED(@var{symbol})
7066@kindex DEFINED(@var{symbol})
7067@cindex symbol defaults
7068Return 1 if @var{symbol} is in the linker global symbol table and is
420e579c
HPN
7069defined before the statement using DEFINED in the script, otherwise
7070return 0. You can use this function to provide
252b5132
RH
7071default values for symbols. For example, the following script fragment
7072shows how to set a global symbol @samp{begin} to the first location in
7073the @samp{.text} section---but if a symbol called @samp{begin} already
7074existed, its value is preserved:
7075
7076@smallexample
7077@group
7078SECTIONS @{ @dots{}
7079 .text : @{
7080 begin = DEFINED(begin) ? begin : . ;
7081 @dots{}
7082 @}
7083 @dots{}
7084@}
7085@end group
7086@end smallexample
7087
3ec57632
NC
7088@item LENGTH(@var{memory})
7089@kindex LENGTH(@var{memory})
7090Return the length of the memory region named @var{memory}.
7091
252b5132
RH
7092@item LOADADDR(@var{section})
7093@kindex LOADADDR(@var{section})
7094@cindex section load address in expression
7542af2a 7095Return the absolute LMA of the named @var{section}. (@pxref{Output
252b5132
RH
7096Section LMA}).
7097
2e53f7d6
NC
7098@item LOG2CEIL(@var{exp})
7099@kindex LOG2CEIL(@var{exp})
7100Return the binary logarithm of @var{exp} rounded towards infinity.
7101@code{LOG2CEIL(0)} returns 0.
7102
252b5132
RH
7103@kindex MAX
7104@item MAX(@var{exp1}, @var{exp2})
7105Returns the maximum of @var{exp1} and @var{exp2}.
7106
7107@kindex MIN
7108@item MIN(@var{exp1}, @var{exp2})
7109Returns the minimum of @var{exp1} and @var{exp2}.
7110
7111@item NEXT(@var{exp})
7112@kindex NEXT(@var{exp})
7113@cindex unallocated address, next
7114Return the next unallocated address that is a multiple of @var{exp}.
7115This function is closely related to @code{ALIGN(@var{exp})}; unless you
7116use the @code{MEMORY} command to define discontinuous memory for the
7117output file, the two functions are equivalent.
7118
3ec57632
NC
7119@item ORIGIN(@var{memory})
7120@kindex ORIGIN(@var{memory})
7121Return the origin of the memory region named @var{memory}.
7122
ba916c8a
MM
7123@item SEGMENT_START(@var{segment}, @var{default})
7124@kindex SEGMENT_START(@var{segment}, @var{default})
7125Return the base address of the named @var{segment}. If an explicit
c5da8c7d
NC
7126value has already been given for this segment (with a command-line
7127@samp{-T} option) then that value will be returned otherwise the value
7128will be @var{default}. At present, the @samp{-T} command-line option
7129can only be used to set the base address for the ``text'', ``data'', and
7542af2a 7130``bss'' sections, but you can use @code{SEGMENT_START} with any segment
ba916c8a
MM
7131name.
7132
252b5132
RH
7133@item SIZEOF(@var{section})
7134@kindex SIZEOF(@var{section})
7135@cindex section size
7136Return the size in bytes of the named @var{section}, if that section has
7137been allocated. If the section has not been allocated when this is
7138evaluated, the linker will report an error. In the following example,
7139@code{symbol_1} and @code{symbol_2} are assigned identical values:
7140@smallexample
7141@group
7142SECTIONS@{ @dots{}
7143 .output @{
7144 .start = . ;
7145 @dots{}
7146 .end = . ;
7147 @}
7148 symbol_1 = .end - .start ;
7149 symbol_2 = SIZEOF(.output);
7150@dots{} @}
7151@end group
7152@end smallexample
7153
7154@item SIZEOF_HEADERS
252b5132
RH
7155@kindex SIZEOF_HEADERS
7156@cindex header size
7157Return the size in bytes of the output file's headers. This is
7158information which appears at the start of the output file. You can use
7159this number when setting the start address of the first section, if you
7160choose, to facilitate paging.
7161
7162@cindex not enough room for program headers
7163@cindex program headers, not enough room
7164When producing an ELF output file, if the linker script uses the
7165@code{SIZEOF_HEADERS} builtin function, the linker must compute the
7166number of program headers before it has determined all the section
7167addresses and sizes. If the linker later discovers that it needs
7168additional program headers, it will report an error @samp{not enough
7169room for program headers}. To avoid this error, you must avoid using
7170the @code{SIZEOF_HEADERS} function, or you must rework your linker
7171script to avoid forcing the linker to use additional program headers, or
7172you must define the program headers yourself using the @code{PHDRS}
7173command (@pxref{PHDRS}).
7174@end table
7175
7176@node Implicit Linker Scripts
7177@section Implicit Linker Scripts
7178@cindex implicit linker scripts
7179If you specify a linker input file which the linker can not recognize as
7180an object file or an archive file, it will try to read the file as a
7181linker script. If the file can not be parsed as a linker script, the
7182linker will report an error.
7183
7184An implicit linker script will not replace the default linker script.
7185
7186Typically an implicit linker script would contain only symbol
7187assignments, or the @code{INPUT}, @code{GROUP}, or @code{VERSION}
7188commands.
7189
7190Any input files read because of an implicit linker script will be read
7191at the position in the command line where the implicit linker script was
7192read. This can affect archive searching.
7193
bf6d8037
HC
7194@node Plugins
7195@chapter Linker Plugins
7196
7197@cindex plugins
7198@cindex linker plugins
7199The linker can use dynamically loaded plugins to modify its behavior.
7200For example, the link-time optimization feature that some compilers
7201support is implemented with a linker plugin.
7202
7203Currently there is only one plugin shipped by default, but more may
7204be added here later.
7205
7206@menu
7207* libdep Plugin:: Static Library Dependencies Plugin
7208@end menu
7209
7210@node libdep Plugin
7211@section Static Library Dependencies Plugin
7212@cindex static library dependencies
7213Originally, static libraries were contained in an archive file consisting
7214just of a collection of relocatable object files. Later they evolved to
7215optionally include a symbol table, to assist in finding the needed objects
7216within a library. There their evolution ended, and dynamic libraries
7217rose to ascendance.
7218
7219One useful feature of dynamic libraries was that, more than just collecting
7220multiple objects into a single file, they also included a list of their
7221dependencies, such that one could specify just the name of a single dynamic
7222library at link time, and all of its dependencies would be implicitly
7223referenced as well. But static libraries lacked this feature, so if a
7224link invocation was switched from using dynamic libraries to static
7225libraries, the link command would usually fail unless it was rewritten to
7226explicitly list the dependencies of the static library.
7227
7228The GNU @command{ar} utility now supports a @option{--record-libdeps} option
7229to embed dependency lists into static libraries as well, and the @file{libdep}
7230plugin may be used to read this dependency information at link time. The
7231dependency information is stored as a single string, carrying @option{-l}
7232and @option{-L} arguments as they would normally appear in a linker
7233command line. As such, the information can be written with any text
7234utility and stored into any archive, even if GNU @command{ar} is not
7235being used to create the archive. The information is stored in an
7236archive member named @samp{__.LIBDEP}.
7237
7238For example, given a library @file{libssl.a} that depends on another
7239library @file{libcrypto.a} which may be found in @file{/usr/local/lib},
7240the @samp{__.LIBDEP} member of @file{libssl.a} would contain
7241
7242@smallexample
7243-L/usr/local/lib -lcrypto
7244@end smallexample
7245
252b5132
RH
7246@ifset GENERIC
7247@node Machine Dependent
7248@chapter Machine Dependent Features
7249
7250@cindex machine dependencies
ff5dcc92
SC
7251@command{ld} has additional features on some platforms; the following
7252sections describe them. Machines where @command{ld} has no additional
252b5132
RH
7253functionality are not listed.
7254
7255@menu
36f63dca
NC
7256@ifset H8300
7257* H8/300:: @command{ld} and the H8/300
7258@end ifset
7ca01ed9
NC
7259@ifset M68HC11
7260* M68HC11/68HC12:: @code{ld} and the Motorola 68HC11 and 68HC12 families
7261@end ifset
36f63dca
NC
7262@ifset ARM
7263* ARM:: @command{ld} and the ARM family
7264@end ifset
7265@ifset HPPA
7266* HPPA ELF32:: @command{ld} and HPPA 32-bit ELF
7267@end ifset
7fb9f789
NC
7268@ifset M68K
7269* M68K:: @command{ld} and the Motorola 68K family
7270@end ifset
833794fc
MR
7271@ifset MIPS
7272* MIPS:: @command{ld} and the MIPS family
7273@end ifset
3c3bdf30 7274@ifset MMIX
36f63dca 7275* MMIX:: @command{ld} and MMIX
3c3bdf30 7276@end ifset
2469cfa2 7277@ifset MSP430
36f63dca 7278* MSP430:: @command{ld} and MSP430
2469cfa2 7279@end ifset
35c08157
KLC
7280@ifset NDS32
7281* NDS32:: @command{ld} and NDS32
7282@end ifset
78058a5e
SL
7283@ifset NIOSII
7284* Nios II:: @command{ld} and the Altera Nios II
7285@end ifset
2a60a7a8
AM
7286@ifset POWERPC
7287* PowerPC ELF32:: @command{ld} and PowerPC 32-bit ELF Support
7288@end ifset
7289@ifset POWERPC64
7290* PowerPC64 ELF64:: @command{ld} and PowerPC64 64-bit ELF Support
7291@end ifset
b4cbbe8f
AK
7292@ifset S/390
7293* S/390 ELF:: @command{ld} and S/390 ELF Support
7294@end ifset
49fa1e15
AM
7295@ifset SPU
7296* SPU ELF:: @command{ld} and SPU ELF Support
7297@end ifset
74459f0e 7298@ifset TICOFF
ff5dcc92 7299* TI COFF:: @command{ld} and TI COFF
74459f0e 7300@end ifset
2ca22b03
NC
7301@ifset WIN32
7302* WIN32:: @command{ld} and WIN32 (cygwin/mingw)
7303@end ifset
e0001a05
NC
7304@ifset XTENSA
7305* Xtensa:: @command{ld} and Xtensa Processors
7306@end ifset
252b5132
RH
7307@end menu
7308@end ifset
7309
252b5132
RH
7310@ifset H8300
7311@ifclear GENERIC
7312@raisesections
7313@end ifclear
7314
7315@node H8/300
ff5dcc92 7316@section @command{ld} and the H8/300
252b5132
RH
7317
7318@cindex H8/300 support
ff5dcc92 7319For the H8/300, @command{ld} can perform these global optimizations when
252b5132
RH
7320you specify the @samp{--relax} command-line option.
7321
7322@table @emph
7323@cindex relaxing on H8/300
7324@item relaxing address modes
ff5dcc92 7325@command{ld} finds all @code{jsr} and @code{jmp} instructions whose
252b5132
RH
7326targets are within eight bits, and turns them into eight-bit
7327program-counter relative @code{bsr} and @code{bra} instructions,
7328respectively.
7329
7330@cindex synthesizing on H8/300
7331@item synthesizing instructions
81f5558e 7332@c FIXME: specifically mov.b, or any mov instructions really? -> mov.b only, at least on H8, H8H, H8S
ff5dcc92 7333@command{ld} finds all @code{mov.b} instructions which use the
252b5132
RH
7334sixteen-bit absolute address form, but refer to the top
7335page of memory, and changes them to use the eight-bit address form.
7336(That is: the linker turns @samp{mov.b @code{@@}@var{aa}:16} into
7337@samp{mov.b @code{@@}@var{aa}:8} whenever the address @var{aa} is in the
7338top page of memory).
1502569c 7339
81f5558e
NC
7340@command{ld} finds all @code{mov} instructions which use the register
7341indirect with 32-bit displacement addressing mode, but use a small
7342displacement inside 16-bit displacement range, and changes them to use
7343the 16-bit displacement form. (That is: the linker turns @samp{mov.b
7344@code{@@}@var{d}:32,ERx} into @samp{mov.b @code{@@}@var{d}:16,ERx}
7345whenever the displacement @var{d} is in the 16 bit signed integer
7346range. Only implemented in ELF-format ld).
7347
1502569c 7348@item bit manipulation instructions
c0065db7 7349@command{ld} finds all bit manipulation instructions like @code{band, bclr,
1502569c 7350biand, bild, bior, bist, bixor, bld, bnot, bor, bset, bst, btst, bxor}
c0065db7 7351which use 32 bit and 16 bit absolute address form, but refer to the top
1502569c
NC
7352page of memory, and changes them to use the 8 bit address form.
7353(That is: the linker turns @samp{bset #xx:3,@code{@@}@var{aa}:32} into
c0065db7 7354@samp{bset #xx:3,@code{@@}@var{aa}:8} whenever the address @var{aa} is in
1502569c
NC
7355the top page of memory).
7356
7357@item system control instructions
c0065db7
RM
7358@command{ld} finds all @code{ldc.w, stc.w} instructions which use the
735932 bit absolute address form, but refer to the top page of memory, and
1502569c
NC
7360changes them to use 16 bit address form.
7361(That is: the linker turns @samp{ldc.w @code{@@}@var{aa}:32,ccr} into
c0065db7 7362@samp{ldc.w @code{@@}@var{aa}:16,ccr} whenever the address @var{aa} is in
1502569c 7363the top page of memory).
252b5132
RH
7364@end table
7365
7366@ifclear GENERIC
7367@lowersections
7368@end ifclear
7369@end ifset
7370
36f63dca 7371@ifclear GENERIC
c2dcd04e 7372@ifset Renesas
36f63dca 7373@c This stuff is pointless to say unless you're especially concerned
c2dcd04e
NC
7374@c with Renesas chips; don't enable it for generic case, please.
7375@node Renesas
7376@chapter @command{ld} and Other Renesas Chips
36f63dca 7377
c2dcd04e
NC
7378@command{ld} also supports the Renesas (formerly Hitachi) H8/300H,
7379H8/500, and SH chips. No special features, commands, or command-line
7380options are required for these chips.
36f63dca
NC
7381@end ifset
7382@end ifclear
7383
36f63dca
NC
7384@ifset ARM
7385@ifclear GENERIC
7386@raisesections
7387@end ifclear
7388
93fd0973
SC
7389@ifset M68HC11
7390@ifclear GENERIC
7391@raisesections
7392@end ifclear
7393
7394@node M68HC11/68HC12
7395@section @command{ld} and the Motorola 68HC11 and 68HC12 families
7396
7397@cindex M68HC11 and 68HC12 support
7398
7399@subsection Linker Relaxation
7400
7401For the Motorola 68HC11, @command{ld} can perform these global
7402optimizations when you specify the @samp{--relax} command-line option.
7403
7404@table @emph
7405@cindex relaxing on M68HC11
7406@item relaxing address modes
7407@command{ld} finds all @code{jsr} and @code{jmp} instructions whose
7408targets are within eight bits, and turns them into eight-bit
7409program-counter relative @code{bsr} and @code{bra} instructions,
7410respectively.
7411
7412@command{ld} also looks at all 16-bit extended addressing modes and
7413transforms them in a direct addressing mode when the address is in
7414page 0 (between 0 and 0x0ff).
7415
7416@item relaxing gcc instruction group
7417When @command{gcc} is called with @option{-mrelax}, it can emit group
7418of instructions that the linker can optimize to use a 68HC11 direct
7419addressing mode. These instructions consists of @code{bclr} or
7420@code{bset} instructions.
7421
7422@end table
7423
7424@subsection Trampoline Generation
7425
7426@cindex trampoline generation on M68HC11
7427@cindex trampoline generation on M68HC12
7428For 68HC11 and 68HC12, @command{ld} can generate trampoline code to
7429call a far function using a normal @code{jsr} instruction. The linker
c0065db7 7430will also change the relocation to some far function to use the
93fd0973
SC
7431trampoline address instead of the function address. This is typically the
7432case when a pointer to a function is taken. The pointer will in fact
7433point to the function trampoline.
7434
7435@ifclear GENERIC
7436@lowersections
7437@end ifclear
7438@end ifset
7439
36f63dca 7440@node ARM
3674e28a 7441@section @command{ld} and the ARM family
36f63dca
NC
7442
7443@cindex ARM interworking support
7444@kindex --support-old-code
7445For the ARM, @command{ld} will generate code stubs to allow functions calls
b45619c0 7446between ARM and Thumb code. These stubs only work with code that has
36f63dca
NC
7447been compiled and assembled with the @samp{-mthumb-interwork} command
7448line option. If it is necessary to link with old ARM object files or
7449libraries, which have not been compiled with the -mthumb-interwork
a05a5b64 7450option then the @samp{--support-old-code} command-line switch should be
36f63dca
NC
7451given to the linker. This will make it generate larger stub functions
7452which will work with non-interworking aware ARM code. Note, however,
7453the linker does not support generating stubs for function calls to
7454non-interworking aware Thumb code.
7455
7456@cindex thumb entry point
7457@cindex entry point, thumb
7458@kindex --thumb-entry=@var{entry}
7459The @samp{--thumb-entry} switch is a duplicate of the generic
7460@samp{--entry} switch, in that it sets the program's starting address.
7461But it also sets the bottom bit of the address, so that it can be
7462branched to using a BX instruction, and the program will start
7463executing in Thumb mode straight away.
7464
ce11ba6c
KT
7465@cindex PE import table prefixing
7466@kindex --use-nul-prefixed-import-tables
7467The @samp{--use-nul-prefixed-import-tables} switch is specifying, that
7468the import tables idata4 and idata5 have to be generated with a zero
11e7fd74 7469element prefix for import libraries. This is the old style to generate
ce11ba6c
KT
7470import tables. By default this option is turned off.
7471
e489d0ae
PB
7472@cindex BE8
7473@kindex --be8
7474The @samp{--be8} switch instructs @command{ld} to generate BE8 format
080bb7bb
NC
7475executables. This option is only valid when linking big-endian
7476objects - ie ones which have been assembled with the @option{-EB}
7477option. The resulting image will contain big-endian data and
7478little-endian code.
e489d0ae 7479
3674e28a
PB
7480@cindex TARGET1
7481@kindex --target1-rel
7482@kindex --target1-abs
7483The @samp{R_ARM_TARGET1} relocation is typically used for entries in the
7484@samp{.init_array} section. It is interpreted as either @samp{R_ARM_REL32}
7485or @samp{R_ARM_ABS32}, depending on the target. The @samp{--target1-rel}
7486and @samp{--target1-abs} switches override the default.
7487
7488@cindex TARGET2
7489@kindex --target2=@var{type}
7490The @samp{--target2=type} switch overrides the default definition of the
7491@samp{R_ARM_TARGET2} relocation. Valid values for @samp{type}, their
7492meanings, and target defaults are as follows:
7493@table @samp
7494@item rel
eeac373a
PB
7495@samp{R_ARM_REL32} (arm*-*-elf, arm*-*-eabi)
7496@item abs
a57d1773 7497@samp{R_ARM_ABS32}
3674e28a
PB
7498@item got-rel
7499@samp{R_ARM_GOT_PREL} (arm*-*-linux, arm*-*-*bsd)
7500@end table
7501
319850b4
JB
7502@cindex FIX_V4BX
7503@kindex --fix-v4bx
7504The @samp{R_ARM_V4BX} relocation (defined by the ARM AAELF
7505specification) enables objects compiled for the ARMv4 architecture to be
7506interworking-safe when linked with other objects compiled for ARMv4t, but
7507also allows pure ARMv4 binaries to be built from the same ARMv4 objects.
7508
7509In the latter case, the switch @option{--fix-v4bx} must be passed to the
7510linker, which causes v4t @code{BX rM} instructions to be rewritten as
7511@code{MOV PC,rM}, since v4 processors do not have a @code{BX} instruction.
7512
7513In the former case, the switch should not be used, and @samp{R_ARM_V4BX}
7514relocations are ignored.
7515
845b51d6
PB
7516@cindex FIX_V4BX_INTERWORKING
7517@kindex --fix-v4bx-interworking
7518Replace @code{BX rM} instructions identified by @samp{R_ARM_V4BX}
7519relocations with a branch to the following veneer:
7520
7521@smallexample
7522TST rM, #1
7523MOVEQ PC, rM
7524BX Rn
7525@end smallexample
7526
7527This allows generation of libraries/applications that work on ARMv4 cores
7528and are still interworking safe. Note that the above veneer clobbers the
11e7fd74 7529condition flags, so may cause incorrect program behavior in rare cases.
845b51d6 7530
33bfe774
JB
7531@cindex USE_BLX
7532@kindex --use-blx
7533The @samp{--use-blx} switch enables the linker to use ARM/Thumb
7534BLX instructions (available on ARMv5t and above) in various
7535situations. Currently it is used to perform calls via the PLT from Thumb
7536code using BLX rather than using BX and a mode-switching stub before
7537each PLT entry. This should lead to such calls executing slightly faster.
7538
c6dd86c6
JB
7539@cindex VFP11_DENORM_FIX
7540@kindex --vfp11-denorm-fix
7541The @samp{--vfp11-denorm-fix} switch enables a link-time workaround for a
7542bug in certain VFP11 coprocessor hardware, which sometimes allows
7543instructions with denorm operands (which must be handled by support code)
7544to have those operands overwritten by subsequent instructions before
7545the support code can read the intended values.
7546
7547The bug may be avoided in scalar mode if you allow at least one
7548intervening instruction between a VFP11 instruction which uses a register
7549and another instruction which writes to the same register, or at least two
7550intervening instructions if vector mode is in use. The bug only affects
7551full-compliance floating-point mode: you do not need this workaround if
7552you are using "runfast" mode. Please contact ARM for further details.
7553
7554If you know you are using buggy VFP11 hardware, you can
7555enable this workaround by specifying the linker option
7556@samp{--vfp-denorm-fix=scalar} if you are using the VFP11 scalar
7557mode only, or @samp{--vfp-denorm-fix=vector} if you are using
7558vector mode (the latter also works for scalar code). The default is
7559@samp{--vfp-denorm-fix=none}.
7560
7561If the workaround is enabled, instructions are scanned for
7562potentially-troublesome sequences, and a veneer is created for each
7563such sequence which may trigger the erratum. The veneer consists of the
7564first instruction of the sequence and a branch back to the subsequent
7565instruction. The original instruction is then replaced with a branch to
7566the veneer. The extra cycles required to call and return from the veneer
7567are sufficient to avoid the erratum in both the scalar and vector cases.
7568
2de70689
MGD
7569@cindex ARM1176 erratum workaround
7570@kindex --fix-arm1176
7571@kindex --no-fix-arm1176
9d5777a3
RM
7572The @samp{--fix-arm1176} switch enables a link-time workaround for an erratum
7573in certain ARM1176 processors. The workaround is enabled by default if you
7574are targeting ARM v6 (excluding ARM v6T2) or earlier. It can be disabled
2de70689
MGD
7575unconditionally by specifying @samp{--no-fix-arm1176}.
7576
9d5777a3 7577Further information is available in the ``ARM1176JZ-S and ARM1176JZF-S
11e7fd74 7578Programmer Advice Notice'' available on the ARM documentation website at:
2de70689
MGD
7579http://infocenter.arm.com/.
7580
a504d23a
LA
7581@cindex STM32L4xx erratum workaround
7582@kindex --fix-stm32l4xx-629360
7583
7584The @samp{--fix-stm32l4xx-629360} switch enables a link-time
7585workaround for a bug in the bus matrix / memory controller for some of
7586the STM32 Cortex-M4 based products (STM32L4xx). When accessing
7587off-chip memory via the affected bus for bus reads of 9 words or more,
7588the bus can generate corrupt data and/or abort. These are only
7589core-initiated accesses (not DMA), and might affect any access:
7590integer loads such as LDM, POP and floating-point loads such as VLDM,
7591VPOP. Stores are not affected.
7592
7593The bug can be avoided by splitting memory accesses into the
7594necessary chunks to keep bus reads below 8 words.
7595
7596The workaround is not enabled by default, this is equivalent to use
7597@samp{--fix-stm32l4xx-629360=none}. If you know you are using buggy
7598STM32L4xx hardware, you can enable the workaround by specifying the
7599linker option @samp{--fix-stm32l4xx-629360}, or the equivalent
7600@samp{--fix-stm32l4xx-629360=default}.
7601
7602If the workaround is enabled, instructions are scanned for
7603potentially-troublesome sequences, and a veneer is created for each
7604such sequence which may trigger the erratum. The veneer consists in a
7605replacement sequence emulating the behaviour of the original one and a
7606branch back to the subsequent instruction. The original instruction is
7607then replaced with a branch to the veneer.
7608
7609The workaround does not always preserve the memory access order for
7610the LDMDB instruction, when the instruction loads the PC.
7611
7612The workaround is not able to handle problematic instructions when
7613they are in the middle of an IT block, since a branch is not allowed
7614there. In that case, the linker reports a warning and no replacement
7615occurs.
7616
7617The workaround is not able to replace problematic instructions with a
7618PC-relative branch instruction if the @samp{.text} section is too
7619large. In that case, when the branch that replaces the original code
7620cannot be encoded, the linker reports a warning and no replacement
7621occurs.
7622
bf21ed78
MS
7623@cindex NO_ENUM_SIZE_WARNING
7624@kindex --no-enum-size-warning
726150b7 7625The @option{--no-enum-size-warning} switch prevents the linker from
bf21ed78
MS
7626warning when linking object files that specify incompatible EABI
7627enumeration size attributes. For example, with this switch enabled,
7628linking of an object file using 32-bit enumeration values with another
7629using enumeration values fitted into the smallest possible space will
7630not be diagnosed.
a9dc9481
JM
7631
7632@cindex NO_WCHAR_SIZE_WARNING
7633@kindex --no-wchar-size-warning
7634The @option{--no-wchar-size-warning} switch prevents the linker from
7635warning when linking object files that specify incompatible EABI
7636@code{wchar_t} size attributes. For example, with this switch enabled,
7637linking of an object file using 32-bit @code{wchar_t} values with another
7638using 16-bit @code{wchar_t} values will not be diagnosed.
bf21ed78 7639
726150b7
NC
7640@cindex PIC_VENEER
7641@kindex --pic-veneer
7642The @samp{--pic-veneer} switch makes the linker use PIC sequences for
7643ARM/Thumb interworking veneers, even if the rest of the binary
7644is not PIC. This avoids problems on uClinux targets where
7645@samp{--emit-relocs} is used to generate relocatable binaries.
7646
7647@cindex STUB_GROUP_SIZE
7648@kindex --stub-group-size=@var{N}
7649The linker will automatically generate and insert small sequences of
7650code into a linked ARM ELF executable whenever an attempt is made to
7651perform a function call to a symbol that is too far away. The
7652placement of these sequences of instructions - called stubs - is
a05a5b64 7653controlled by the command-line option @option{--stub-group-size=N}.
726150b7 7654The placement is important because a poor choice can create a need for
11e7fd74 7655duplicate stubs, increasing the code size. The linker will try to
726150b7
NC
7656group stubs together in order to reduce interruptions to the flow of
7657code, but it needs guidance as to how big these groups should be and
7658where they should be placed.
7659
7660The value of @samp{N}, the parameter to the
7661@option{--stub-group-size=} option controls where the stub groups are
07d72278 7662placed. If it is negative then all stubs are placed after the first
726150b7
NC
7663branch that needs them. If it is positive then the stubs can be
7664placed either before or after the branches that need them. If the
7665value of @samp{N} is 1 (either +1 or -1) then the linker will choose
7666exactly where to place groups of stubs, using its built in heuristics.
7667A value of @samp{N} greater than 1 (or smaller than -1) tells the
7668linker that a single group of stubs can service at most @samp{N} bytes
7669from the input sections.
7670
7671The default, if @option{--stub-group-size=} is not specified, is
7672@samp{N = +1}.
7673
1a51c1a4
NC
7674Farcalls stubs insertion is fully supported for the ARM-EABI target
7675only, because it relies on object files properties not present
7676otherwise.
7677
1db37fe6
YG
7678@cindex Cortex-A8 erratum workaround
7679@kindex --fix-cortex-a8
7680@kindex --no-fix-cortex-a8
7681The @samp{--fix-cortex-a8} switch enables a link-time workaround for an erratum in certain Cortex-A8 processors. The workaround is enabled by default if you are targeting the ARM v7-A architecture profile. It can be enabled otherwise by specifying @samp{--fix-cortex-a8}, or disabled unconditionally by specifying @samp{--no-fix-cortex-a8}.
7682
7683The erratum only affects Thumb-2 code. Please contact ARM for further details.
7684
68fcca92
JW
7685@cindex Cortex-A53 erratum 835769 workaround
7686@kindex --fix-cortex-a53-835769
7687@kindex --no-fix-cortex-a53-835769
7688The @samp{--fix-cortex-a53-835769} switch enables a link-time workaround for erratum 835769 present on certain early revisions of Cortex-A53 processors. The workaround is disabled by default. It can be enabled by specifying @samp{--fix-cortex-a53-835769}, or disabled unconditionally by specifying @samp{--no-fix-cortex-a53-835769}.
7689
7690Please contact ARM for further details.
7691
1db37fe6
YG
7692@kindex --merge-exidx-entries
7693@kindex --no-merge-exidx-entries
7694@cindex Merging exidx entries
7695The @samp{--no-merge-exidx-entries} switch disables the merging of adjacent exidx entries in debuginfo.
7696
7697@kindex --long-plt
7698@cindex 32-bit PLT entries
7699The @samp{--long-plt} option enables the use of 16 byte PLT entries
7700which support up to 4Gb of code. The default is to use 12 byte PLT
7701entries which only support 512Mb of code.
7702
1f56df9d
JW
7703@kindex --no-apply-dynamic-relocs
7704@cindex AArch64 rela addend
7705The @samp{--no-apply-dynamic-relocs} option makes AArch64 linker do not apply
7706link-time values for dynamic relocations.
7707
4ba2ef8f
TP
7708@cindex Placement of SG veneers
7709All SG veneers are placed in the special output section @code{.gnu.sgstubs}.
a05a5b64 7710Its start address must be set, either with the command-line option
4ba2ef8f
TP
7711@samp{--section-start} or in a linker script, to indicate where to place these
7712veneers in memory.
7713
54ddd295
TP
7714@kindex --cmse-implib
7715@cindex Secure gateway import library
7716The @samp{--cmse-implib} option requests that the import libraries
7717specified by the @samp{--out-implib} and @samp{--in-implib} options are
7718secure gateway import libraries, suitable for linking a non-secure
7719executable against secure code as per ARMv8-M Security Extensions.
7720
0955507f
TP
7721@kindex --in-implib=@var{file}
7722@cindex Input import library
7723The @samp{--in-implib=file} specifies an input import library whose symbols
7724must keep the same address in the executable being produced. A warning is
7725given if no @samp{--out-implib} is given but new symbols have been introduced
7726in the executable that should be listed in its import library. Otherwise, if
7727@samp{--out-implib} is specified, the symbols are added to the output import
7728library. A warning is also given if some symbols present in the input import
7729library have disappeared from the executable. This option is only effective
7730for Secure Gateway import libraries, ie. when @samp{--cmse-implib} is
7731specified.
7732
36f63dca
NC
7733@ifclear GENERIC
7734@lowersections
7735@end ifclear
7736@end ifset
7737
7738@ifset HPPA
7739@ifclear GENERIC
7740@raisesections
7741@end ifclear
7742
7743@node HPPA ELF32
7744@section @command{ld} and HPPA 32-bit ELF Support
7745@cindex HPPA multiple sub-space stubs
7746@kindex --multi-subspace
7747When generating a shared library, @command{ld} will by default generate
7748import stubs suitable for use with a single sub-space application.
7749The @samp{--multi-subspace} switch causes @command{ld} to generate export
7750stubs, and different (larger) import stubs suitable for use with
7751multiple sub-spaces.
7752
7753@cindex HPPA stub grouping
7754@kindex --stub-group-size=@var{N}
7755Long branch stubs and import/export stubs are placed by @command{ld} in
7756stub sections located between groups of input sections.
7757@samp{--stub-group-size} specifies the maximum size of a group of input
7758sections handled by one stub section. Since branch offsets are signed,
7759a stub section may serve two groups of input sections, one group before
7760the stub section, and one group after it. However, when using
7761conditional branches that require stubs, it may be better (for branch
7762prediction) that stub sections only serve one group of input sections.
7763A negative value for @samp{N} chooses this scheme, ensuring that
7764branches to stubs always use a negative offset. Two special values of
7765@samp{N} are recognized, @samp{1} and @samp{-1}. These both instruct
7766@command{ld} to automatically size input section groups for the branch types
7767detected, with the same behaviour regarding stub placement as other
7768positive or negative values of @samp{N} respectively.
7769
7770Note that @samp{--stub-group-size} does not split input sections. A
7771single input section larger than the group size specified will of course
7772create a larger group (of one section). If input sections are too
7773large, it may not be possible for a branch to reach its stub.
7774
7775@ifclear GENERIC
7776@lowersections
7777@end ifclear
7778@end ifset
7779
7fb9f789
NC
7780@ifset M68K
7781@ifclear GENERIC
7782@raisesections
7783@end ifclear
7784
7785@node M68K
7786@section @command{ld} and the Motorola 68K family
7787
7788@cindex Motorola 68K GOT generation
7789@kindex --got=@var{type}
7790The @samp{--got=@var{type}} option lets you choose the GOT generation scheme.
7791The choices are @samp{single}, @samp{negative}, @samp{multigot} and
7792@samp{target}. When @samp{target} is selected the linker chooses
7793the default GOT generation scheme for the current target.
7794@samp{single} tells the linker to generate a single GOT with
7795entries only at non-negative offsets.
7796@samp{negative} instructs the linker to generate a single GOT with
7797entries at both negative and positive offsets. Not all environments
7798support such GOTs.
7799@samp{multigot} allows the linker to generate several GOTs in the
7800output file. All GOT references from a single input object
7801file access the same GOT, but references from different input object
7802files might access different GOTs. Not all environments support such GOTs.
7803
7804@ifclear GENERIC
7805@lowersections
7806@end ifclear
7807@end ifset
7808
833794fc
MR
7809@ifset MIPS
7810@ifclear GENERIC
7811@raisesections
7812@end ifclear
7813
7814@node MIPS
7815@section @command{ld} and the MIPS family
7816
7817@cindex MIPS microMIPS instruction choice selection
7818@kindex --insn32
7819@kindex --no-insn32
7820The @samp{--insn32} and @samp{--no-insn32} options control the choice of
7821microMIPS instructions used in code generated by the linker, such as that
7822in the PLT or lazy binding stubs, or in relaxation. If @samp{--insn32} is
7823used, then the linker only uses 32-bit instruction encodings. By default
7824or if @samp{--no-insn32} is used, all instruction encodings are used,
7825including 16-bit ones where possible.
7826
8b10b0b3
MR
7827@cindex MIPS branch relocation check control
7828@kindex --ignore-branch-isa
7829@kindex --no-ignore-branch-isa
7830The @samp{--ignore-branch-isa} and @samp{--no-ignore-branch-isa} options
7831control branch relocation checks for invalid ISA mode transitions. If
7832@samp{--ignore-branch-isa} is used, then the linker accepts any branch
7833relocations and any ISA mode transition required is lost in relocation
7834calculation, except for some cases of @code{BAL} instructions which meet
7835relaxation conditions and are converted to equivalent @code{JALX}
7836instructions as the associated relocation is calculated. By default
7837or if @samp{--no-ignore-branch-isa} is used a check is made causing
7838the loss of an ISA mode transition to produce an error.
7839
833794fc
MR
7840@ifclear GENERIC
7841@lowersections
7842@end ifclear
7843@end ifset
7844
36f63dca
NC
7845@ifset MMIX
7846@ifclear GENERIC
7847@raisesections
7848@end ifclear
7849
7850@node MMIX
7851@section @code{ld} and MMIX
7852For MMIX, there is a choice of generating @code{ELF} object files or
7853@code{mmo} object files when linking. The simulator @code{mmix}
7854understands the @code{mmo} format. The binutils @code{objcopy} utility
7855can translate between the two formats.
7856
7857There is one special section, the @samp{.MMIX.reg_contents} section.
7858Contents in this section is assumed to correspond to that of global
7859registers, and symbols referring to it are translated to special symbols,
7860equal to registers. In a final link, the start address of the
7861@samp{.MMIX.reg_contents} section corresponds to the first allocated
7862global register multiplied by 8. Register @code{$255} is not included in
7863this section; it is always set to the program entry, which is at the
7864symbol @code{Main} for @code{mmo} files.
7865
7a2de473
HPN
7866Global symbols with the prefix @code{__.MMIX.start.}, for example
7867@code{__.MMIX.start..text} and @code{__.MMIX.start..data} are special.
7868The default linker script uses these to set the default start address
7869of a section.
36f63dca
NC
7870
7871Initial and trailing multiples of zero-valued 32-bit words in a section,
7872are left out from an mmo file.
7873
7874@ifclear GENERIC
7875@lowersections
7876@end ifclear
7877@end ifset
7878
7879@ifset MSP430
7880@ifclear GENERIC
7881@raisesections
7882@end ifclear
7883
7884@node MSP430
7885@section @code{ld} and MSP430
7886For the MSP430 it is possible to select the MPU architecture. The flag @samp{-m [mpu type]}
7887will select an appropriate linker script for selected MPU type. (To get a list of known MPUs
7888just pass @samp{-m help} option to the linker).
7889
7890@cindex MSP430 extra sections
7891The linker will recognize some extra sections which are MSP430 specific:
7892
7893@table @code
7894@item @samp{.vectors}
7895Defines a portion of ROM where interrupt vectors located.
7896
7897@item @samp{.bootloader}
7898Defines the bootloader portion of the ROM (if applicable). Any code
7899in this section will be uploaded to the MPU.
7900
7901@item @samp{.infomem}
7902Defines an information memory section (if applicable). Any code in
7903this section will be uploaded to the MPU.
7904
c0065db7 7905@item @samp{.infomemnobits}
36f63dca
NC
7906This is the same as the @samp{.infomem} section except that any code
7907in this section will not be uploaded to the MPU.
7908
7909@item @samp{.noinit}
7910Denotes a portion of RAM located above @samp{.bss} section.
7911
c0065db7 7912The last two sections are used by gcc.
36f63dca
NC
7913@end table
7914
7ef3addb
JL
7915@table @option
7916@cindex MSP430 Options
7917@kindex --code-region
7918@item --code-region=[either,lower,upper,none]
7919This will transform .text* sections to [either,lower,upper].text* sections. The
7920argument passed to GCC for -mcode-region is propagated to the linker
7921using this option.
7922
7923@kindex --data-region
7924@item --data-region=[either,lower,upper,none]
7925This will transform .data*, .bss* and .rodata* sections to
7926[either,lower,upper].[data,bss,rodata]* sections. The argument passed to GCC
7927for -mdata-region is propagated to the linker using this option.
7928
7929@kindex --disable-sec-transformation
7930@item --disable-sec-transformation
7931Prevent the transformation of sections as specified by the @code{--code-region}
7932and @code{--data-region} options.
7933This is useful if you are compiling and linking using a single call to the GCC
7934wrapper, and want to compile the source files using -m[code,data]-region but
7935not transform the sections for prebuilt libraries and objects.
7936@end table
7937
36f63dca
NC
7938@ifclear GENERIC
7939@lowersections
7940@end ifclear
7941@end ifset
7942
35c08157
KLC
7943@ifset NDS32
7944@ifclear GENERIC
7945@raisesections
7946@end ifclear
7947
7948@node NDS32
7949@section @code{ld} and NDS32
7950@kindex relaxing on NDS32
7951For NDS32, there are some options to select relaxation behavior. The linker
7952relaxes objects according to these options.
7953
7954@table @code
7955@item @samp{--m[no-]fp-as-gp}
7956Disable/enable fp-as-gp relaxation.
7957
7958@item @samp{--mexport-symbols=FILE}
7959Exporting symbols and their address into FILE as linker script.
7960
7961@item @samp{--m[no-]ex9}
7962Disable/enable link-time EX9 relaxation.
7963
7964@item @samp{--mexport-ex9=FILE}
7965Export the EX9 table after linking.
7966
7967@item @samp{--mimport-ex9=FILE}
7968Import the Ex9 table for EX9 relaxation.
7969
7970@item @samp{--mupdate-ex9}
7971Update the existing EX9 table.
7972
7973@item @samp{--mex9-limit=NUM}
7974Maximum number of entries in the ex9 table.
7975
7976@item @samp{--mex9-loop-aware}
7977Avoid generating the EX9 instruction inside the loop.
7978
7979@item @samp{--m[no-]ifc}
7980Disable/enable the link-time IFC optimization.
7981
7982@item @samp{--mifc-loop-aware}
7983Avoid generating the IFC instruction inside the loop.
7984@end table
7985
7986@ifclear GENERIC
7987@lowersections
7988@end ifclear
7989@end ifset
7990
78058a5e
SL
7991@ifset NIOSII
7992@ifclear GENERIC
7993@raisesections
7994@end ifclear
7995
7996@node Nios II
7997@section @command{ld} and the Altera Nios II
7998@cindex Nios II call relaxation
7999@kindex --relax on Nios II
8000
8001Call and immediate jump instructions on Nios II processors are limited to
8002transferring control to addresses in the same 256MB memory segment,
8003which may result in @command{ld} giving
8004@samp{relocation truncated to fit} errors with very large programs.
8005The command-line option @option{--relax} enables the generation of
8006trampolines that can access the entire 32-bit address space for calls
8007outside the normal @code{call} and @code{jmpi} address range. These
8008trampolines are inserted at section boundaries, so may not themselves
8009be reachable if an input section and its associated call trampolines are
8010larger than 256MB.
8011
8012The @option{--relax} option is enabled by default unless @option{-r}
8013is also specified. You can disable trampoline generation by using the
8014@option{--no-relax} linker option. You can also disable this optimization
8015locally by using the @samp{set .noat} directive in assembly-language
8016source files, as the linker-inserted trampolines use the @code{at}
8017register as a temporary.
8018
8019Note that the linker @option{--relax} option is independent of assembler
8020relaxation options, and that using the GNU assembler's @option{-relax-all}
8021option interferes with the linker's more selective call instruction relaxation.
8022
8023@ifclear GENERIC
8024@lowersections
8025@end ifclear
8026@end ifset
8027
2a60a7a8
AM
8028@ifset POWERPC
8029@ifclear GENERIC
8030@raisesections
8031@end ifclear
8032
8033@node PowerPC ELF32
8034@section @command{ld} and PowerPC 32-bit ELF Support
8035@cindex PowerPC long branches
8036@kindex --relax on PowerPC
8037Branches on PowerPC processors are limited to a signed 26-bit
8038displacement, which may result in @command{ld} giving
8039@samp{relocation truncated to fit} errors with very large programs.
8040@samp{--relax} enables the generation of trampolines that can access
8041the entire 32-bit address space. These trampolines are inserted at
8042section boundaries, so may not themselves be reachable if an input
c8a1f254
NS
8043section exceeds 33M in size. You may combine @samp{-r} and
8044@samp{--relax} to add trampolines in a partial link. In that case
8045both branches to undefined symbols and inter-section branches are also
8046considered potentially out of range, and trampolines inserted.
2a60a7a8
AM
8047
8048@cindex PowerPC ELF32 options
8049@table @option
8050@cindex PowerPC PLT
8051@kindex --bss-plt
8052@item --bss-plt
8053Current PowerPC GCC accepts a @samp{-msecure-plt} option that
8054generates code capable of using a newer PLT and GOT layout that has
8055the security advantage of no executable section ever needing to be
8056writable and no writable section ever being executable. PowerPC
8057@command{ld} will generate this layout, including stubs to access the
8058PLT, if all input files (including startup and static libraries) were
8059compiled with @samp{-msecure-plt}. @samp{--bss-plt} forces the old
8060BSS PLT (and GOT layout) which can give slightly better performance.
8061
016687f8
AM
8062@kindex --secure-plt
8063@item --secure-plt
8064@command{ld} will use the new PLT and GOT layout if it is linking new
8065@samp{-fpic} or @samp{-fPIC} code, but does not do so automatically
8066when linking non-PIC code. This option requests the new PLT and GOT
8067layout. A warning will be given if some object file requires the old
8068style BSS PLT.
8069
2a60a7a8
AM
8070@cindex PowerPC GOT
8071@kindex --sdata-got
8072@item --sdata-got
8073The new secure PLT and GOT are placed differently relative to other
8074sections compared to older BSS PLT and GOT placement. The location of
8075@code{.plt} must change because the new secure PLT is an initialized
8076section while the old PLT is uninitialized. The reason for the
8077@code{.got} change is more subtle: The new placement allows
8078@code{.got} to be read-only in applications linked with
8079@samp{-z relro -z now}. However, this placement means that
8080@code{.sdata} cannot always be used in shared libraries, because the
8081PowerPC ABI accesses @code{.sdata} in shared libraries from the GOT
8082pointer. @samp{--sdata-got} forces the old GOT placement. PowerPC
8083GCC doesn't use @code{.sdata} in shared libraries, so this option is
8084really only useful for other compilers that may do so.
8085
8086@cindex PowerPC stub symbols
8087@kindex --emit-stub-syms
8088@item --emit-stub-syms
8089This option causes @command{ld} to label linker stubs with a local
8090symbol that encodes the stub type and destination.
8091
8092@cindex PowerPC TLS optimization
8093@kindex --no-tls-optimize
8094@item --no-tls-optimize
8095PowerPC @command{ld} normally performs some optimization of code
8096sequences used to access Thread-Local Storage. Use this option to
8097disable the optimization.
8098@end table
8099
8100@ifclear GENERIC
8101@lowersections
8102@end ifclear
8103@end ifset
8104
8105@ifset POWERPC64
8106@ifclear GENERIC
8107@raisesections
8108@end ifclear
8109
8110@node PowerPC64 ELF64
8111@section @command{ld} and PowerPC64 64-bit ELF Support
8112
8113@cindex PowerPC64 ELF64 options
8114@table @option
8115@cindex PowerPC64 stub grouping
8116@kindex --stub-group-size
8117@item --stub-group-size
8118Long branch stubs, PLT call stubs and TOC adjusting stubs are placed
8119by @command{ld} in stub sections located between groups of input sections.
8120@samp{--stub-group-size} specifies the maximum size of a group of input
8121sections handled by one stub section. Since branch offsets are signed,
8122a stub section may serve two groups of input sections, one group before
8123the stub section, and one group after it. However, when using
8124conditional branches that require stubs, it may be better (for branch
8125prediction) that stub sections only serve one group of input sections.
8126A negative value for @samp{N} chooses this scheme, ensuring that
8127branches to stubs always use a negative offset. Two special values of
8128@samp{N} are recognized, @samp{1} and @samp{-1}. These both instruct
8129@command{ld} to automatically size input section groups for the branch types
8130detected, with the same behaviour regarding stub placement as other
8131positive or negative values of @samp{N} respectively.
8132
8133Note that @samp{--stub-group-size} does not split input sections. A
8134single input section larger than the group size specified will of course
8135create a larger group (of one section). If input sections are too
8136large, it may not be possible for a branch to reach its stub.
8137
8138@cindex PowerPC64 stub symbols
8139@kindex --emit-stub-syms
8140@item --emit-stub-syms
8141This option causes @command{ld} to label linker stubs with a local
8142symbol that encodes the stub type and destination.
8143
8144@cindex PowerPC64 dot symbols
8145@kindex --dotsyms
8146@kindex --no-dotsyms
95421fb9
AM
8147@item --dotsyms
8148@itemx --no-dotsyms
2a60a7a8
AM
8149These two options control how @command{ld} interprets version patterns
8150in a version script. Older PowerPC64 compilers emitted both a
8151function descriptor symbol with the same name as the function, and a
8152code entry symbol with the name prefixed by a dot (@samp{.}). To
8153properly version a function @samp{foo}, the version script thus needs
8154to control both @samp{foo} and @samp{.foo}. The option
8155@samp{--dotsyms}, on by default, automatically adds the required
8156dot-prefixed patterns. Use @samp{--no-dotsyms} to disable this
8157feature.
8158
7ae4ea7d
AM
8159@cindex PowerPC64 register save/restore functions
8160@kindex --save-restore-funcs
8161@kindex --no-save-restore-funcs
95421fb9
AM
8162@item --save-restore-funcs
8163@itemx --no-save-restore-funcs
7ae4ea7d
AM
8164These two options control whether PowerPC64 @command{ld} automatically
8165provides out-of-line register save and restore functions used by
8166@samp{-Os} code. The default is to provide any such referenced
8167function for a normal final link, and to not do so for a relocatable
8168link.
8169
2a60a7a8
AM
8170@cindex PowerPC64 TLS optimization
8171@kindex --no-tls-optimize
8172@item --no-tls-optimize
8173PowerPC64 @command{ld} normally performs some optimization of code
8174sequences used to access Thread-Local Storage. Use this option to
8175disable the optimization.
8176
7c9cf415
AM
8177@cindex PowerPC64 __tls_get_addr optimization
8178@kindex --tls-get-addr-optimize
8179@kindex --no-tls-get-addr-optimize
9e7028aa
AM
8180@kindex --tls-get-addr-regsave
8181@kindex --no-tls-get-addr-regsave
95421fb9
AM
8182@item --tls-get-addr-optimize
8183@itemx --no-tls-get-addr-optimize
9e7028aa 8184These options control how PowerPC64 @command{ld} uses a special
7c9cf415
AM
8185stub to call __tls_get_addr. PowerPC64 glibc 2.22 and later support
8186an optimization that allows the second and subsequent calls to
8187@code{__tls_get_addr} for a given symbol to be resolved by the special
9e7028aa
AM
8188stub without calling in to glibc. By default the linker enables
8189generation of the stub when glibc advertises the availability of
8190__tls_get_addr_opt.
8191Using @option{--tls-get-addr-optimize} with an older glibc won't do
8192much besides slow down your applications, but may be useful if linking
8193an application against an older glibc with the expectation that it
8194will normally be used on systems having a newer glibc.
8195@option{--tls-get-addr-regsave} forces generation of a stub that saves
8196and restores volatile registers around the call into glibc. Normally,
8197this is done when the linker detects a call to __tls_get_addr_desc.
8198Such calls then go via the register saving stub to __tls_get_addr_opt.
5cebc931 8199@option{--no-tls-get-addr-regsave} disables generation of the
9e7028aa 8200register saves.
7c9cf415 8201
2a60a7a8
AM
8202@cindex PowerPC64 OPD optimization
8203@kindex --no-opd-optimize
8204@item --no-opd-optimize
8205PowerPC64 @command{ld} normally removes @code{.opd} section entries
8206corresponding to deleted link-once functions, or functions removed by
e7fc76dd 8207the action of @samp{--gc-sections} or linker script @code{/DISCARD/}.
2a60a7a8
AM
8208Use this option to disable @code{.opd} optimization.
8209
8210@cindex PowerPC64 OPD spacing
8211@kindex --non-overlapping-opd
8212@item --non-overlapping-opd
8213Some PowerPC64 compilers have an option to generate compressed
8214@code{.opd} entries spaced 16 bytes apart, overlapping the third word,
8215the static chain pointer (unused in C) with the first word of the next
8216entry. This option expands such entries to the full 24 bytes.
8217
8218@cindex PowerPC64 TOC optimization
8219@kindex --no-toc-optimize
8220@item --no-toc-optimize
8221PowerPC64 @command{ld} normally removes unused @code{.toc} section
8222entries. Such entries are detected by examining relocations that
8223reference the TOC in code sections. A reloc in a deleted code section
8224marks a TOC word as unneeded, while a reloc in a kept code section
8225marks a TOC word as needed. Since the TOC may reference itself, TOC
8226relocs are also examined. TOC words marked as both needed and
8227unneeded will of course be kept. TOC words without any referencing
8228reloc are assumed to be part of a multi-word entry, and are kept or
8229discarded as per the nearest marked preceding word. This works
8230reliably for compiler generated code, but may be incorrect if assembly
8231code is used to insert TOC entries. Use this option to disable the
8232optimization.
8233
d882c988
AM
8234@cindex PowerPC64 inline PLT call optimization
8235@kindex --no-inline-optimize
8236@item --no-inline-optimize
8237PowerPC64 @command{ld} normally replaces inline PLT call sequences
8238marked with @code{R_PPC64_PLTSEQ}, @code{R_PPC64_PLTCALL},
8239@code{R_PPC64_PLT16_HA} and @code{R_PPC64_PLT16_LO_DS} relocations by
8240a number of @code{nop}s and a direct call when the function is defined
8241locally and can't be overridden by some other definition. This option
8242disables that optimization.
8243
2a60a7a8
AM
8244@cindex PowerPC64 multi-TOC
8245@kindex --no-multi-toc
8246@item --no-multi-toc
794e51c0
AM
8247If given any toc option besides @code{-mcmodel=medium} or
8248@code{-mcmodel=large}, PowerPC64 GCC generates code for a TOC model
8249where TOC
2a60a7a8
AM
8250entries are accessed with a 16-bit offset from r2. This limits the
8251total TOC size to 64K. PowerPC64 @command{ld} extends this limit by
8252grouping code sections such that each group uses less than 64K for its
8253TOC entries, then inserts r2 adjusting stubs between inter-group
8254calls. @command{ld} does not split apart input sections, so cannot
8255help if a single input file has a @code{.toc} section that exceeds
825664K, most likely from linking multiple files with @command{ld -r}.
8257Use this option to turn off this feature.
794e51c0
AM
8258
8259@cindex PowerPC64 TOC sorting
8260@kindex --no-toc-sort
8261@item --no-toc-sort
8262By default, @command{ld} sorts TOC sections so that those whose file
8263happens to have a section called @code{.init} or @code{.fini} are
8264placed first, followed by TOC sections referenced by code generated
8265with PowerPC64 gcc's @code{-mcmodel=small}, and lastly TOC sections
8266referenced only by code generated with PowerPC64 gcc's
8267@code{-mcmodel=medium} or @code{-mcmodel=large} options. Doing this
8268results in better TOC grouping for multi-TOC. Use this option to turn
8269off this feature.
8270
8271@cindex PowerPC64 PLT stub alignment
8272@kindex --plt-align
8273@kindex --no-plt-align
8274@item --plt-align
8275@itemx --no-plt-align
8276Use these options to control whether individual PLT call stubs are
2420fff6
AM
8277aligned to a 32-byte boundary, or to the specified power of two
8278boundary when using @code{--plt-align=}. A negative value may be
8279specified to pad PLT call stubs so that they do not cross the
8280specified power of two boundary (or the minimum number of boundaries
8281if a PLT stub is so large that it must cross a boundary). By default
8282PLT call stubs are aligned to 32-byte boundaries.
794e51c0
AM
8283
8284@cindex PowerPC64 PLT call stub static chain
8285@kindex --plt-static-chain
8286@kindex --no-plt-static-chain
8287@item --plt-static-chain
8288@itemx --no-plt-static-chain
8289Use these options to control whether PLT call stubs load the static
8290chain pointer (r11). @code{ld} defaults to not loading the static
8291chain since there is never any need to do so on a PLT call.
8292
8293@cindex PowerPC64 PLT call stub thread safety
8294@kindex --plt-thread-safe
8295@kindex --no-plt-thread-safe
8296@item --plt-thread-safe
1be5d8d3 8297@itemx --no-plt-thread-safe
794e51c0
AM
8298With power7's weakly ordered memory model, it is possible when using
8299lazy binding for ld.so to update a plt entry in one thread and have
8300another thread see the individual plt entry words update in the wrong
8301order, despite ld.so carefully writing in the correct order and using
8302memory write barriers. To avoid this we need some sort of read
8303barrier in the call stub, or use LD_BIND_NOW=1. By default, @code{ld}
8304looks for calls to commonly used functions that create threads, and if
8305seen, adds the necessary barriers. Use these options to change the
8306default behaviour.
8b5f1ed8
AM
8307
8308@cindex PowerPC64 ELFv2 PLT localentry optimization
8309@kindex --plt-localentry
8310@kindex --no-plt-localentry
8311@item --plt-localentry
8312@itemx --no-localentry
8313ELFv2 functions with localentry:0 are those with a single entry point,
8314ie. global entry == local entry, and that have no requirement on r2
8315(the TOC/GOT pointer) or r12, and guarantee r2 is unchanged on return.
8316Such an external function can be called via the PLT without saving r2
8317or restoring it on return, avoiding a common load-hit-store for small
8318functions. The optimization is attractive, with up to 40% reduction
8319in execution time for a small function, but can result in symbol
d44c746a
AM
8320interposition failures. Also, minor changes in a shared library,
8321including system libraries, can cause a function that was localentry:0
8322to become localentry:8. This will result in a dynamic loader
8323complaint and failure to run. The option is experimental, use with
8324care. @option{--no-plt-localentry} is the default.
d882c988
AM
8325
8326@cindex PowerPC64 Power10 stubs
8327@kindex --power10-stubs
8328@kindex --no-power10-stubs
8329@item --power10-stubs
8330@itemx --no-power10-stubs
8331When PowerPC64 @command{ld} links input object files containing
8332relocations used on power10 prefixed instructions it normally creates
e10a07b3
AM
8333linkage stubs (PLT call and long branch) using power10 instructions
8334for @code{@@notoc} PLT calls where @code{r2} is not known. The
8335power10 notoc stubs are smaller and faster, so are preferred for
d882c988
AM
8336power10. @option{--power10-stubs} and @option{--no-power10-stubs}
8337allow you to override the linker's selection of stub instructions.
e10a07b3
AM
8338@option{--power10-stubs=auto} allows the user to select the default
8339auto mode.
2a60a7a8
AM
8340@end table
8341
8342@ifclear GENERIC
8343@lowersections
8344@end ifclear
8345@end ifset
8346
b4cbbe8f
AK
8347@ifset S/390
8348@ifclear GENERIC
8349@raisesections
8350@end ifclear
8351
8352@node S/390 ELF
8353@section @command{ld} and S/390 ELF Support
8354
8355@cindex S/390 ELF options
8356@table @option
8357
8358@cindex S/390
8359@kindex --s390-pgste
8360@item --s390-pgste
8361This option marks the result file with a @code{PT_S390_PGSTE}
8362segment. The Linux kernel is supposed to allocate 4k page tables for
8363binaries marked that way.
8364@end table
8365
8366@ifclear GENERIC
8367@lowersections
8368@end ifclear
8369@end ifset
8370
49fa1e15
AM
8371@ifset SPU
8372@ifclear GENERIC
8373@raisesections
8374@end ifclear
8375
8376@node SPU ELF
8377@section @command{ld} and SPU ELF Support
8378
8379@cindex SPU ELF options
8380@table @option
8381
8382@cindex SPU plugins
8383@kindex --plugin
8384@item --plugin
8385This option marks an executable as a PIC plugin module.
8386
8387@cindex SPU overlays
8388@kindex --no-overlays
8389@item --no-overlays
8390Normally, @command{ld} recognizes calls to functions within overlay
8391regions, and redirects such calls to an overlay manager via a stub.
8392@command{ld} also provides a built-in overlay manager. This option
8393turns off all this special overlay handling.
8394
8395@cindex SPU overlay stub symbols
8396@kindex --emit-stub-syms
8397@item --emit-stub-syms
8398This option causes @command{ld} to label overlay stubs with a local
8399symbol that encodes the stub type and destination.
8400
8401@cindex SPU extra overlay stubs
8402@kindex --extra-overlay-stubs
8403@item --extra-overlay-stubs
8404This option causes @command{ld} to add overlay call stubs on all
8405function calls out of overlay regions. Normally stubs are not added
8406on calls to non-overlay regions.
8407
8408@cindex SPU local store size
8409@kindex --local-store=lo:hi
8410@item --local-store=lo:hi
8411@command{ld} usually checks that a final executable for SPU fits in
8412the address range 0 to 256k. This option may be used to change the
8413range. Disable the check entirely with @option{--local-store=0:0}.
8414
c0065db7 8415@cindex SPU
49fa1e15
AM
8416@kindex --stack-analysis
8417@item --stack-analysis
8418SPU local store space is limited. Over-allocation of stack space
8419unnecessarily limits space available for code and data, while
8420under-allocation results in runtime failures. If given this option,
8421@command{ld} will provide an estimate of maximum stack usage.
8422@command{ld} does this by examining symbols in code sections to
8423determine the extents of functions, and looking at function prologues
8424for stack adjusting instructions. A call-graph is created by looking
8425for relocations on branch instructions. The graph is then searched
8426for the maximum stack usage path. Note that this analysis does not
8427find calls made via function pointers, and does not handle recursion
8428and other cycles in the call graph. Stack usage may be
8429under-estimated if your code makes such calls. Also, stack usage for
8430dynamic allocation, e.g. alloca, will not be detected. If a link map
8431is requested, detailed information about each function's stack usage
8432and calls will be given.
8433
c0065db7 8434@cindex SPU
49fa1e15
AM
8435@kindex --emit-stack-syms
8436@item --emit-stack-syms
8437This option, if given along with @option{--stack-analysis} will result
8438in @command{ld} emitting stack sizing symbols for each function.
8439These take the form @code{__stack_<function_name>} for global
8440functions, and @code{__stack_<number>_<function_name>} for static
8441functions. @code{<number>} is the section id in hex. The value of
8442such symbols is the stack requirement for the corresponding function.
8443The symbol size will be zero, type @code{STT_NOTYPE}, binding
c0065db7 8444@code{STB_LOCAL}, and section @code{SHN_ABS}.
49fa1e15
AM
8445@end table
8446
8447@ifclear GENERIC
8448@lowersections
8449@end ifclear
8450@end ifset
8451
36f63dca
NC
8452@ifset TICOFF
8453@ifclear GENERIC
8454@raisesections
8455@end ifclear
8456
8457@node TI COFF
8458@section @command{ld}'s Support for Various TI COFF Versions
8459@cindex TI COFF versions
8460@kindex --format=@var{version}
8461The @samp{--format} switch allows selection of one of the various
8462TI COFF versions. The latest of this writing is 2; versions 0 and 1 are
8463also supported. The TI COFF versions also vary in header byte-order
8464format; @command{ld} will read any version or byte order, but the output
8465header format depends on the default specified by the specific target.
8466
8467@ifclear GENERIC
8468@lowersections
8469@end ifclear
8470@end ifset
8471
2ca22b03
NC
8472@ifset WIN32
8473@ifclear GENERIC
8474@raisesections
8475@end ifclear
8476
8477@node WIN32
8478@section @command{ld} and WIN32 (cygwin/mingw)
8479
c0065db7 8480This section describes some of the win32 specific @command{ld} issues.
a05a5b64
TP
8481See @ref{Options,,Command-line Options} for detailed description of the
8482command-line options mentioned here.
2ca22b03
NC
8483
8484@table @emph
c0065db7
RM
8485@cindex import libraries
8486@item import libraries
69da35b5 8487The standard Windows linker creates and uses so-called import
2ca22b03 8488libraries, which contains information for linking to dll's. They are
69da35b5
NC
8489regular static archives and are handled as any other static
8490archive. The cygwin and mingw ports of @command{ld} have specific
2ca22b03 8491support for creating such libraries provided with the
a05a5b64 8492@samp{--out-implib} command-line option.
2ca22b03 8493
c0065db7
RM
8494@item exporting DLL symbols
8495@cindex exporting DLL symbols
dc8465bf
NC
8496The cygwin/mingw @command{ld} has several ways to export symbols for dll's.
8497
8498@table @emph
8499@item using auto-export functionality
8500@cindex using auto-export functionality
8501By default @command{ld} exports symbols with the auto-export functionality,
a05a5b64 8502which is controlled by the following command-line options:
dc8465bf 8503
0a5d968e
NC
8504@itemize
8505@item --export-all-symbols [This is the default]
8506@item --exclude-symbols
8507@item --exclude-libs
e1c37eb5 8508@item --exclude-modules-for-implib
09e2aba4 8509@item --version-script
0a5d968e
NC
8510@end itemize
8511
09e2aba4
DK
8512When auto-export is in operation, @command{ld} will export all the non-local
8513(global and common) symbols it finds in a DLL, with the exception of a few
8514symbols known to belong to the system's runtime and libraries. As it will
8515often not be desirable to export all of a DLL's symbols, which may include
8516private functions that are not part of any public interface, the command-line
9d5777a3 8517options listed above may be used to filter symbols out from the list for
09e2aba4
DK
8518exporting. The @samp{--output-def} option can be used in order to see the
8519final list of exported symbols with all exclusions taken into effect.
8520
8521If @samp{--export-all-symbols} is not given explicitly on the
0a5d968e
NC
8522command line, then the default auto-export behavior will be @emph{disabled}
8523if either of the following are true:
8524
8525@itemize
8526@item A DEF file is used.
8527@item Any symbol in any object file was marked with the __declspec(dllexport) attribute.
8528@end itemize
dc8465bf 8529
c0065db7
RM
8530@item using a DEF file
8531@cindex using a DEF file
dc8465bf
NC
8532Another way of exporting symbols is using a DEF file. A DEF file is
8533an ASCII file containing definitions of symbols which should be
8534exported when a dll is created. Usually it is named @samp{<dll
8535name>.def} and is added as any other object file to the linker's
0a5d968e 8536command line. The file's name must end in @samp{.def} or @samp{.DEF}.
dc8465bf
NC
8537
8538@example
8539gcc -o <output> <objectfiles> <dll name>.def
8540@end example
8541
0a5d968e
NC
8542Using a DEF file turns off the normal auto-export behavior, unless the
8543@samp{--export-all-symbols} option is also used.
8544
dc8465bf
NC
8545Here is an example of a DEF file for a shared library called @samp{xyz.dll}:
8546
8547@example
4b5bd4e7 8548LIBRARY "xyz.dll" BASE=0x20000000
dc8465bf
NC
8549
8550EXPORTS
8551foo
8552bar
8553_bar = bar
4b5bd4e7
DS
8554another_foo = abc.dll.afoo
8555var1 DATA
7fcab871
KT
8556doo = foo == foo2
8557eoo DATA == var1
c0065db7 8558@end example
dc8465bf 8559
7fcab871 8560This example defines a DLL with a non-default base address and seven
4b5bd4e7
DS
8561symbols in the export table. The third exported symbol @code{_bar} is an
8562alias for the second. The fourth symbol, @code{another_foo} is resolved
8563by "forwarding" to another module and treating it as an alias for
8564@code{afoo} exported from the DLL @samp{abc.dll}. The final symbol
7fcab871
KT
8565@code{var1} is declared to be a data object. The @samp{doo} symbol in
8566export library is an alias of @samp{foo}, which gets the string name
8567in export table @samp{foo2}. The @samp{eoo} symbol is an data export
8568symbol, which gets in export table the name @samp{var1}.
4b5bd4e7 8569
6b31ad16
DS
8570The optional @code{LIBRARY <name>} command indicates the @emph{internal}
8571name of the output DLL. If @samp{<name>} does not include a suffix,
8572the default library suffix, @samp{.DLL} is appended.
8573
b45619c0
NC
8574When the .DEF file is used to build an application, rather than a
8575library, the @code{NAME <name>} command should be used instead of
6b31ad16 8576@code{LIBRARY}. If @samp{<name>} does not include a suffix, the default
c0065db7 8577executable suffix, @samp{.EXE} is appended.
6b31ad16
DS
8578
8579With either @code{LIBRARY <name>} or @code{NAME <name>} the optional
8580specification @code{BASE = <number>} may be used to specify a
c0065db7 8581non-default base address for the image.
6b31ad16
DS
8582
8583If neither @code{LIBRARY <name>} nor @code{NAME <name>} is specified,
a2877985
DS
8584or they specify an empty string, the internal name is the same as the
8585filename specified on the command line.
6b31ad16 8586
4b5bd4e7
DS
8587The complete specification of an export symbol is:
8588
8589@example
8590EXPORTS
8591 ( ( ( <name1> [ = <name2> ] )
8592 | ( <name1> = <module-name> . <external-name>))
7fcab871 8593 [ @@ <integer> ] [NONAME] [DATA] [CONSTANT] [PRIVATE] [== <name3>] ) *
c0065db7 8594@end example
4b5bd4e7
DS
8595
8596Declares @samp{<name1>} as an exported symbol from the DLL, or declares
8597@samp{<name1>} as an exported alias for @samp{<name2>}; or declares
8598@samp{<name1>} as a "forward" alias for the symbol
8599@samp{<external-name>} in the DLL @samp{<module-name>}.
8600Optionally, the symbol may be exported by the specified ordinal
7fcab871
KT
8601@samp{<integer>} alias. The optional @samp{<name3>} is the to be used
8602string in import/export table for the symbol.
4b5bd4e7
DS
8603
8604The optional keywords that follow the declaration indicate:
8605
8606@code{NONAME}: Do not put the symbol name in the DLL's export table. It
8607will still be exported by its ordinal alias (either the value specified
8608by the .def specification or, otherwise, the value assigned by the
8609linker). The symbol name, however, does remain visible in the import
8610library (if any), unless @code{PRIVATE} is also specified.
8611
8612@code{DATA}: The symbol is a variable or object, rather than a function.
8613The import lib will export only an indirect reference to @code{foo} as
8614the symbol @code{_imp__foo} (ie, @code{foo} must be resolved as
8615@code{*_imp__foo}).
8616
8617@code{CONSTANT}: Like @code{DATA}, but put the undecorated @code{foo} as
8618well as @code{_imp__foo} into the import library. Both refer to the
8619read-only import address table's pointer to the variable, not to the
8620variable itself. This can be dangerous. If the user code fails to add
8621the @code{dllimport} attribute and also fails to explicitly add the
8622extra indirection that the use of the attribute enforces, the
8623application will behave unexpectedly.
8624
8625@code{PRIVATE}: Put the symbol in the DLL's export table, but do not put
8626it into the static import library used to resolve imports at link time. The
8627symbol can still be imported using the @code{LoadLibrary/GetProcAddress}
de194d85 8628API at runtime or by using the GNU ld extension of linking directly to
4b5bd4e7 8629the DLL without an import library.
c0065db7 8630
4b5bd4e7
DS
8631See ld/deffilep.y in the binutils sources for the full specification of
8632other DEF file statements
dc8465bf
NC
8633
8634@cindex creating a DEF file
8635While linking a shared dll, @command{ld} is able to create a DEF file
a05a5b64 8636with the @samp{--output-def <file>} command-line option.
0a5d968e
NC
8637
8638@item Using decorations
8639@cindex Using decorations
8640Another way of marking symbols for export is to modify the source code
8641itself, so that when building the DLL each symbol to be exported is
8642declared as:
8643
8644@example
8645__declspec(dllexport) int a_variable
8646__declspec(dllexport) void a_function(int with_args)
8647@end example
8648
8649All such symbols will be exported from the DLL. If, however,
8650any of the object files in the DLL contain symbols decorated in
8651this way, then the normal auto-export behavior is disabled, unless
8652the @samp{--export-all-symbols} option is also used.
8653
8654Note that object files that wish to access these symbols must @emph{not}
c0065db7 8655decorate them with dllexport. Instead, they should use dllimport,
0a5d968e
NC
8656instead:
8657
8658@example
8659__declspec(dllimport) int a_variable
8660__declspec(dllimport) void a_function(int with_args)
8661@end example
8662
c0065db7
RM
8663This complicates the structure of library header files, because
8664when included by the library itself the header must declare the
0a5d968e
NC
8665variables and functions as dllexport, but when included by client
8666code the header must declare them as dllimport. There are a number
c0065db7 8667of idioms that are typically used to do this; often client code can
0a5d968e
NC
8668omit the __declspec() declaration completely. See
8669@samp{--enable-auto-import} and @samp{automatic data imports} for more
b45619c0 8670information.
c0065db7 8671@end table
dc8465bf 8672
2ca22b03
NC
8673@cindex automatic data imports
8674@item automatic data imports
8675The standard Windows dll format supports data imports from dlls only
69da35b5 8676by adding special decorations (dllimport/dllexport), which let the
2ca22b03 8677compiler produce specific assembler instructions to deal with this
c0065db7 8678issue. This increases the effort necessary to port existing Un*x
69da35b5 8679code to these platforms, especially for large
2ca22b03 8680c++ libraries and applications. The auto-import feature, which was
c0065db7 8681initially provided by Paul Sokolovsky, allows one to omit the
b45619c0 8682decorations to achieve a behavior that conforms to that on POSIX/Un*x
c0065db7 8683platforms. This feature is enabled with the @samp{--enable-auto-import}
69da35b5
NC
8684command-line option, although it is enabled by default on cygwin/mingw.
8685The @samp{--enable-auto-import} option itself now serves mainly to
8686suppress any warnings that are ordinarily emitted when linked objects
8687trigger the feature's use.
8688
c0065db7 8689auto-import of variables does not always work flawlessly without
69da35b5
NC
8690additional assistance. Sometimes, you will see this message
8691
c0065db7 8692"variable '<var>' can't be auto-imported. Please read the
69da35b5
NC
8693documentation for ld's @code{--enable-auto-import} for details."
8694
c0065db7
RM
8695The @samp{--enable-auto-import} documentation explains why this error
8696occurs, and several methods that can be used to overcome this difficulty.
8697One of these methods is the @emph{runtime pseudo-relocs} feature, described
69da35b5
NC
8698below.
8699
8700@cindex runtime pseudo-relocation
c0065db7
RM
8701For complex variables imported from DLLs (such as structs or classes),
8702object files typically contain a base address for the variable and an
8703offset (@emph{addend}) within the variable--to specify a particular
8704field or public member, for instance. Unfortunately, the runtime loader used
8705in win32 environments is incapable of fixing these references at runtime
69da35b5 8706without the additional information supplied by dllimport/dllexport decorations.
c0065db7 8707The standard auto-import feature described above is unable to resolve these
69da35b5
NC
8708references.
8709
c0065db7
RM
8710The @samp{--enable-runtime-pseudo-relocs} switch allows these references to
8711be resolved without error, while leaving the task of adjusting the references
8712themselves (with their non-zero addends) to specialized code provided by the
8713runtime environment. Recent versions of the cygwin and mingw environments and
8714compilers provide this runtime support; older versions do not. However, the
8715support is only necessary on the developer's platform; the compiled result will
69da35b5
NC
8716run without error on an older system.
8717
c0065db7
RM
8718@samp{--enable-runtime-pseudo-relocs} is not the default; it must be explicitly
8719enabled as needed.
2ca22b03
NC
8720
8721@cindex direct linking to a dll
8722@item direct linking to a dll
8723The cygwin/mingw ports of @command{ld} support the direct linking,
8724including data symbols, to a dll without the usage of any import
69da35b5 8725libraries. This is much faster and uses much less memory than does the
b45619c0 8726traditional import library method, especially when linking large
c0065db7
RM
8727libraries or applications. When @command{ld} creates an import lib, each
8728function or variable exported from the dll is stored in its own bfd, even
8729though a single bfd could contain many exports. The overhead involved in
69da35b5 8730storing, loading, and processing so many bfd's is quite large, and explains the
c0065db7 8731tremendous time, memory, and storage needed to link against particularly
69da35b5
NC
8732large or complex libraries when using import libs.
8733
c0065db7 8734Linking directly to a dll uses no extra command-line switches other than
69da35b5 8735@samp{-L} and @samp{-l}, because @command{ld} already searches for a number
c0065db7 8736of names to match each library. All that is needed from the developer's
69da35b5
NC
8737perspective is an understanding of this search, in order to force ld to
8738select the dll instead of an import library.
8739
2ca22b03 8740
69da35b5
NC
8741For instance, when ld is called with the argument @samp{-lxxx} it will attempt
8742to find, in the first directory of its search path,
2ca22b03
NC
8743
8744@example
45e948fe
NC
8745libxxx.dll.a
8746xxx.dll.a
8747libxxx.a
8748xxx.lib
f6c4d4b1 8749libxxx.lib
69da35b5 8750cygxxx.dll (*)
45e948fe
NC
8751libxxx.dll
8752xxx.dll
2ca22b03
NC
8753@end example
8754
69da35b5
NC
8755before moving on to the next directory in the search path.
8756
c0065db7
RM
8757(*) Actually, this is not @samp{cygxxx.dll} but in fact is @samp{<prefix>xxx.dll},
8758where @samp{<prefix>} is set by the @command{ld} option
8759@samp{--dll-search-prefix=<prefix>}. In the case of cygwin, the standard gcc spec
8760file includes @samp{--dll-search-prefix=cyg}, so in effect we actually search for
69da35b5
NC
8761@samp{cygxxx.dll}.
8762
c0065db7
RM
8763Other win32-based unix environments, such as mingw or pw32, may use other
8764@samp{<prefix>}es, although at present only cygwin makes use of this feature. It
69da35b5
NC
8765was originally intended to help avoid name conflicts among dll's built for the
8766various win32/un*x environments, so that (for example) two versions of a zlib dll
8767could coexist on the same machine.
8768
2ca22b03
NC
8769The generic cygwin/mingw path layout uses a @samp{bin} directory for
8770applications and dll's and a @samp{lib} directory for the import
69da35b5 8771libraries (using cygwin nomenclature):
2ca22b03
NC
8772
8773@example
8774bin/
8775 cygxxx.dll
8776lib/
8777 libxxx.dll.a (in case of dll's)
c0065db7 8778 libxxx.a (in case of static archive)
2ca22b03
NC
8779@end example
8780
c0065db7
RM
8781Linking directly to a dll without using the import library can be
8782done two ways:
2ca22b03
NC
8783
87841. Use the dll directly by adding the @samp{bin} path to the link line
8785@example
8786gcc -Wl,-verbose -o a.exe -L../bin/ -lxxx
c0065db7 8787@end example
2ca22b03 8788
69da35b5
NC
8789However, as the dll's often have version numbers appended to their names
8790(@samp{cygncurses-5.dll}) this will often fail, unless one specifies
8791@samp{-L../bin -lncurses-5} to include the version. Import libs are generally
8792not versioned, and do not have this difficulty.
8793
2ca22b03
NC
87942. Create a symbolic link from the dll to a file in the @samp{lib}
8795directory according to the above mentioned search pattern. This
8796should be used to avoid unwanted changes in the tools needed for
8797making the app/dll.
8798
8799@example
8800ln -s bin/cygxxx.dll lib/[cyg|lib|]xxx.dll[.a]
c0065db7 8801@end example
2ca22b03
NC
8802
8803Then you can link without any make environment changes.
8804
8805@example
8806gcc -Wl,-verbose -o a.exe -L../lib/ -lxxx
c0065db7 8807@end example
69da35b5
NC
8808
8809This technique also avoids the version number problems, because the following is
8810perfectly legal
8811
8812@example
8813bin/
8814 cygxxx-5.dll
8815lib/
c0065db7 8816 libxxx.dll.a -> ../bin/cygxxx-5.dll
69da35b5
NC
8817@end example
8818
dc8465bf 8819Linking directly to a dll without using an import lib will work
69da35b5
NC
8820even when auto-import features are exercised, and even when
8821@samp{--enable-runtime-pseudo-relocs} is used.
8822
8823Given the improvements in speed and memory usage, one might justifiably
45e948fe 8824wonder why import libraries are used at all. There are three reasons:
69da35b5
NC
8825
88261. Until recently, the link-directly-to-dll functionality did @emph{not}
8827work with auto-imported data.
8828
dc8465bf
NC
88292. Sometimes it is necessary to include pure static objects within the
8830import library (which otherwise contains only bfd's for indirection
8831symbols that point to the exports of a dll). Again, the import lib
8832for the cygwin kernel makes use of this ability, and it is not
8833possible to do this without an import lib.
69da35b5 8834
45e948fe
NC
88353. Symbol aliases can only be resolved using an import lib. This is
8836critical when linking against OS-supplied dll's (eg, the win32 API)
8837in which symbols are usually exported as undecorated aliases of their
8838stdcall-decorated assembly names.
8839
69da35b5 8840So, import libs are not going away. But the ability to replace
c0065db7
RM
8841true import libs with a simple symbolic link to (or a copy of)
8842a dll, in many cases, is a useful addition to the suite of tools
8843binutils makes available to the win32 developer. Given the
69da35b5
NC
8844massive improvements in memory requirements during linking, storage
8845requirements, and linking speed, we expect that many developers
8846will soon begin to use this feature whenever possible.
dc8465bf 8847
c0065db7 8848@item symbol aliasing
dc8465bf 8849@table @emph
c0065db7
RM
8850@item adding additional names
8851Sometimes, it is useful to export symbols with additional names.
dc8465bf
NC
8852A symbol @samp{foo} will be exported as @samp{foo}, but it can also be
8853exported as @samp{_foo} by using special directives in the DEF file
8854when creating the dll. This will affect also the optional created
c0065db7 8855import library. Consider the following DEF file:
dc8465bf 8856
c0065db7 8857@example
dc8465bf
NC
8858LIBRARY "xyz.dll" BASE=0x61000000
8859
8860EXPORTS
c0065db7 8861foo
dc8465bf 8862_foo = foo
c0065db7 8863@end example
dc8465bf
NC
8864
8865The line @samp{_foo = foo} maps the symbol @samp{foo} to @samp{_foo}.
8866
8867Another method for creating a symbol alias is to create it in the
8868source code using the "weak" attribute:
8869
c0065db7
RM
8870@example
8871void foo () @{ /* Do something. */; @}
dc8465bf 8872void _foo () __attribute__ ((weak, alias ("foo")));
c0065db7 8873@end example
dc8465bf
NC
8874
8875See the gcc manual for more information about attributes and weak
8876symbols.
8877
8878@item renaming symbols
8879Sometimes it is useful to rename exports. For instance, the cygwin
c0065db7 8880kernel does this regularly. A symbol @samp{_foo} can be exported as
dc8465bf
NC
8881@samp{foo} but not as @samp{_foo} by using special directives in the
8882DEF file. (This will also affect the import library, if it is
c0065db7 8883created). In the following example:
dc8465bf 8884
c0065db7 8885@example
dc8465bf
NC
8886LIBRARY "xyz.dll" BASE=0x61000000
8887
8888EXPORTS
8889_foo = foo
c0065db7 8890@end example
dc8465bf
NC
8891
8892The line @samp{_foo = foo} maps the exported symbol @samp{foo} to
8893@samp{_foo}.
c0065db7 8894@end table
dc8465bf 8895
0a5d968e 8896Note: using a DEF file disables the default auto-export behavior,
a05a5b64 8897unless the @samp{--export-all-symbols} command-line option is used.
0a5d968e 8898If, however, you are trying to rename symbols, then you should list
c0065db7
RM
8899@emph{all} desired exports in the DEF file, including the symbols
8900that are not being renamed, and do @emph{not} use the
8901@samp{--export-all-symbols} option. If you list only the
8902renamed symbols in the DEF file, and use @samp{--export-all-symbols}
8903to handle the other symbols, then the both the new names @emph{and}
8904the original names for the renamed symbols will be exported.
8905In effect, you'd be aliasing those symbols, not renaming them,
0a5d968e 8906which is probably not what you wanted.
c87db184
CF
8907
8908@cindex weak externals
8909@item weak externals
8910The Windows object format, PE, specifies a form of weak symbols called
8911weak externals. When a weak symbol is linked and the symbol is not
8912defined, the weak symbol becomes an alias for some other symbol. There
8913are three variants of weak externals:
8914@itemize
8915@item Definition is searched for in objects and libraries, historically
8916called lazy externals.
8917@item Definition is searched for only in other objects, not in libraries.
8918This form is not presently implemented.
8919@item No search; the symbol is an alias. This form is not presently
8920implemented.
8921@end itemize
8922As a GNU extension, weak symbols that do not specify an alternate symbol
8923are supported. If the symbol is undefined when linking, the symbol
8924uses a default value.
c1711530
DK
8925
8926@cindex aligned common symbols
8927@item aligned common symbols
8928As a GNU extension to the PE file format, it is possible to specify the
8929desired alignment for a common symbol. This information is conveyed from
8930the assembler or compiler to the linker by means of GNU-specific commands
8931carried in the object file's @samp{.drectve} section, which are recognized
8932by @command{ld} and respected when laying out the common symbols. Native
8933tools will be able to process object files employing this GNU extension,
8934but will fail to respect the alignment instructions, and may issue noisy
8935warnings about unknown linker directives.
5063daf7 8936
2ca22b03
NC
8937@end table
8938
8939@ifclear GENERIC
8940@lowersections
8941@end ifclear
8942@end ifset
8943
e0001a05
NC
8944@ifset XTENSA
8945@ifclear GENERIC
8946@raisesections
8947@end ifclear
8948
8949@node Xtensa
8950@section @code{ld} and Xtensa Processors
8951
8952@cindex Xtensa processors
8953The default @command{ld} behavior for Xtensa processors is to interpret
8954@code{SECTIONS} commands so that lists of explicitly named sections in a
8955specification with a wildcard file will be interleaved when necessary to
8956keep literal pools within the range of PC-relative load offsets. For
8957example, with the command:
8958
8959@smallexample
8960SECTIONS
8961@{
8962 .text : @{
8963 *(.literal .text)
8964 @}
8965@}
8966@end smallexample
8967
8968@noindent
8969@command{ld} may interleave some of the @code{.literal}
8970and @code{.text} sections from different object files to ensure that the
8971literal pools are within the range of PC-relative load offsets. A valid
8972interleaving might place the @code{.literal} sections from an initial
8973group of files followed by the @code{.text} sections of that group of
8974files. Then, the @code{.literal} sections from the rest of the files
8975and the @code{.text} sections from the rest of the files would follow.
e0001a05 8976
43cd72b9 8977@cindex @option{--relax} on Xtensa
e0001a05 8978@cindex relaxing on Xtensa
43cd72b9
BW
8979Relaxation is enabled by default for the Xtensa version of @command{ld} and
8980provides two important link-time optimizations. The first optimization
8981is to combine identical literal values to reduce code size. A redundant
8982literal will be removed and all the @code{L32R} instructions that use it
8983will be changed to reference an identical literal, as long as the
8984location of the replacement literal is within the offset range of all
8985the @code{L32R} instructions. The second optimization is to remove
8986unnecessary overhead from assembler-generated ``longcall'' sequences of
8987@code{L32R}/@code{CALLX@var{n}} when the target functions are within
8988range of direct @code{CALL@var{n}} instructions.
8989
8990For each of these cases where an indirect call sequence can be optimized
8991to a direct call, the linker will change the @code{CALLX@var{n}}
8992instruction to a @code{CALL@var{n}} instruction, remove the @code{L32R}
8993instruction, and remove the literal referenced by the @code{L32R}
8994instruction if it is not used for anything else. Removing the
8995@code{L32R} instruction always reduces code size but can potentially
8996hurt performance by changing the alignment of subsequent branch targets.
8997By default, the linker will always preserve alignments, either by
8998switching some instructions between 24-bit encodings and the equivalent
8999density instructions or by inserting a no-op in place of the @code{L32R}
9000instruction that was removed. If code size is more important than
9001performance, the @option{--size-opt} option can be used to prevent the
9002linker from widening density instructions or inserting no-ops, except in
9003a few cases where no-ops are required for correctness.
9004
9005The following Xtensa-specific command-line options can be used to
9006control the linker:
9007
9008@cindex Xtensa options
9009@table @option
43cd72b9
BW
9010@item --size-opt
9011When optimizing indirect calls to direct calls, optimize for code size
9012more than performance. With this option, the linker will not insert
9013no-ops or widen density instructions to preserve branch target
9014alignment. There may still be some cases where no-ops are required to
9015preserve the correctness of the code.
7a77f1ac
MF
9016
9017@item --abi-windowed
9018@itemx --abi-call0
9019Choose ABI for the output object and for the generated PLT code.
9020PLT code inserted by the linker must match ABI of the output object
9021because windowed and call0 ABI use incompatible function call
9022conventions.
9023Default ABI is chosen by the ABI tag in the @code{.xtensa.info} section
9024of the first input object.
9025A warning is issued if ABI tags of input objects do not match each other
9026or the chosen output object ABI.
43cd72b9 9027@end table
e0001a05
NC
9028
9029@ifclear GENERIC
9030@lowersections
9031@end ifclear
9032@end ifset
9033
252b5132
RH
9034@ifclear SingleFormat
9035@node BFD
9036@chapter BFD
9037
9038@cindex back end
9039@cindex object file management
9040@cindex object formats available
9041@kindex objdump -i
9042The linker accesses object and archive files using the BFD libraries.
9043These libraries allow the linker to use the same routines to operate on
9044object files whatever the object file format. A different object file
9045format can be supported simply by creating a new BFD back end and adding
9046it to the library. To conserve runtime memory, however, the linker and
9047associated tools are usually configured to support only a subset of the
9048object file formats available. You can use @code{objdump -i}
9049(@pxref{objdump,,objdump,binutils.info,The GNU Binary Utilities}) to
9050list all the formats available for your configuration.
9051
9052@cindex BFD requirements
9053@cindex requirements for BFD
9054As with most implementations, BFD is a compromise between
9055several conflicting requirements. The major factor influencing
9056BFD design was efficiency: any time used converting between
9057formats is time which would not have been spent had BFD not
9058been involved. This is partly offset by abstraction payback; since
9059BFD simplifies applications and back ends, more time and care
9060may be spent optimizing algorithms for a greater speed.
9061
9062One minor artifact of the BFD solution which you should bear in
9063mind is the potential for information loss. There are two places where
9064useful information can be lost using the BFD mechanism: during
9065conversion and during output. @xref{BFD information loss}.
9066
9067@menu
9068* BFD outline:: How it works: an outline of BFD
9069@end menu
9070
9071@node BFD outline
36f63dca 9072@section How It Works: An Outline of BFD
252b5132
RH
9073@cindex opening object files
9074@include bfdsumm.texi
9075@end ifclear
9076
9077@node Reporting Bugs
9078@chapter Reporting Bugs
ff5dcc92
SC
9079@cindex bugs in @command{ld}
9080@cindex reporting bugs in @command{ld}
252b5132 9081
ff5dcc92 9082Your bug reports play an essential role in making @command{ld} reliable.
252b5132
RH
9083
9084Reporting a bug may help you by bringing a solution to your problem, or
9085it may not. But in any case the principal function of a bug report is
ff5dcc92 9086to help the entire community by making the next version of @command{ld}
252b5132 9087work better. Bug reports are your contribution to the maintenance of
ff5dcc92 9088@command{ld}.
252b5132
RH
9089
9090In order for a bug report to serve its purpose, you must include the
9091information that enables us to fix the bug.
9092
9093@menu
9094* Bug Criteria:: Have you found a bug?
9095* Bug Reporting:: How to report bugs
9096@end menu
9097
9098@node Bug Criteria
36f63dca 9099@section Have You Found a Bug?
252b5132
RH
9100@cindex bug criteria
9101
9102If you are not sure whether you have found a bug, here are some guidelines:
9103
9104@itemize @bullet
9105@cindex fatal signal
9106@cindex linker crash
9107@cindex crash of linker
9108@item
9109If the linker gets a fatal signal, for any input whatever, that is a
ff5dcc92 9110@command{ld} bug. Reliable linkers never crash.
252b5132
RH
9111
9112@cindex error on valid input
9113@item
ff5dcc92 9114If @command{ld} produces an error message for valid input, that is a bug.
252b5132
RH
9115
9116@cindex invalid input
9117@item
ff5dcc92 9118If @command{ld} does not produce an error message for invalid input, that
252b5132
RH
9119may be a bug. In the general case, the linker can not verify that
9120object files are correct.
9121
9122@item
9123If you are an experienced user of linkers, your suggestions for
ff5dcc92 9124improvement of @command{ld} are welcome in any case.
252b5132
RH
9125@end itemize
9126
9127@node Bug Reporting
36f63dca 9128@section How to Report Bugs
252b5132 9129@cindex bug reports
ff5dcc92 9130@cindex @command{ld} bugs, reporting
252b5132
RH
9131
9132A number of companies and individuals offer support for @sc{gnu}
ff5dcc92 9133products. If you obtained @command{ld} from a support organization, we
252b5132
RH
9134recommend you contact that organization first.
9135
9136You can find contact information for many support companies and
9137individuals in the file @file{etc/SERVICE} in the @sc{gnu} Emacs
9138distribution.
9139
ad22bfe8 9140@ifset BUGURL
ff5dcc92 9141Otherwise, send bug reports for @command{ld} to
ad22bfe8
JM
9142@value{BUGURL}.
9143@end ifset
252b5132
RH
9144
9145The fundamental principle of reporting bugs usefully is this:
9146@strong{report all the facts}. If you are not sure whether to state a
9147fact or leave it out, state it!
9148
9149Often people omit facts because they think they know what causes the
9150problem and assume that some details do not matter. Thus, you might
b553b183
NC
9151assume that the name of a symbol you use in an example does not
9152matter. Well, probably it does not, but one cannot be sure. Perhaps
9153the bug is a stray memory reference which happens to fetch from the
9154location where that name is stored in memory; perhaps, if the name
9155were different, the contents of that location would fool the linker
9156into doing the right thing despite the bug. Play it safe and give a
9157specific, complete example. That is the easiest thing for you to do,
c0065db7 9158and the most helpful.
b553b183
NC
9159
9160Keep in mind that the purpose of a bug report is to enable us to fix
9161the bug if it is new to us. Therefore, always write your bug reports
9162on the assumption that the bug has not been reported previously.
252b5132
RH
9163
9164Sometimes people give a few sketchy facts and ask, ``Does this ring a
36f63dca
NC
9165bell?'' This cannot help us fix a bug, so it is basically useless. We
9166respond by asking for enough details to enable us to investigate.
9167You might as well expedite matters by sending them to begin with.
252b5132
RH
9168
9169To enable us to fix the bug, you should include all these things:
9170
9171@itemize @bullet
9172@item
ff5dcc92 9173The version of @command{ld}. @command{ld} announces it if you start it with
252b5132
RH
9174the @samp{--version} argument.
9175
9176Without this, we will not know whether there is any point in looking for
ff5dcc92 9177the bug in the current version of @command{ld}.
252b5132
RH
9178
9179@item
ff5dcc92 9180Any patches you may have applied to the @command{ld} source, including any
252b5132
RH
9181patches made to the @code{BFD} library.
9182
9183@item
9184The type of machine you are using, and the operating system name and
9185version number.
9186
9187@item
ff5dcc92 9188What compiler (and its version) was used to compile @command{ld}---e.g.
252b5132
RH
9189``@code{gcc-2.7}''.
9190
9191@item
9192The command arguments you gave the linker to link your example and
9193observe the bug. To guarantee you will not omit something important,
9194list them all. A copy of the Makefile (or the output from make) is
9195sufficient.
9196
9197If we were to try to guess the arguments, we would probably guess wrong
9198and then we might not encounter the bug.
9199
9200@item
9201A complete input file, or set of input files, that will reproduce the
b553b183
NC
9202bug. It is generally most helpful to send the actual object files
9203provided that they are reasonably small. Say no more than 10K. For
9204bigger files you can either make them available by FTP or HTTP or else
9205state that you are willing to send the object file(s) to whomever
9206requests them. (Note - your email will be going to a mailing list, so
9207we do not want to clog it up with large attachments). But small
9208attachments are best.
252b5132
RH
9209
9210If the source files were assembled using @code{gas} or compiled using
9211@code{gcc}, then it may be OK to send the source files rather than the
9212object files. In this case, be sure to say exactly what version of
9213@code{gas} or @code{gcc} was used to produce the object files. Also say
9214how @code{gas} or @code{gcc} were configured.
9215
9216@item
9217A description of what behavior you observe that you believe is
9218incorrect. For example, ``It gets a fatal signal.''
9219
ff5dcc92 9220Of course, if the bug is that @command{ld} gets a fatal signal, then we
252b5132
RH
9221will certainly notice it. But if the bug is incorrect output, we might
9222not notice unless it is glaringly wrong. You might as well not give us
9223a chance to make a mistake.
9224
9225Even if the problem you experience is a fatal signal, you should still
9226say so explicitly. Suppose something strange is going on, such as, your
b45619c0 9227copy of @command{ld} is out of sync, or you have encountered a bug in the
252b5132
RH
9228C library on your system. (This has happened!) Your copy might crash
9229and ours would not. If you told us to expect a crash, then when ours
9230fails to crash, we would know that the bug was not happening for us. If
9231you had not told us to expect a crash, then we would not be able to draw
9232any conclusion from our observations.
9233
9234@item
ff5dcc92 9235If you wish to suggest changes to the @command{ld} source, send us context
252b5132
RH
9236diffs, as generated by @code{diff} with the @samp{-u}, @samp{-c}, or
9237@samp{-p} option. Always send diffs from the old file to the new file.
ff5dcc92 9238If you even discuss something in the @command{ld} source, refer to it by
252b5132
RH
9239context, not by line number.
9240
9241The line numbers in our development sources will not match those in your
9242sources. Your line numbers would convey no useful information to us.
9243@end itemize
9244
9245Here are some things that are not necessary:
9246
9247@itemize @bullet
9248@item
9249A description of the envelope of the bug.
9250
9251Often people who encounter a bug spend a lot of time investigating
9252which changes to the input file will make the bug go away and which
9253changes will not affect it.
9254
9255This is often time consuming and not very useful, because the way we
9256will find the bug is by running a single example under the debugger
9257with breakpoints, not by pure deduction from a series of examples.
9258We recommend that you save your time for something else.
9259
9260Of course, if you can find a simpler example to report @emph{instead}
9261of the original one, that is a convenience for us. Errors in the
9262output will be easier to spot, running under the debugger will take
9263less time, and so on.
9264
9265However, simplification is not vital; if you do not want to do this,
9266report the bug anyway and send us the entire test case you used.
9267
9268@item
9269A patch for the bug.
9270
9271A patch for the bug does help us if it is a good one. But do not omit
9272the necessary information, such as the test case, on the assumption that
9273a patch is all we need. We might see problems with your patch and decide
9274to fix the problem another way, or we might not understand it at all.
9275
ff5dcc92 9276Sometimes with a program as complicated as @command{ld} it is very hard to
252b5132
RH
9277construct an example that will make the program follow a certain path
9278through the code. If you do not send us the example, we will not be
9279able to construct one, so we will not be able to verify that the bug is
9280fixed.
9281
9282And if we cannot understand what bug you are trying to fix, or why your
9283patch should be an improvement, we will not install it. A test case will
9284help us to understand.
9285
9286@item
9287A guess about what the bug is or what it depends on.
9288
9289Such guesses are usually wrong. Even we cannot guess right about such
9290things without first using the debugger to find the facts.
9291@end itemize
9292
9293@node MRI
9294@appendix MRI Compatible Script Files
9295@cindex MRI compatibility
ff5dcc92
SC
9296To aid users making the transition to @sc{gnu} @command{ld} from the MRI
9297linker, @command{ld} can use MRI compatible linker scripts as an
252b5132
RH
9298alternative to the more general-purpose linker scripting language
9299described in @ref{Scripts}. MRI compatible linker scripts have a much
9300simpler command set than the scripting language otherwise used with
ff5dcc92 9301@command{ld}. @sc{gnu} @command{ld} supports the most commonly used MRI
252b5132
RH
9302linker commands; these commands are described here.
9303
9304In general, MRI scripts aren't of much use with the @code{a.out} object
9305file format, since it only has three sections and MRI scripts lack some
9306features to make use of them.
9307
9308You can specify a file containing an MRI-compatible script using the
9309@samp{-c} command-line option.
9310
9311Each command in an MRI-compatible script occupies its own line; each
9312command line starts with the keyword that identifies the command (though
9313blank lines are also allowed for punctuation). If a line of an
ff5dcc92 9314MRI-compatible script begins with an unrecognized keyword, @command{ld}
252b5132
RH
9315issues a warning message, but continues processing the script.
9316
9317Lines beginning with @samp{*} are comments.
9318
9319You can write these commands using all upper-case letters, or all
9320lower case; for example, @samp{chip} is the same as @samp{CHIP}.
9321The following list shows only the upper-case form of each command.
9322
9323@table @code
9324@cindex @code{ABSOLUTE} (MRI)
9325@item ABSOLUTE @var{secname}
9326@itemx ABSOLUTE @var{secname}, @var{secname}, @dots{} @var{secname}
ff5dcc92 9327Normally, @command{ld} includes in the output file all sections from all
252b5132
RH
9328the input files. However, in an MRI-compatible script, you can use the
9329@code{ABSOLUTE} command to restrict the sections that will be present in
9330your output program. If the @code{ABSOLUTE} command is used at all in a
9331script, then only the sections named explicitly in @code{ABSOLUTE}
9332commands will appear in the linker output. You can still use other
9333input sections (whatever you select on the command line, or using
9334@code{LOAD}) to resolve addresses in the output file.
9335
9336@cindex @code{ALIAS} (MRI)
9337@item ALIAS @var{out-secname}, @var{in-secname}
9338Use this command to place the data from input section @var{in-secname}
9339in a section called @var{out-secname} in the linker output file.
9340
9341@var{in-secname} may be an integer.
9342
9343@cindex @code{ALIGN} (MRI)
9344@item ALIGN @var{secname} = @var{expression}
9345Align the section called @var{secname} to @var{expression}. The
9346@var{expression} should be a power of two.
9347
9348@cindex @code{BASE} (MRI)
9349@item BASE @var{expression}
9350Use the value of @var{expression} as the lowest address (other than
9351absolute addresses) in the output file.
9352
9353@cindex @code{CHIP} (MRI)
9354@item CHIP @var{expression}
9355@itemx CHIP @var{expression}, @var{expression}
9356This command does nothing; it is accepted only for compatibility.
9357
9358@cindex @code{END} (MRI)
9359@item END
9360This command does nothing whatever; it's only accepted for compatibility.
9361
9362@cindex @code{FORMAT} (MRI)
9363@item FORMAT @var{output-format}
9364Similar to the @code{OUTPUT_FORMAT} command in the more general linker
dc12032b 9365language, but restricted to S-records, if @var{output-format} is @samp{S}
252b5132
RH
9366
9367@cindex @code{LIST} (MRI)
9368@item LIST @var{anything}@dots{}
9369Print (to the standard output file) a link map, as produced by the
ff5dcc92 9370@command{ld} command-line option @samp{-M}.
252b5132
RH
9371
9372The keyword @code{LIST} may be followed by anything on the
9373same line, with no change in its effect.
9374
9375@cindex @code{LOAD} (MRI)
9376@item LOAD @var{filename}
9377@itemx LOAD @var{filename}, @var{filename}, @dots{} @var{filename}
9378Include one or more object file @var{filename} in the link; this has the
ff5dcc92 9379same effect as specifying @var{filename} directly on the @command{ld}
252b5132
RH
9380command line.
9381
9382@cindex @code{NAME} (MRI)
9383@item NAME @var{output-name}
ff5dcc92 9384@var{output-name} is the name for the program produced by @command{ld}; the
252b5132
RH
9385MRI-compatible command @code{NAME} is equivalent to the command-line
9386option @samp{-o} or the general script language command @code{OUTPUT}.
9387
9388@cindex @code{ORDER} (MRI)
9389@item ORDER @var{secname}, @var{secname}, @dots{} @var{secname}
9390@itemx ORDER @var{secname} @var{secname} @var{secname}
ff5dcc92 9391Normally, @command{ld} orders the sections in its output file in the
252b5132
RH
9392order in which they first appear in the input files. In an MRI-compatible
9393script, you can override this ordering with the @code{ORDER} command. The
9394sections you list with @code{ORDER} will appear first in your output
9395file, in the order specified.
9396
9397@cindex @code{PUBLIC} (MRI)
9398@item PUBLIC @var{name}=@var{expression}
9399@itemx PUBLIC @var{name},@var{expression}
9400@itemx PUBLIC @var{name} @var{expression}
9401Supply a value (@var{expression}) for external symbol
9402@var{name} used in the linker input files.
9403
9404@cindex @code{SECT} (MRI)
9405@item SECT @var{secname}, @var{expression}
9406@itemx SECT @var{secname}=@var{expression}
9407@itemx SECT @var{secname} @var{expression}
9408You can use any of these three forms of the @code{SECT} command to
9409specify the start address (@var{expression}) for section @var{secname}.
9410If you have more than one @code{SECT} statement for the same
9411@var{secname}, only the @emph{first} sets the start address.
9412@end table
9413
793c5807
NC
9414@node GNU Free Documentation License
9415@appendix GNU Free Documentation License
36f63dca 9416@include fdl.texi
704c465c 9417
370b66a1
CD
9418@node LD Index
9419@unnumbered LD Index
252b5132
RH
9420
9421@printindex cp
9422
9423@tex
7ca01ed9 9424% I think something like @@colophon should be in texinfo. In the
252b5132
RH
9425% meantime:
9426\long\def\colophon{\hbox to0pt{}\vfill
9427\centerline{The body of this manual is set in}
9428\centerline{\fontname\tenrm,}
9429\centerline{with headings in {\bf\fontname\tenbf}}
9430\centerline{and examples in {\tt\fontname\tentt}.}
9431\centerline{{\it\fontname\tenit\/} and}
9432\centerline{{\sl\fontname\tensl\/}}
9433\centerline{are used for emphasis.}\vfill}
9434\page\colophon
7ca01ed9 9435% Blame: doc@@cygnus.com, 28mar91.
252b5132
RH
9436@end tex
9437
252b5132 9438@bye